Ford Automobile 2010 Explorer User Manual

Table of Contents  
All rights reserved. Reproduction by any means, electronic or mechanical  
including photocopying, recording or by any information storage and retrieval  
system or translation in whole or part is not permitted without written  
authorization from Ford Motor Company. Ford may change the contents without  
notice and without incurring obligation.  
Copyright © 2009 Ford Motor Company  
3
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Introduction  
CONGRATULATIONS  
Congratulations on acquiring your new Ford. Please take the time to get  
well acquainted with your vehicle by reading this handbook. The more  
you know and understand about your vehicle, the greater the safety and  
pleasure you will derive from driving it.  
For more information on Ford Motor Company and its products visit the  
following website:  
In the United States: www.ford.com  
In Canada: www.ford.ca  
In Australia: www.ford.com.au  
In Mexico: www.ford.com.mx  
Additional owner information is given in separate publications.  
This Owner’s Guide describes every option and model variant available  
and therefore some of the items covered may not apply to your  
particular vehicle. Furthermore, due to printing cycles it may describe  
options before they are generally available.  
Remember to pass on this Owner’s Guide when reselling the vehicle. It is  
an integral part of the vehicle.  
WARNING: Fuel pump shut-off switch: In the event of an  
accident the safety switch will automatically cut off the fuel  
supply to the engine. The switch can also be activated through sudden  
vibration (e.g. collision when parking). To reset the switch, refer to the  
Fuel pump shut-off switch in the Roadside Emergencies chapter.  
SAFETY AND ENVIRONMENT PROTECTION  
Warning symbols in this guide  
How can you reduce the risk of personal injury to yourself or others? In  
this guide, answers to such questions are contained in comments  
highlighted by the warning triangle symbol. These comments should be  
read and observed.  
4
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Introduction  
Warning symbols on your vehicle  
When you see this symbol, it is  
imperative that you consult the  
relevant section of this guide before  
touching or attempting adjustment  
of any kind.  
Protecting the environment  
We must all play our part in  
protecting the environment. Correct  
vehicle usage and the authorized  
disposal of waste, cleaning and  
lubrication materials are significant  
steps towards this aim. Information in this respect is highlighted in this  
guide with the tree symbol.  
CALIFORNIA Proposition 65 Warning  
WARNING: Engine exhaust, some of its constituents, and  
certain vehicle components contain or emit chemicals known to  
the State of California to cause cancer and birth defects or other  
reproductive harm. In addition, certain fluids contained in vehicles and  
certain products of component wear contain or emit chemicals known  
to the State of California to cause cancer and birth defects or other  
reproductive harm.  
PERCHLORATE MATERIAL  
Certain components of this vehicle such as airbag modules, seat belt  
pretensioners, and button cell batteries may contain Perchlorate Material  
– Special handling may apply for service or vehicle end of life disposal.  
See www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/perchlorate.  
BREAKING-IN YOUR VEHICLE  
Your vehicle does not need an extensive break-in. Try not to drive  
continuously at the same speed for the first 1,000 miles (1,600 km) of  
new vehicle operation. Vary your speed frequently in order to give the  
moving parts a chance to break in.  
Drive your new vehicle at least 1,000 miles (1,600 km) before towing a  
trailer. For more detailed information about towing a trailer, refer to  
Trailer towing in the Tires, Wheels and Loading chapter.  
5
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Introduction  
Do not add friction modifier compounds or special break-in oils since  
these additives may prevent piston ring seating. See Engine oil in the  
Maintenance and Specifications chapter for more information on oil  
usage.  
SPECIAL NOTICES  
New Vehicle Limited Warranty  
For a detailed description of what is covered and what is not covered by  
your vehicle’s New Vehicle Limited Warranty, refer to the Warranty  
Guide/Customer Information Guide that is provided to you along with  
your Owner’s Guide.  
Special instructions  
For your added safety, your vehicle is fitted with sophisticated electronic  
controls.  
WARNING: Please read the section Airbag Supplemental  
Restraint System (SRS) in the Seating and Safety Restraints  
chapter. Failure to follow the specific warnings and instructions could  
result in personal injury.  
WARNING: Front seat mounted rear-facing child or infant seats  
should NEVER be placed in front of an active passenger airbag.  
Notice to owners of pickup trucks and utility type vehicles  
WARNING: Utility vehicles have a significantly higher rollover  
rate than other types of vehicles.  
Before you drive your vehicle, please read this Owner’s Guide carefully.  
Your vehicle is not a passenger car. As with other vehicles of this type,  
failure to operate this vehicle correctly may result in loss of vehicle  
control, vehicle rollover, personal injury or death.  
Using your vehicle with a snowplow  
Do not use this vehicle for snowplowing.  
Your vehicle is not equipped with a snowplowing package.  
Using your vehicle as an ambulance  
Do not use this vehicle as an ambulance.  
6
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Introduction  
Your vehicle is not equipped with the Ford Ambulance Preparation  
Package.  
NOTICE TO OWNERS WITH 20 INCH WHEELS AND TIRES  
When equipped with 20 inch wheels and tires the vehicle is designed for  
on-road use only and not off-road use.  
Note: When first driving the vehicle after it has been parked for a period  
of time, you may experience a temporary ride disturbance. This is a  
characteristic of the tires and should be no reason for concern. The  
condition should correct itself within 5-15 miles (8-25 km) of driving. If  
the disturbance persists, have the tires serviced by an authorized dealer.  
Correct tire pressure is important to payload and proper ride and  
handling attributes. Check your vehicle’s Safety Compliance Certification  
Label or Tire Label for the proper tire pressure levels.  
DATA RECORDING  
Service Data Recording  
Service data recorders in your vehicle are capable of collecting and  
storing diagnostic information about your vehicle. This potentially  
includes information about the performance or status of various systems  
and modules in the vehicle, such as engine, throttle, steering or brake  
systems. In order to properly diagnose and service your vehicle, Ford  
Motor Company, Ford of Canada, and service and repair facilities may  
access or share among them vehicle diagnostic information received  
through a direct connection to your vehicle when diagnosing or servicing  
your vehicle. For U.S. only (if equipped), if you choose to use the SYNC௡  
Vehicle Health Report, you consent that certain diagnostic information  
may also be accessed electronically by Ford Motor Company and Ford  
authorized service facilities, and that the diagnostic information may be  
used for any purpose. See your SYNCsupplement for more information.  
Event Data Recording  
Other modules in your vehicle — event data recorders — are  
capable of collecting and storing data during a crash or near  
crash event. The recorded information may assist in the  
investigation of such an event. The modules may record  
information about both the vehicle and the occupants, potentially  
including information such as:  
how various systems in your vehicle were operating;  
whether or not the driver and passenger seatbelts were  
buckled;  
7
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Introduction  
how far (if at all) the driver was depressing the accelerator  
and/or the brake pedal;  
how fast the vehicle was traveling;  
where the driver was positioning the steering wheel; and  
longitude and latitude of vehicle at last location, using GPS  
technology and advanced vehicle sensors.  
To access this information, special equipment must be directly  
connected to the recording modules. Ford Motor Company and  
Ford of Canada do not access event data recorder information  
without obtaining consent, unless pursuant to court order or  
where required by law enforcement, other government authorities  
or other third parties acting with lawful authority. Other parties  
may seek to access the information independently of Ford Motor  
Company and Ford of Canada. To the extent that any law  
pertaining to Event Data Recording applies to SYNCor its  
features, please note the following: Once 911 Assist (if equipped)  
is enabled (set ON), 911 Assist may, through any paired and  
connected cell phone, disclose to emergency services that the  
vehicle has been in a crash involving the deployment of an airbag  
or, in certain vehicles, the activation of the fuel pump shut-off.  
Certain versions or updates to 911 Assist may also be capable of  
electronically or verbally disclosing to 911 operators the vehicle  
location, and/or other details about the vehicle or crash to assist  
911 operators to provide the most appropriate emergency  
services. If you do not want to disclose this information, do not  
activate the feature. See your SYNCsupplement for more  
information. Additionally, when you connect to Traffic, Directions  
and Information (if equipped, U.S. only), the service uses GPS  
technology and advanced vehicle sensors to collect the vehicle’s  
current location, travel direction, and speed (“vehicle travel  
information”) only to help provide you with the directions, traffic  
reports, or business searches you request. If you do not want  
Ford or its vendors to receive this information, do not activate  
the service. Ford Motor Company and the vendors it uses to  
provide you with this information do not store your vehicle travel  
information. For more information, see Traffic, Directions and  
Information, Terms and Conditions. See your SYNCsupplement  
for more information.  
8
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Introduction  
CELL PHONE USE  
The use of Mobile Communications Equipment has become increasingly  
important in the conduct of business and personal affairs. However,  
drivers must not compromise their own or others’ safety when using  
such equipment. Mobile Communications can enhance personal safety  
and security when appropriately used, particularly in emergency  
situations. Safety must be paramount when using mobile communications  
equipment to avoid negating these benefits.  
Mobile Communication Equipment includes, but is not limited to cellular  
phones, pagers, portable email devices, in-vehicle communications  
systems, telematics devices and portable two-way radios.  
WARNING: Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle  
control, accident and injury. Ford strongly recommends that  
drivers use extreme caution when using any device that may take their  
focus off the road. The driver’s primary responsibility is the safe  
operation of their vehicle. Only use cell phones and other devices not  
essential to the driving task when it is safe to do so.  
EXPORT UNIQUE (NON–UNITED STATES/CANADA) VEHICLE  
SPECIFIC INFORMATION  
For your particular global region, your vehicle may be equipped with  
features and options that are different from the features and options that  
are described in this Owner’s Guide. A market unique supplement may  
be supplied that complements this book. By referring to the market  
unique supplement, if provided, you can properly identify those features,  
recommendations and specifications that are unique to your vehicle. This  
Owner’s Guide is written primarily for the U.S. and Canadian Markets.  
Features or equipment listed as standard may be different on units built  
for Export. Refer to this Owner’s Guide for all other required  
information and warnings.  
9
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Introduction  
These are some of the symbols you may see on your vehicle.  
Vehicle Symbol Glossary  
Safety Alert  
See Owner’s Guide  
Airbag - Front  
Fasten Safety Belt  
Airbag - Side  
Child Seat Lower  
Anchor  
Child Seat Tether  
Anchor  
Brake System  
Anti-Lock Brake System  
Parking Brake System  
Brake Fluid -  
Non-Petroleum Based  
Parking Aid System  
Speed Control  
Stability Control System  
Master Lighting Switch  
Fog Lamps-Front  
Hazard Warning Flasher  
Fuse Compartment  
Windshield Wash/Wipe  
Fuel Pump Reset  
Windshield  
Rear Window  
Defrost/Demist  
Defrost/Demist  
10  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Introduction  
Vehicle Symbol Glossary  
Power Window Lockout  
Interior Luggage  
Power Windows  
Front/Rear  
Child Safety Door  
Lock/Unlock  
Compartment Release  
Panic Alarm  
Engine Oil  
Engine Coolant  
Temperature  
Engine Coolant  
Do Not Open When Hot  
Battery  
Avoid Smoking, Flames,  
or Sparks  
Battery Acid  
Fan Warning  
Explosive Gas  
MAX  
MIN  
Maintain Correct Fluid  
Level  
Power Steering Fluid  
Service Engine Soon  
Engine Air Filter  
Jack  
Passenger Compartment  
Air Filter  
Low Tire Pressure  
Warning  
Check Fuel Cap  
11  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
WARNING LIGHTS AND CHIMES  
Standard instrument cluster  
Optional instrument cluster  
Warning lights and gauges can alert you to a vehicle condition that may  
become serious enough to cause expensive repairs. A warning light may  
illuminate when a problem exists with one of your vehicle’s functions.  
Many lights will illuminate when you start your vehicle to make sure the  
bulb works. If any light remains on after starting the vehicle, refer to the  
respective system warning light for additional information.  
Note: Some warning lights will display in the message center as words  
and function the same as the warning light.  
Note: Depending on which options your vehicle has, some indicators  
may not be present in your vehicle.  
12  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Instrument Cluster  
Service engine soon: The service  
engine soon indicator light  
illuminates when the ignition is first  
turned to the on position to check  
the bulb and to indicate whether the vehicle is ready for  
Inspection/Maintenance (I/M) testing. Normally, the service engine soon  
light will stay on until the engine is cranked, then turn itself off if no  
malfunctions are present. However, if after 15 seconds the service engine  
soon light blinks eight times, it means that the vehicle is not ready for  
I/M testing. See the Readiness for Inspection/Maintenance (I/M)  
testing in the Maintenance and Specifications chapter.  
Solid illumination after the engine is started indicates the On Board  
Diagnostics System (OBD-II) has detected a malfunction. Refer to On  
board diagnostics (OBD-II) in the Maintenance and Specifications  
chapter. If the light is blinking, engine misfire is occurring which could  
damage your catalytic converter. Drive in a moderate fashion (avoid  
heavy acceleration and deceleration) and contact your authorized dealer  
as soon as possible.  
If the light remains on while driving, the temperature of the engine may  
be too high; refer to Engine coolant in the Maintenance and  
Specifications chapter.  
WARNING: Under engine misfire conditions, excessive exhaust  
temperatures could damage the catalytic converter, the fuel  
system, interior floor coverings or other vehicle components, possibly  
causing a fire.  
Powertrain malfunction indicator: Illuminates when a powertrain, a  
4x4 or an AWD fault has been detected. Contact your authorized dealer  
as soon as possible.  
Standard instrument cluster  
Optional instrument cluster  
13  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
Brake system warning light: To  
confirm the brake system warning  
light is functional, it will  
momentarily illuminate when the  
ignition is turned to the on position  
!
P
BRAKE  
when the engine is not running, or in a position between on and start, or  
by applying the parking brake when the ignition is turned to the on  
position. If the brake system warning light does not illuminate at this  
time, contact your authorized dealer as soon as possible. Illumination  
after releasing the parking brake indicates low brake fluid level. Contact  
your authorized dealer as soon as possible.  
WARNING: Driving a vehicle with the brake system warning  
light on is dangerous. A significant decrease in braking  
performance may occur. It will take you longer to stop the vehicle.  
Contact your authorized dealer as soon as possible. Driving extended  
distances with the parking brake engaged can cause brake failure and  
the risk of personal injury.  
Anti-lock brake system: If the  
ABS light stays illuminated or  
ABS  
continues to flash, a malfunction has  
been detected. Contact your  
authorized dealer as soon as  
possible. Normal braking is still functional unless the brake warning light  
also is illuminated.  
Airbag readiness: If this light fails  
to illuminate when the ignition is  
turned to on, continues to flash or  
remains on, contact your authorized  
dealer as soon as possible. A chime will sound when there is a  
malfunction in the indicator light.  
Safety belt: Reminds you to fasten  
your safety belt. A Belt-Minder௡  
chime will also sound to remind you  
to fasten your safety belt. Refer to  
the Seating and Safety Restraints  
chapter to activate/deactivate the Belt-Minderchime feature.  
14  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
Charging system: Illuminates when the battery is not charging properly.  
If it stays on while the engine is running, there may be a malfunction  
with the charging system. Contact your authorized dealer as soon as  
possible. This indicates a problem with the electrical system or a related  
component.  
Standard instrument cluster  
Optional instrument cluster  
Engine oil pressure: Illuminates  
when the oil pressure falls below the  
normal range. Check the oil level  
and add oil if needed. Refer to  
Engine oil in the Maintenance and Specifications chapter.  
Engine coolant temperature: Illuminates when the engine coolant  
temperature is high. Stop the vehicle as soon as possible, switch off the  
engine and let cool. Refer to Engine coolant in the Maintenance and  
Specifications chapter.  
Standard instrument cluster  
Optional instrument cluster  
WARNING: Never remove the coolant reservoir cap while the  
engine is running or hot.  
15  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
Low tire pressure warning:  
Illuminates when your tire pressure  
is low. If the light remains on at  
start up or while driving, the tire  
pressure should be checked. Refer  
to Inflating your tires in the Tires, Wheels and Loading chapter. When  
the ignition is first turned to on, the light will illuminate for three  
seconds to ensure the bulb is working. If the light does not turn on,  
contact your authorized dealer as soon as possible. For more information  
on this system, refer to Tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) in  
the Tires, Wheels and Loading chapter.  
Check fuel cap fill inlet (if equipped): Illuminates when the fuel fill  
inlet may not be properly closed. Continued driving with this light on  
may cause the service engine soon warning light to come on, refer to  
Easy Fuel “no cap” fuel system in the Maintenance and Specification  
chapter.  
If “CHECK FUEL FILL INLET” is displayed in the message center, refer  
to Message center in this chapter for more information.  
Standard instrument cluster  
Optional instrument cluster  
Speed control (if equipped):  
Illuminates when the speed control  
is activated. Turns off when the  
speed control system is deactivated.  
O/D off: Illuminates when the  
O/D  
overdrive function of the  
OFF  
transmission has been turned off;  
refer to the Driving chapter.  
16  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
AdvanceTrac: Flashes when the  
AdvanceTracwith RSCsystem is  
active. Illuminates solid when the  
system has been disabled (by the  
driver or as a result of a system  
failure); refer to the Driving  
chapter for more information.  
Four wheel drive low  
4x4  
LOW  
(if equipped): Illuminates when  
four-wheel drive low is engaged. If  
the light fails to illuminate when the  
ignition is turned ON, or remains on, contact your authorized dealer as  
soon as possible.  
Four wheel drive high  
4x4  
(if equipped): Illuminates when  
four-wheel drive is engaged. If the  
light fails to illuminate when the ignition is turned on, or remains on,  
contact your authorized dealer as soon as possible.  
Door ajar: Illuminates when the  
ignition is in the on position and any  
door, liftgate or the liftgate glass is  
open.  
Low fuel (if equipped):  
Illuminates when the fuel level in  
the fuel tank is at or near empty  
(refer to Fuel gauge in this  
chapter).  
Low washer fluid (if equipped):  
Illuminates when the windshield  
washer fluid is low.  
Turn signal: Illuminates when the  
left or right turn signal or the  
hazard lights are turned on. If the  
indicators stay on or flash faster, check for a burned out bulb.  
17  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
High beams: Illuminates when the  
high beam headlamps are turned on.  
Key-in-ignition warning chime: Sounds when the key is left in the  
ignition in the off or accessory position and the driver’s door is opened.  
Headlamps on warning chime: Sounds when the headlamps or parking  
lamps are on, the ignition is off (the key is not in the ignition) and the  
driver’s door is opened.  
Turn signal warning chime: Sounds when the turn signal lever has  
been activated to signal a turn and not turned off after the vehicle is  
driven more than 2 miles (3.2 km).  
Parking brake on warning chime: Sounds when the parking brake is  
set, the engine is running and the vehicle is driven more than 3 mph  
(5 km/h).  
Message center activation chime: Sounds when the following  
warnings DOOR AJAR, LOW FUEL LEVEL or LOW TIRE PRESSURE  
appear in the message center display for the first time.  
GAUGES  
18  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Instrument Cluster  
Speedometer: Indicates the  
current vehicle speed.  
Engine coolant temperature  
gauge: Indicates engine coolant  
temperature. At normal operating  
temperature, the needle will be in  
the normal range (between “H” and  
“C”). If it enters the red section, the  
engine is overheating; refer to  
Engine coolant in the  
Maintenance and Specifications chapter. Stop the vehicle as soon as  
safely possible, switch off the engine and let the engine cool.  
WARNING: Never remove the coolant reservoir cap while the  
engine is running or hot.  
Odometer: Registers the total miles (kilometers) of the vehicle.  
Standard instrument cluster  
Optional instrument cluster  
Refer to Message center in this  
chapter on how to switch the  
display from English to Metric.  
19  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
Trip odometer: Registers the miles (kilometers) of individual journeys.  
Standard instrument cluster  
Press the SELECT/RESET control  
once to switch from the odometer to  
the TRIP A feature. Press the  
control again to select the TRIP B  
feature. To reset the trip, press and  
hold the control again until the trip reading is 0.0 miles.  
Optional instrument cluster: see  
TRIP A/B under Message center in  
this chapter.  
Note: Outside air temperature will  
only be displayed in the instrument  
cluster message center on vehicles  
with manual climate control.  
Tachometer: Indicates the engine  
speed in revolutions per minute.  
Driving with your tachometer  
pointer continuously at the top of  
the scale may damage the engine.  
Fuel gauge: Indicates  
approximately how much fuel is left  
in the fuel tank (when the ignition  
is in the on position). The fuel  
gauge may vary slightly when the  
vehicle is in motion or on a grade.  
Refer to Filling the tank in the  
Maintenance and Specifications  
chapter for more information.  
The FUEL icon and arrow indicates which side of the vehicle the fuel  
door is located.  
20  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
STANDARD MESSAGE CENTER (IF EQUIPPED)  
Your vehicle’s message center allows  
you to configure/personalize certain  
vehicle options to suit your needs.  
The message center is also capable  
of monitoring many vehicle systems  
and will alert you to potential  
vehicle problems and various conditions with an informational message  
followed by a long indicator chime.  
The message center display is located in the instrument cluster.  
Selectable features (information menu)  
Press and release the  
SELECT/RESET stem to scroll and  
reset the following functions. Select  
or reset the function by holding the  
SELECT/RESET stem for more than  
two seconds:  
TRIP A/B  
Registers the distance of individual journeys. Press the SELECT/RESET  
stem once to switch from the odometer to the TRIP A feature. Press the  
control again to select the TRIP B feature. To reset the trip, press and  
hold the stem until it resets.  
Refer to UNITS later in this section to switch the display from Metric to  
English.  
MILES (km) TO EMPTY  
This displays an estimate of approximately how far you can drive with  
the fuel remaining in your tank under normal driving conditions.  
Remember to turn the ignition off when refueling to allow this feature to  
correctly detect the added fuel.  
The DTE function will display FUEL LEVEL LOW and sound a tone for  
one second when you have approximately 50 miles (80 km) to empty. If  
you reset this warning message, this display and tone will return within  
10 minutes.  
DTE is calculated using a running average fuel economy, which is based  
on your recent driving history of 500 miles (800 km). This value is not  
the same as the average fuel economy display. The running average fuel  
economy is reinitialized to a factory default value if the battery is  
disconnected.  
21  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Instrument Cluster  
AVERAGE FUEL XX.X MPG / (L/100km)  
Average fuel economy displays your average fuel economy in miles/gallon  
or liters/100 km.  
If you calculate your average fuel economy by dividing miles traveled by  
gallons of fuel used (liters of fuel used by 100 kilometers traveled), your  
figure may be different than displayed for the following reasons:  
Your vehicle was not perfectly level during fill-up  
Differences in the automatic shut-off points on the fuel pumps at  
service stations  
Variations in top-off procedure from one fill-up to another  
Rounding of the displayed values to the nearest 0.1 gallon (liter)  
1. Drive the vehicle at least 5 miles (8 km) with the speed control  
system engaged to display a stabilized average.  
2. Record the highway fuel economy for future reference.  
It is important to press the SELECT/RESET stem (press and hold for  
two seconds in order to reset the function) after setting the speed  
control to get accurate highway fuel economy readings.  
SETUP MENU HOLD RESET  
When this appears, press and hold the SELECT/RESET stem to reach  
the setup menu.  
Briefly press the SELECT/RESET stem to scroll through the setup menu  
items. If the SELECT/RESET stem is not pressed within four seconds,  
the message center returns to the info menu.  
System Check  
AWD Lock (4.6L engine vehicles only)  
Units (English/Metric)  
Language  
Autolamp  
Autolock  
Autounlock  
Park Aid (if equipped)  
Trailer sway control  
Oil Life Reset and Start Value  
Compass display  
22  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
Compass zone adjustment  
Compass calibration adjustment  
SYSTEM CHECK HOLD RESET  
Press and hold the SELECT/RESET stem to select system check when  
this is displayed in the message center. The message center will cycle  
through each of the systems being monitored. For each of the monitored  
systems, the message center will indicate either an OK message or a  
warning message for two seconds.  
Pressing the SELECT/RESET stem cycles the message center through  
each of the systems being monitored.  
The sequence of the system check report and how it appears in the  
message center is as follows:  
1. OIL LIFE  
2. CHARGING SYSTEM  
3. WASHER FLUID  
4. DOOR AJAR  
5. EXTERIOR LAMP  
6. BRAKE FLUID LEVEL  
7. PARK BRAKE  
8. MILES TO EMPTY  
9. FUEL LEVEL LOW (will only display if 50 miles [80 km] or less to  
empty)  
AWD AUTO / LOCKED (4.6L engine vehicles only)  
This displays the AWD locked function.  
1. Press and hold the SELECT/RESET stem within four seconds to turn  
the AWD system to the auto / locked mode.  
2. Press the SELECT/RESET stem for the next setup menu item or wait  
for more than four seconds to return to the info menu.  
Note: When the AWD system is in the LOCKED mode, the 4X4 indicator  
will be illuminated.  
UNITS  
Displays the current units English or Metric.  
1. Press and hold the SELECT/RESET stem to change from English to  
Metric.  
23  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
2. Press the SELECT/RESET stem for the next setup menu item or wait  
for more than four seconds to return to the info menu.  
ENGLISH / SPANISH / FRENCH / JAPANESE  
Allows you to choose which language the message center will display in.  
Selectable languages are English, Spanish, French, or Japanese.  
1. Press and hold the SELECT/RESET stem to select a new language.  
2. Press the SELECT/RESET stem for the next setup menu item or wait  
for more than four seconds to return to the info menu.  
AUTOLAMP  
This feature keeps your headlights on for up to three minutes after the  
ignition is switched off.  
1. Press and hold the SELECT/RESET stem to select the new autolamp  
delay time (in seconds) values of 0, 10, 20, 30, 60, 90, 120 or 180.  
2. Press the SELECT/RESET stem for the next setup menu item or wait  
for more than four seconds to return to the info menu.  
AUTOLOCK  
This feature automatically locks all vehicle doors when the vehicle is  
shifted into any gear and when the vehicle is in motion over 13 mph  
(20 km/h) or higher.  
1. Press and hold the SELECT/RESET stem to to turn autolock on or off.  
2. Press the SELECT/RESET stem for the next setup menu item or wait  
for more than four seconds to return to the info menu.  
AUTOUNLOCK  
This feature automatically unlocks all vehicle doors when the driver’s  
door is opened within 10 minutes of the ignition being turned off.  
1. Press and hold the SELECT/RESET stem to to turn autounlock on or  
off.  
2. Press the SELECT/RESET stem switch for the next setup menu item  
or wait for more than four seconds to return to the info menu.  
PARK AID (if equipped)  
This feature sounds a warning tone to warn the driver of obstacles near  
the rear bumper, and functions only when R (Reverse) gear is selected.  
1. To disable/enable the reverse sensing system feature with the vehicle  
in P (Park), select this function from the setup menu or put the vehicle  
in R (Reverse).  
24  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
2. Press and hold the SELECT/RESET stem to turn park aid on or off.  
3. Press the SELECT/RESET stem for the next setup menu item or wait  
for more than four seconds to return to the info menu.  
TRAILER SWAY  
This feature uses the electronic stability control to mitigate trailer sway,  
1. Press and hold the SELECT/RESET stem to turn trailer sway on or  
off.  
2. Press the SELECT/RESET stem for the next setup menu item or wait  
for more than four seconds to return to the info menu.  
HOLD RESET IF NEW OIL  
To reset the oil monitoring system to 100% after each oil change  
(approximately 7,500 miles [12,000 km] or six months) perform the  
following:  
1. Press and hold the SELECT/RESET stem for more than two seconds.  
Oil life is set to 100% and OIL LIFE SET TO 100% is displayed.  
Note: To change oil life 100% miles value from 7,500 miles (12,000 km)  
or six months to another value, proceed to Step 3.  
2. Once OIL LIFE SET TO 100% is displayed, release, press and hold the  
SELECT/RESET stem for more than two seconds to change the oil life  
start value. Each release, press and hold will reduce the value by 10%.  
3. After setting the oil life start value, press the SELECT/RESET stem  
for the next setup menu item or wait for more than four seconds to  
return to the info menu.  
Note: Oil Life Start Value of 100% equals 7,500 miles (12,000 km) or six  
months. For example, setting oil life start value to 60% sets the oil life  
start value to 3,000 miles (4,800 km) and 120 days.  
COMPASS (if equipped)  
The compass heading is displayed as one of N, NE, E, SE, S, SW, W and  
NW in the message center display.  
The compass reading may be affected when you drive near large  
buildings, bridges, power lines and powerful broadcast antenna. Magnetic  
or metallic objects placed in, on or near the vehicle may also affect  
compass accuracy.  
Usually, when something affects the compass readings, the compass will  
correct itself after a few days of operating your vehicle in normal  
conditions. If the compass still appears to be inaccurate, a manual  
calibration may be necessary. Refer to Compass zone/calibration  
adjustment.  
25  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
Most geographic areas (zones) have a magnetic north compass point that  
varies slightly from the northerly direction on maps. This variation is four  
degrees between adjacent zones and will become noticeable as the  
vehicle crosses multiple zones. A correct zone setting will eliminate this  
error. Do the following to set the proper zone:  
Compass zone adjustment  
1. Determine which magnetic zone  
you are in for your geographic  
location by referring to the zone  
3 2  
4
1
15  
map.  
14  
13  
2. Turn ignition to the on position.  
5
12  
6
7 8 91011  
3. Press and release the SELECT/RESET stem to scroll through the  
information menu until the message center displays HOLD RESET FOR  
SETUP MENU.  
4. Press and hold the SELECT/RESET stem until the message center  
displays HOLD RESET FOR SYSTEM CHECK. Do not hold the stem  
down at this point as you do not want to enter the system check.  
Instead, quickly release the stem and repeatedly press it again to scroll  
through the setup menu until the message center displays COMPASS  
ZONE XX.  
5. Press and hold the SELECT/RESET stem for approximately two  
seconds to enter the compass zone adjustment mode.  
6. Press and release the SELECT/RESET stem until the desired zone  
number appears.  
7. Release the SELECT/RESET stem and allow the setup timer to expire  
to exit the procedure.  
Compass calibration adjustment  
Perform compass calibration in an open area free from steel structures  
and high voltage lines. For optimum calibration, turn off all electrical  
accessories (heater/air conditioning, wipers, etc.) and make sure all  
vehicle doors are shut.  
1. Start the vehicle.  
26  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
2. Press and release the SELECT/RESET stem to scroll through the  
information menu until the message center displays HOLD RESET FOR  
SETUP MENU.  
3. Press and hold the SELECT/RESET stem until the message center  
displays HOLD RESET FOR SYSTEM CHECK. Do not hold the stem  
down at this point as you do not want to enter the system check.  
Instead, quickly release the stem and repeatedly press it again to scroll  
through the setup menu until the message center displays COMPASS  
ZONE XX.  
4. Press and hold the SELECT/RESET stem for approximately two  
seconds until the message center to enter the compass zone adjustment  
mode.  
5. Press and hold the SELECT/RESET stem until the message center  
displays CIRCLE SLOWLY TO CALIBRATE. This step may require up to  
five circles to complete the calibration.  
NOTE: : If the SELECT/RESET stem is pressed during the calibration or  
three minutes has elapsed since the beginning of the calibration without  
driving the vehicle, the message center reverts back to normal operation  
and the CAL will display until a successful calibration is carried out.  
6. Slowly drive the vehicle in a circle less than 3 mph (5 km/h ) until the  
CIRCLE SLOWLY TO CALIBRATE message changes to CALIBRATION  
COMPLETED.  
System warnings  
System warnings alert you to possible problems or malfunctions in your  
vehicle’s operating systems.  
In the event of a multiple warning situation, the message center will  
cycle the display to show all warnings by displaying each one for four  
seconds.  
The message center will display the last selected feature if there are no  
more warning messages.  
Types of messages and warnings:  
Some messages will appear briefly to inform you of something you  
may need to take action on or be informed of.  
Some messages will appear once and then again when the vehicle is  
restarted.  
Some messages will reappear after clearing or being reset if a problem  
or condition is still present and needs your attention.  
27  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Instrument Cluster  
Some messages can be acknowledged and reset by pressing the  
SELECT/RESET stem. This allows you to use the full message center  
functionality by clearing the message.  
DOOR AJAR — Displayed when a door is not completely closed.  
REMOVE OBJECTS NEAR PASS SEAT — Displayed when objects  
are by the passenger seat. After the objects are moved away from the  
seat, if the warning stays on or continues to come on, contact your  
authorized dealer as soon as possible.  
SERVICE RSC NOW — Displayed when the system is not operating  
properly. If the warning stays on or continues to come on, contact your  
authorized dealer as soon as possible.  
CHECK FUEL FILL INLET — Displayed when the fuel fill inlet may  
not be properly closed. Refer to Easy Fuel™ “no cap” fuel system in  
the Maintenance and Specifications chapter.  
CHECK CHARGING SYSTEM — Displayed when the electrical system  
is not maintaining proper voltage when the engine is running. If you are  
operating electrical accessories when the engine is idling at a low speed,  
turn off as many of the electrical loads as soon as possible. If the  
warning stays on or comes on when the engine is operating at normal  
speeds, contact your authorized dealer as soon as possible.  
FUEL LEVEL LOW — Displayed as an early reminder of a low fuel  
condition.  
PARK BRAKE ENGAGED — Displayed when the parking brake is set,  
the engine is running and the vehicle is driven more than 3 mph  
(5 km/h). If the warning stays on after the parking brake is released,  
contact your authorized dealer as soon as possible.  
CHECK BRAKE SYSTEM — Displayed when the braking system is not  
operating properly. If the warning stays on or continues to come on,  
contact your authorized dealer as soon as possible.  
CHECK PARK AID (if equipped) — Displayed when the transmission  
is in R (Reverse) and the reverse sensing system (park aid) is disabled.  
LOW TIRE PRESSURE — Displayed when one or more tires on your  
vehicle have low tire pressure. Refer to Inflating your tires in the Tires,  
Wheels and Loading chapter.  
TIRE PRESSURE MONITOR FAULT — Displayed when the Tire  
Pressure Monitoring System is malfunctioning. If the warning stays on or  
continues to come on, contact your authorized dealer as soon as  
possible.  
28  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
TIRE PRESSURE SENSOR FAULT — Displayed when a tire pressure  
sensor is malfunctioning, or your spare tire is in use. For more  
information on how the system operates under these conditions, refer to  
Understanding your Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) in the  
Tires, Wheels and Loading chapter. If the warning stays on or  
continues to come on, contact your authorized dealer as soon as  
possible.  
BRAKE FLUID LEVEL LOW — Indicates the brake fluid level is low  
and the brake system should be inspected immediately. Refer to Brake  
fluid in the Maintenance and Specifications chapter.  
WASHER FLUID LEVEL LOW — Indicates the washer fluid reservoir  
is less than one quarter full. Check the washer fluid level. Refer to  
Windshield washer fluid in the Maintenance and Specifications  
chapter.  
OIL LIFE CHANGE SOON — Displayed when the engine oil life  
remaining is 10% or less.  
OIL CHANGE REQUIRED — Displayed when the oil life left reaches  
0%.  
LIFTGATE / GLASS AJAR — Displayed when the liftgate or the  
liftgate glass is not completely closed.  
TRAILER SWAY REDUCE SPEED — Displayed when your trailer  
starts to sway when towing. Refer to Trailer sway control in the  
Driving chapter for more information.  
FOR 4X4 LOW STOP VEHICLE (if equipped) — Displayed when  
4X4 LOW is selected while the vehicle is moving. For more information,  
refer to Using the Control Trac 4WD system in the Driving chapter.  
FOR 4X4 LOW SHIFT TO N (if equipped) — Displayed when 4X4  
LOW is selected and the vehicle is stopped. For more information, refer  
to Using the Control Trac 4WD system in the Driving chapter.  
TO EXIT 4X4 LOW STOP VEHICLE (if equipped) — Displayed  
when 2WD is selected while the vehicle is operating in 4X4 LOW. For  
more information, refer to Using the Control Trac 4WD system in the  
Driving chapter.  
TO EXIT 4X4 LOW SHIFT TO N (if equipped) — Displayed when  
2WD is selected while the vehicle has been stopped in 4X4 LOW. For  
more information, refer to Using the Control Trac 4WD system in the  
Driving chapter.  
29  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
OPTIONAL MESSAGE CENTER (IF EQUIPPED)  
Your vehicle’s message center allows  
you to configure/personalize certain  
vehicle options to suit your needs.  
The message center is also capable  
of monitoring many vehicle systems  
and will alert you to potential  
vehicle problems and various  
conditions with an informational  
message followed by a long indicator chime.  
The message center display is located in the instrument cluster.  
Your display can show up to six reconfigurable telltales at one time.  
Whatever is displayed in the top left corner has the highest priority.  
Info  
Press the INFO button repeatedly to  
cycle through the following features:  
TRIP A/B  
Registers the distance of individual journeys. Press and release INFO  
button until the A or B trip appears in the display (this represents the  
trip mode). Press and hold the RESET button for two seconds to reset.  
30  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Instrument Cluster  
Refer to UNITS later in this section to switch the display from Metric to  
English.  
MILES (km) TO E  
This displays an estimate of approximately how far you can drive with  
the fuel remaining in your tank under normal driving conditions.  
Remember to turn the ignition off when refueling to allow this feature to  
correctly detect the added fuel.  
The DTE function will display LOW FUEL LEVEL when you have  
approximately 50 miles (80 km), to empty. Press RESET to clear this  
warning message. It will return at approximately 25 miles (40 km),  
10 miles (16 km) and 0 miles (0 km) miles to empty.  
DTE is calculated using a running average fuel economy, which is based  
on your recent driving history of 500 miles (800 km). This value is not  
the same as the average fuel economy display. The running average fuel  
economy is re-initialized to a factory default value if the battery is  
disconnected.  
AVERAGE FUEL XX.X MPG (L/100km)  
Average fuel economy displays your average fuel economy in miles/gallon  
or liters/100 km.  
If you calculate your average fuel economy by dividing distance traveled  
by gallons of fuel used (liters of fuel used by 100 kilometers traveled),  
your figure may be different than displayed for the following reasons:  
Your vehicle was not perfectly level during fill-up  
Differences in the automatic shut-off points on the fuel pumps at  
service stations  
Variations in top-off procedure from one fill-up to another  
Rounding of the displayed values to the nearest 0.1 gallon (liter)  
1. Drive the vehicle at least 5 miles (8 km) with the speed control  
system engaged to display a stabilized average.  
2. Record the highway fuel economy for future reference.  
It is important to press the RESET button (press and hold RESET for  
two seconds in order to reset the function) after setting the speed  
control to get accurate highway fuel economy readings.  
For more information refer to Essentials of good fuel economy in the  
Maintenance and Specifications chapter.  
31  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
FUEL ECONOMY MPG (L/km)  
This displays instantaneous fuel economy as a bar graph ranging from ↓  
poor economy to excellent economy.  
Your vehicle must be moving to calculate instantaneous fuel economy.  
When your vehicle is not moving, this function shows , one or no bars  
illuminated. Instantaneous fuel economy cannot be reset.  
FUEL USED XX.X GAL (L)  
This displays the fuel used since last reset. The information displayed  
will be in gallons or liters, depending on English/Metric mode state.  
DRIVE TIME  
Timer displays the trip elapsed drive time.  
To operate, do the following:  
1. Press and release RESET in order to start the timer.  
2. Press and release RESET to pause the timer.  
3. Press and hold RESET until the timer resets.  
Blank display  
Select this function from the info menu to turn the upper two lines of  
the message center display off.  
System check and vehicle feature customization  
Press the SETUP button repeatedly  
to cycle the message center through  
the following features:  
INFO  
SETUP  
RESET  
PRESS RESET TO BEGIN SYSTEM CHECK  
When this message appears, press the RESET button and the message  
center will begin to cycle through the following systems and provide a  
status of the item if needed.  
Note: Some systems show a message only if a condition is present.  
1. OIL LIFE  
2. CHARGING SYSTEM  
3. WASHER FLUID  
32  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Instrument Cluster  
4. DOOR AJAR  
5. EXTERIOR LAMP  
6. BRAKE FLUID LEVEL  
7. PARK BRAKE  
8. FUEL LEVEL AND DISTANCE TO EMPTY  
AWD AUTO / LOCKED (if equipped)  
This feature disables/enables the AWD feature.  
Press the RESET button to select the AUTO or LOCKED mode.  
Note: When the AWD system is in the locked mode, the 4X4 indicator  
will be illuminated.  
UNITS  
Displays the current units in English or Metric.  
Press the RESET button to change from English to Metric.  
LANGUAGE ENGLISH / SPANISH / FRENCH / JAPANESE /  
ARABIC  
Note: When entering the SETUP MENU and a non-English language has  
been selected, PRESS RESET FOR ENGLISH will be displayed to change  
back to English.  
Allows you to choose which language the message center will display in.  
Selectable languages are English, Spanish, French, Japanese, or Arabic  
Waiting four seconds or pressing the RESET button cycles the message  
center through each of the language choices.  
Press the RESET button to set the language choice.  
AUTOLAMP  
This feature keeps your headlights on for up to three minutes after the  
ignition is switched off.  
Press the RESET button to select the new Autolamp delay values of 0,  
10, 20, 30, 60, 90, 120 or 180 seconds.  
AUTOLOCK  
This feature automatically locks all vehicle doors when the vehicle is  
shifted into any gear, putting the vehicle in motion.  
Press the RESET button to turn autolock on or off.  
AUTOUNLOCK  
This feature automatically unlocks all vehicle doors when the driver’s  
door is opened within 10 minutes of the ignition being turned off.  
33  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
Press the RESET button to turn autounlock on or off.  
RUNNING BRDS (if equipped)  
This feature automatically deploys the side running boards for easy  
entry/exit from the vehicle or for cleaning.  
1. To disable/enable the power running board feature the vehicle must be  
in P (Park),  
2. To change operation of the power running board feature, select this  
function from the SETUP MENU.  
3. Press the RESETbutton to select the running boards setting as  
follows:  
AUTOMATIC: the running boards will automatically deploy when a  
door is opened and automatically retract when the door is closed,  
OUT: the running boards will remain OUT regardless of the doors  
being open/closed. For example, use this setting when washing the  
vehicle, or  
OFF: the running boards will remain IN regardless of the doors being  
open/closed.  
EASY ENTRY  
This feature automatically moves the driver’s seat backwards for easy  
exit/entry from the vehicle.  
Press the RESET button to turn the easy entry/exit seat on or off.  
PARK AID (if equipped)  
This feature sounds a warning tone to warn the driver of obstacles near  
the rear bumper, and functions only when R (Reverse) gear is selected.  
Press the RESET button to turn the rear park assist on or off.  
This function choice will also appear when putting the transmission in  
reverse and can be turned on/off at that time.  
TRAILER SWAY  
This feature uses the electronic stability control to mitigate trailer sway,  
Press the RESET button to turn trailer sway on or off.  
COMPASS (if equipped)  
The compass heading is displayed as one of N, NE, E, SE, S, SW, W and  
NW in the message center display.  
The compass reading may be affected when you drive near large  
buildings, bridges, power lines and powerful broadcast antenna. Magnetic  
or metallic objects placed in, on or near the vehicle may also affect  
compass accuracy.  
34  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
Usually, when something affects the compass readings, the compass will  
correct itself after a few days of operating your vehicle in normal  
conditions. If the compass still appears to be inaccurate, a manual  
calibration may be necessary. Refer to RESET FOR ZONE SETTING /  
PRESS RESET FOR CALIBRATION following.  
Most geographic areas (zones) have a magnetic north compass point that  
varies slightly from the northerly direction on maps. This variation is four  
degrees between adjacent zones and will become noticeable as the  
vehicle crosses multiple zones. A correct zone setting will eliminate this  
error. Refer to RESET FOR ZONE SETTING / PRESS RESET FOR  
CALIBRATION following.  
RESET FOR ZONE SETTING  
1. Determine your magnetic zone by  
referring to the zone map.  
3 2  
4
1
15  
2. Start the engine.  
3. Press the SETUP button to select  
RESET FOR ZONE SETTING.  
14  
13  
4. Press the RESET button until the  
message center display changes to  
show the current zone setting (XX).  
5
12  
5. Press the RESET button  
repeatedly until the correct zone  
6
7 8 91011  
setting for your geographic location is displayed on the message center.  
The range of zone values are from 01 to 15 and “wraps” back to 01.  
6. Wait four seconds when correct zone is chosen.  
PRESS RESET FOR CALIBRATION  
Perform compass calibration in an open area free from steel structures  
and high voltage lines. For optimum calibration, turn off all electrical  
accessories (heater/air conditioning, wipers, etc.) and make sure all  
vehicle doors are shut.  
1. Press the SETUP button to select PRESS RESET FOR CALIBRATION.  
2. Press RESET to calibrate.  
3. Slowly drive the vehicle in a circle (less than 3 mph [5 km/h]) until  
the CIRCLE SLOWLY TO CALIBRATE display changes to CALIBRATION  
COMPLETED. It will take up to five circles to complete calibration.  
4. The compass is now calibrated.  
35  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
HOLD RESET IF NEW OIL  
To reset the oil monitoring system to 100% after each oil change  
(approximately 7,500 miles [12,000 km] or six months) perform the  
following:  
1. Press RESET button to display HOLD RESET IF NEW OIL.  
2. Press and hold the RESET button for more than two seconds. Oil life  
is set to 100% and OIL CHANGE SET TO 100% is displayed.  
Note: To change oil life 100% miles value from 7,500 miles (12,000 km)  
or six months to another value, proceed to Step 3.  
3. Once OIL LIFE SET TO XXX% is displayed, release and press the  
RESET button to change the Oil Life Start Value. Each release and press  
will reduce the value by 10%.  
Note: Oil Life Start Value of 100% equals 7,500 miles (12,000 km) or six  
months. For example, setting Oil Life Start Value to 60% sets the Oil Life  
Start Value to 3,000 miles (4,800 km) and 120 days.  
System warnings  
System warnings alert you to possible problems or malfunctions in your  
vehicle’s operating systems.  
In the event of a multiple warning situation, the message center will  
cycle the display to show all warnings by displaying each one for four  
seconds.  
The message center will display the last selected feature if there are no  
more warning messages.  
Types of messages and warnings:  
Some messages will appear briefly to inform you of something you  
may need to take action on or be informed of.  
Some messages will appear once and then again when the vehicle is  
restarted.  
Some messages will reappear after clearing or being reset if a problem  
or condition is still present and needs your attention.  
Some messages can be acknowledged and reset by pressing RESET.  
This allows you to use the full message center functionality by clearing  
the message.  
DOOR AJAR — Displayed when a door is not completely closed.  
36  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Instrument Cluster  
REMOVE OBJECTS NEAR PASS SEAT — Displayed when objects  
are by the passenger seat. After the objects are moved away from the  
seat, if the warning stays on or continues to come on, contact your  
authorized dealer as soon as possible.  
SERVICE RSC NOW — Displayed when the system is not operating  
properly. If the warning stays on or continues to come on, contact your  
authorized dealer as soon as possible.  
CHECK FUEL FILL INLET — Displayed when the fuel fill inlet may  
not be properly closed. Refer to Easy Fuel™ “no cap” fuel system in  
the Maintenance and Specifications chapter.  
CHECK CHARGING SYSTEM — Displayed when the electrical system  
is not maintaining proper voltage when the engine is running. If you are  
operating electrical accessories when the engine is idling at a low speed,  
turn off as many of the electrical loads as soon as possible. If the  
warning stays on or comes on when the engine is operating at normal  
speeds, contact your authorized dealer as soon as possible.  
FUEL LEVEL LOW — Displayed as an early reminder of a low fuel  
condition.  
PARK BRAKE ENGAGED — Displayed when the parking brake is set,  
the engine is running and the vehicle is driven more than 3 mph  
(5 km/h). If the warning stays on after the parking brake is released,  
contact your authorized dealer as soon as possible.  
CHECK BRAKE SYSTEM — Displayed when the braking system is not  
operating properly. If the warning stays on or continues to come on,  
contact your authorized dealer as soon as possible.  
CHECK PARK AID (if equipped) — Displayed when the transmission  
is in R (Reverse) and the reverse sensing system (park aid) is disabled.  
LOW TIRE PRESSURE — Displayed when one or more tires on your  
vehicle have low tire pressure. Refer to Inflating your tires in the Tires,  
Wheels and Loading chapter.  
TIRE PRESSURE MONITOR FAULT — Displayed when the Tire  
Pressure Monitoring System is malfunctioning. If the warning stays on or  
continues to come on, contact your authorized dealer as soon as  
possible.  
TIRE PRESSURE SENSOR FAULT — Displayed when a tire pressure  
sensor is malfunctioning, or your spare tire is in use. For more  
information on how the system operates under these conditions, refer to  
Understanding your Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) in the  
Tires, Wheels and Loading chapter. If the warning stays on or  
continues to come on, contact your authorized dealer as soon as  
possible.  
37  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Instrument Cluster  
BRAKE FLUID LEVEL LOW — Indicates the brake fluid level is low  
and the brake system should be inspected immediately. Refer to Brake  
fluid in the Maintenance and Specifications chapter.  
WASHER FLUID LEVEL LOW — Indicates the washer fluid reservoir  
is less than one quarter full. Check the washer fluid level. Refer to  
Windshield washer fluid in the Maintenance and Specifications  
chapter.  
OIL LIFE CHANGE SOON — Displayed when the engine oil life  
remaining is 10% or less.  
OIL CHANGE REQUIRED — Displayed when the oil life left reaches  
0%.  
LIFTGATE / GLASS AJAR — Displayed when the liftgate or the  
liftgate glass is not completely closed.  
TRAILER SWAY REDUCE SPEED — Displayed when your trailer  
starts to sway when towing. Refer to Trailer sway control in the  
Driving chapter for more information.  
FOR 4X4 LOW STOP VEHICLE (if equipped) — Displayed when  
4X4 LOW is selected while the vehicle is moving. For more information,  
refer to Using the Control Trac 4WD system in the Driving chapter.  
FOR 4X4 LOW SHIFT TO N (if equipped) — Displayed when 4X4  
LOW is selected and the vehicle is stopped. For more information, refer  
to Using the Control Trac 4WD system in the Driving chapter.  
TO EXIT 4X4 LOW STOP VEHICLE (if equipped) — Displayed  
when 2WD is selected while the vehicle is operating in 4X4 LOW. For  
more information, refer to Using the Control Trac 4WD system in the  
Driving chapter.  
TO EXIT 4X4 LOW SHIFT TO N (if equipped) — Displayed when  
2WD is selected while the vehicle has been stopped in 4X4 LOW. For  
more information, refer to Using the Control Trac 4WD system in the  
Driving chapter.  
38  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
AUDIO SYSTEMS  
Quick start — How to get going  
WARNING: Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle  
control, accident and injury. Ford strongly recommends that  
drivers use extreme caution when using any device that may take their  
focus off the road. The drivers primary responsibility is the safe  
operation of their vehicle. Only use cell phones and other devices not  
essential to the driving task when it is safe to do so.  
Listening to the radio  
1. If the audio system is off, press  
VOL-PUSH to turn the radio on.  
Turn VOL-PUSH to adjust the  
volume.  
Note: The system may take a few  
moments to turn on.  
2. Press AM/FM repeatedly to  
choose between AM/FM1/FM2  
frequency bands.  
3. Press  
/
to manually go  
up/down the frequency band.  
Press  
SEEK  
to search  
down/up the chosen frequency band  
for the next strongest station.  
To disengage SEEK mode,  
press  
/
.
4. Once you are tuned to the  
desired station, press and hold a  
memory preset (1–6) to save the  
station. PRESET SAVED will appear on the display and the sound will  
return signifying the station has been saved. You can save up to six  
stations in each frequency band — six in AM, six in FM1 and six in FM2.  
To access your saved stations, press the corresponding memory preset.  
The memory preset # and the station frequency will appear on the  
display.  
39  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Entertainment Systems  
Listening to satellite radio (if equipped)  
1. If the audio system is turned off,  
press VOL-PUSH to turn the radio  
on. Turn VOL-PUSH to adjust the  
volume.  
Note: The system may take a few  
moments to turn on.  
2. Press AUX repeatedly to cycle  
through auxiliary audio sources.  
Select SAT1, SAT2 or SAT3 to listen  
to satellite radio.  
3. Press  
SEEK, SEEK  
to  
access the previous or next satellite  
channel.  
You may also seek by music  
category. For further information, refer to CATEGORY listing under the  
MENU control on your specific audio system.  
4. Once you are tuned to the  
desired channel, press and hold a  
memory preset (1–6) to save the  
channel. PRESET SAVED will appear on the display and the sound will  
return signifying the station has been saved. You can save up to six  
channels in each — six in SAT1, six in SAT2, and six in SAT3.  
To access your saved channels, press the corresponding memory preset.  
The memory preset # and the channel name will appear on the display.  
Listening to a CD/MP3 (if equipped)  
1. If the audio system is turned off,  
press VOL-PUSH to turn the radio  
on. Turn VOL-PUSH to adjust the  
volume.  
Note: The system may take a few  
moments to turn on.  
2. Press CD to enter CD mode. If a  
disc is already loaded into the  
system, CD play will begin where it  
ended last.  
40  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
For a single CD system, if a disc  
is not already loaded, insert only  
one, label side up into the CD slot.  
LOADING CD and READING DISC will appear in the display. The first  
track on the disc will begin playing.  
For an in-dash six CD system, if  
a disc is not already loaded, press  
LOAD. Select a slot number using  
memory presets 1–6. When the  
display reads LOAD CD#, load the  
desired disc, label side up. If you do not choose a slot within five  
seconds, the system will choose for you. Once loaded, the first track will  
begin to play.  
To auto load up to six discs, press and hold LOAD until the display  
reads AUTOLOAD#. Load the desired disc, label side up. The system will  
prompt you to load discs for the remaining available slots. Insert the  
discs, one at a time, label side up, when prompted. Once loaded, the last  
loaded disc will begin to play.  
Note: An MP3 disc with folders will show F001 (folder #) T001 (track #)  
in the display. An MP3 disc without folders will show T001 (track#) in  
the display. Refer to MP3 track and folder structure later in this  
chapter for further information.  
3. In CD/MP3 mode, you can access the following features:  
Press  
SEEK, SEEK  
to  
access the previous/next tracks.  
Press and hold REW to manually  
reverse in a CD/MP3 track.  
Press and hold FF to manually  
advance in a CD/MP3 track.  
While in folder mode, press  
FOLDER to access the previous  
folder on MP3 discs, if available.  
41  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
While in folder mode, press  
FOLDER  
to access the next  
folder on MP3 discs, if available.  
Press SHUFFLE to engage shuffle  
mode. SHUFFLE ON will appear in  
the display. If you wish to engage  
shuffle mode right away, press SEEK to begin random play. Otherwise,  
random play will begin when the current track is finished playing. CD  
SHUF will appear in the display.  
To disengage, press SHUFFLE again. SHUFFLE OFF will appear in the  
display.  
Note: In track mode, all tracks on the current disc will shuffle in  
random order. In MP3 folder mode, the system will randomly play all  
tracks within the current folder.  
Press  
/
(play/pause) when a  
CD/MP3 is playing to pause the disc.  
CD PAUSE will appear in the  
display. Press again to resume play.  
4. For a single CD system,  
press  
to eject the current disc.  
The display will read CD EJECT.  
For an in-dash six CD system,  
press  
and then select the  
correct slot number using memory presets 1–6. When ready, the system  
will eject the disc and the display will read REMOVE CD. If the disc is  
not removed in 15 seconds, the system will reload the disc.  
To auto eject up to six discs, press and hold  
until the system  
begins ejecting all loaded discs. If the discs are not removed, the system  
will reload the discs.  
42  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
AM/FM Single CD/MP3 satellite compatible sound system  
(if equipped)  
WARNING: Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle  
control, accident and injury. Ford strongly recommends that  
drivers use extreme caution when using any device that may take their  
focus off the road. The driver’s primary responsibility is the safe  
operation of their vehicle. Only use cell phones and other devices not  
essential to the driving task when it is safe to do so.  
Accessory delay: Your vehicle is equipped with accessory delay. With  
this feature, the window switches, radio and moon roof (if equipped)  
may be used for up to ten minutes after the ignition is turned off or until  
either front door is opened.  
1.  
/
(Tuner): Press to  
manually go up or down the radio  
frequency. Also use in menu mode  
to select various settings.  
In satellite radio mode (if equipped), press  
/
to tune to the  
next/previous channel.  
43  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Entertainment Systems  
In CATEGORY MODE, press  
/
to scroll through the list of  
available SIRIUS channel Categories (Pop, Rock, News, etc.). Refer to  
Category Mode under Menu for further information.  
Satellite radio is available only with a valid SIRIUS subscription.  
Check with your authorized dealer for availability.  
2.  
(Phone): If your vehicle is  
equipped with SYNC, press to  
access SYNC PHONE features. Refer  
to the SYNCsupplement for further information.  
If your vehicle is not equipped with SYNC, the display will read NO  
PHONE.  
3. MENU: Press repeatedly to  
access the following settings:  
SATELLITE RADIO MENU (if equipped): Press MENU when satellite  
radio mode is active to access. Press OK to enter into the satellite radio  
menu. Press  
/
to cycle through the following options:  
CATEGORY: Press OK to enter category mode. Press  
/
to  
scroll through the list of available SIRIUS channel Categories (Pop,  
Rock, News, etc.) Press OK when the desired category appears in the  
display. After a category is selected, press SEEK to search for that  
specific category of channels only (i.e. ROCK). You may also select  
CATEGORY ALL to seek all available SIRIUS categories and channels.  
Press OK to close and return to the main menu.  
SAVE SONG: Press OK to save the currently playing song’s title in  
the system’s memory. (If you try to save something other than a song,  
CANT SAVE will appear in the display.) When the chosen song is  
playing on any satellite radio channel, the system will alert you with  
an audible prompt. Press OK while SONG ALERT is in the display and  
the system will take you to the channel playing the desired song. You  
can save up to 20 song titles. If you attempt to save more than 20  
titles, the display will read REPLACE SONG? Press OK to access the  
saved titles and press  
/
to cycle through the saved titles. When  
the song appears in the display that you would like to replace, press  
OK. SONG REPLACED will appear in the display.  
44  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
DELETE SONG: Press OK to delete a song from the system’s  
memory. Press  
/
to cycle through the saved songs. When the  
song appears in the display that you would like to delete, press OK.  
The song will appear in the display for confirmation. Press OK again  
and the display will read SONG DELETED. If you do not want to  
delete the currently listed song, press  
RETURN or CANCEL.  
/
to select either  
Note: If there are no songs presently saved, the display will read NO  
SONGS.  
DELETE ALL SONGS: Press OK to delete all songs from the  
system’s memory. The display will read ARE YOU SURE ? Press OK to  
confirm deletion of all saved songs and the display will read ALL  
DELETED.  
Note: If there are no songs presently saved, the display will read NO  
SONGS.  
ENABLE ALERTS / DISABLE ALERTS: Press OK to enable/disable  
the satellite alert status which alerts you when your selected songs are  
playing on a satellite radio channel. (The system default is disabled.)  
SONG ALERTS ENABLED/DISABLED will appear in the display. The  
menu listing will display the opposite state. For example, if you have  
chosen to enable the song alerts, the menu listing will read DISABLE  
as the alerts are currently on, so your other option is to turn them off.  
Satellite radio is available only with a valid SIRIUS radio  
subscription. Check with your authorized dealer for availability.  
Setting the clock: Press MENU until SET HOURS or SET MINUTES is  
displayed. Use  
/
to manually increase/decrease. Press MENU  
again to disengage clock mode. Press OK to close and return to the main  
menu.  
AUTOSET: Press MENU until the display reads AUTOSET. Autoset  
allows you to set the strongest local radio stations without losing your  
original manually set preset stations for AM/FM1/FM2. Use  
turn on/off.  
/
to  
When the six strongest stations are filled, the station stored in preset 1  
will begin playing. If there are less than six strong stations, the system  
will store the last one in the remaining presets. Press OK to close and  
return to the main menu.  
RBDS: Available only in FM mode. This feature allows you to search  
RBDS-equipped stations for a certain category of music format:  
CLASSIC, COUNTRY, INFORM, JAZZ/RB, ROCK, etc.  
45  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Entertainment Systems  
To activate, press MENU repeatedly until RBDS (ON/OFF) appears in  
the display. Use  
/
/
SEEK  
to toggle RBDS ON/OFF. When  
RBDS is OFF, you will not be able to search for RBDS equipped stations  
or view the station name or type. Press OK to close and return to the  
main menu.  
To search for specific RBDS music categories: When the desired  
category appears in the display, press  
/
to find the desired type,  
then press and release  
begin the search.  
SEEK, SEEK  
or press and hold SCAN to  
To view the station name or type: When the desired category appears  
in the display, press TEXT/SCAN to toggle between displaying the station  
type (COUNTRY, ROCK, etc.) or the station name (WYCD, WXYT, etc.).  
BASS: Press MENU to reach the bass setting. Use  
/
to adjust.  
Press OK to close and return to the main menu.  
TREB (Treble): Press MENU to reach the treble setting. Use  
/
to adjust. Press OK to close and return to the main menu. Press OK to  
close and return to the main menu.  
BAL (Balance): Press MENU to reach the balance setting. Use  
/
to adjust the audio between the left (L) and right (R) speakers. Press  
OK to close and return to the main menu.  
FADE: Press MENU to reach the fade setting. Use  
/
to adjust the  
audio between the back (B) and front (F) speakers. Press OK to close  
and return to the main menu.  
SPEED VOL (Speed sensitive volume, if equipped): Press MENU to  
reach the SPEEDVOL setting. Radio volume automatically gets louder  
with increasing vehicle speed to compensate for road and wind noise.  
Use  
/
to adjust. Press OK to close and return to the main menu.  
The default setting is off; increasing your vehicle speed will not change  
the volume level.  
Adjust 1–7: Increasing this setting from 1 (lowest setting) to 7 (highest  
setting) allows the radio volume to automatically change slightly with  
vehicle speed to compensate for road and wind noise.  
Recommended level is 1–3; SPEED OFF turns the feature off and level 7  
is the maximum setting.  
46  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
TRACK/FOLDER MODE: Available only on MP3 discs in CD mode.  
In track mode, press  
SEEK, SEEK  
to scroll through all tracks on  
the disc  
In folder mode, press  
SEEK, SEEK  
to scroll through tracks  
within the selected folder.  
Press  
FOLDER, FOLDER  
to access the previous/next folder (if  
available).  
Press OK to close and return to the main menu.  
COMPRESS (Compression): Available only in CD/MP3 mode. Press  
MENU until COMPRESS ON/OFF appears in the display.  
Use  
/
/
SEEK, SEEK  
to toggle ON/OFF. When COMPRESS  
is ON, the system will bring the soft and loud CD passages together for a  
more consistent listening level. Press OK to close and return to the main  
menu.  
SINGLE PLAY/DUAL PLAY (if equipped): If SINGLE PLAY is ON,  
press  
/
for DUAL PLAY. For further information on Single  
Play/Dual Play, please refer to the Family Entertainment DVD system  
later in this chapter.  
4. AUX: Press repeatedly to cycle  
through FES/DVD (if equipped),  
LINE IN (auxiliary audio mode),  
SYNC(if equipped) and SAT1, SAT2 and SAT3 modes (satellite radio, if  
equipped).  
For location and further information on auxiliary audio mode, refer to  
Auxiliary input jack later in this chapter.  
Satellite radio is available only with a valid SIRIUS radio  
subscription. Check with your authorized dealer for availability.  
If your vehicle is equipped with a Family Entertainment System (FES)  
please refer to the Family Entertainment DVD system later in this  
chapter.  
If your vehicle is equipped with SYNC, please refer to the SYNC௡  
supplement for further information.  
5. SEEK: In radio mode,  
press  
previous/next strong station.  
In CD mode, press  
/
to access the  
/
to  
access the previous/next CD track.  
47  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
6.  
/
(Play/Pause): This  
control is operational in CD and  
DVD mode (if equipped). When a  
CD or DVD is playing in the FES system, press this control to play or  
pause the current CD or DVD. The CD/DVD status will display in the  
radio display.  
OK: Your vehicle may be equipped with special phone and media  
features which will require you to confirm commands by pressing OK.  
For further information, refer to the SYNCsupplement.  
If your vehicle is equipped with a Family Entertainment System (FES)  
please refer to the Family Entertainment DVD system later in this  
chapter.  
7. SHUFFLE: Press SHUFFLE to  
engage shuffle mode. SHUFFLE ON  
will appear in the display. If you  
wish to engage shuffle mode right away, press SEEK to begin random  
play. Otherwise, random play will begin when the current track is  
finished playing. CD SHUF will appear in the display.  
To disengage, press SHUFFLE. SHUFFLE OFF will appear in the display.  
Note: In track mode, all tracks on the current disc will shuffle in  
random order. In MP3 folder mode, the system will randomly play all  
tracks within the current folder.  
8. FOLDER  
press FOLDER  
: In folder mode,  
to access next  
folder on MP3 discs, if available.  
9.  
FOLDER: In folder mode,  
press  
FOLDER to access the  
previous folder on MP3 discs, if  
available.  
10. FF (Fast forward): Press FF  
to manually advance in a CD/MP3  
track.  
11. REW (Rewind): Press REW to  
manually reverse in a CD/MP3 track.  
12. Memory presets: To set a  
station, select the desired frequency  
band, AM, FM1 or FM2. Tune to the  
desired station. Press and hold a preset button until sound returns and  
48  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
PRESET # SAVED appears in the display. You can save up to 18 stations,  
six in AM, six in FM1 and FM2.  
In satellite radio mode (if equipped), there are 18 available presets,  
six each for SAT1, SAT2 and SAT3. To save satellite channels in your  
memory presets, tune to the desired channel then press and hold a  
preset control until sound returns.  
Satellite radio is available only with a valid SIRIUS radio  
subscription. Check with your authorized dealer for availability.  
13. TEXT/SCAN: In radio and  
CD/MP3 mode, press and hold for  
a brief sampling of radio stations or  
CD tracks. Press again to stop.  
In MP3 mode, press and release to display track title, artist name, and  
disc title.  
In satellite radio mode (if equipped), press and release to enter  
TEXT MODE and display the current song title. While in TEXT MODE,  
press again to scroll through the current song title, artist, channel  
category and the SIRIUS long channel name.  
In TEXT MODE, sometimes the display requires additional text to be  
displayed. When the “>” indicator is active, press SEEK  
to view the  
additional display text. When the “<” indicator is active, press  
to view the previous display text.  
SEEK  
In satellite radio mode (if equipped), press and hold to hear a brief  
sampling of the next channels. Press again to stop. In CATEGORY  
MODE, press SCAN to hear a brief sampling of the channels in the  
selected category. Press again to stop.  
Satellite radio is available only with a valid SIRIUS radio  
subscription. Check with your authorized dealer for availability.  
14. AM/FM: Press to select  
AM/FM1/FM2 frequency band.  
15. ON/OFF/Volume: Press to turn  
ON/OFF. Turn to increase/decrease  
volume.  
Note:If the volume is set above a  
certain level and the ignition is  
turned off, the volume will come back on at a “nominal” listening level  
when the ignition switch is turned back on.  
49  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
16. CD: Press to enter CD/MP3  
mode. If a CD/MP3 is already loaded  
into the system, CD/MP3 play will  
begin where it ended last. If no CD is loaded, NO DISC will appear in the  
display.  
17.  
(CD eject): Press to eject a  
CD.  
18. CD slot: Insert a CD label side  
up in the CD slot.  
Premium AM/FM in-dash six CD/MP3 satellite compatible sound  
system (if equipped)  
WARNING: Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle  
control, accident and injury. Ford strongly recommends that  
drivers use extreme caution when using any device that may take their  
focus off the road. The driver’s primary responsibility is the safe  
operation of their vehicle. Only use cell phones and other devices not  
essential to the driving task when it is safe to do so.  
50  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Entertainment Systems  
Accessory delay: Your vehicle is equipped with accessory delay. With  
this feature, the window switches, radio and moon roof (if equipped)  
may be used for up to ten minutes after the ignition is turned off or until  
either front door is opened.  
1.  
In radio mode, press to manually  
go up or down the radio  
/
(Tune/Disc selector):  
frequency. Press and hold for a fast  
advance through radio frequencies.  
In menu mode, use to select various settings.  
In CD/MP3 mode, press to select the desired disc.  
In satellite radio mode (if equipped), press  
/
to tune to the  
next/previous channel.  
In CATEGORY MODE, press  
/
to scroll through the list of  
available SIRIUS channel Categories (Pop, Rock, News, etc.). Refer to  
Category Mode under Menu for further information.  
Satellite radio is available only with a valid SIRIUS radio  
subscription. Check with your authorized dealer for availability.  
2.  
(Phone): If your vehicle is  
equipped with SYNC, press to  
access SYNC PHONE features. For  
further information, please refer to the SYNCsupplement.  
If your vehicle is not equipped with SYNC, the display will read NO  
PHONE.  
3. MENU: Press repeatedly to  
access the following settings:  
SATELLITE RADIO MENU (if equipped): Press MENU when satellite  
radio mode is active to access. Press OK to enter into the satellite radio  
menu. Press  
/
to cycle through the following options:  
CATEGORY: Press OK to enter category mode. Press  
/
to  
scroll through the list of available SIRIUS channel Categories (Pop,  
Rock, News, etc.) Press OK when the desired category appears in the  
display. After a category is selected, press SEEK to search for that  
specific category of channels only (i.e. ROCK). You may also select  
CATEGORY ALL to seek all available SIRIUS categories and channels.  
Press OK to close and return to the main menu.  
51  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
SAVE SONG: Press OK to save the currently playing song’s title in  
the system’s memory. (If you try to save something other than a song,  
CANT SAVE will appear in the display.) When the chosen song is  
playing on any satellite radio channel, the system will alert you with  
an audible prompt. Press OK while SONG ALERT is in the display and  
the system will take you to the channel playing the desired song. You  
can save up to 20 song titles. If you attempt to save more than 20  
titles, the display will read REPLACE SONG? Press OK to access the  
saved titles and press  
/
to cycle through the saved titles. When  
the song title appears in the display that you would like to replace,  
press OK. SONG REPLACED will appear in the display.  
DELETE SONG: Press OK to delete a song from the system’s  
memory. Press  
/
to cycle through the saved songs. When the  
song appears in the display that you would like to delete, press OK.  
The song will appear in the display for confirmation. Press OK again  
and the display will read SONG DELETED. If you do not want to  
delete the currently listed song, press  
RETURN or CANCEL.  
/
to select either  
Note: If there are no songs presently saved, the display will read NO  
SONGS.  
DELETE ALL SONGS: Press OK to delete all songs from the  
system’s memory. The display will read ARE YOU SURE ? Press OK to  
confirm deletion of all saved songs and the display will read ALL  
DELETED.  
Note: If there are no songs presently saved, the display will read NO  
SONGS.  
ENABLE ALERTS / DISABLE ALERTS: Press OK to enable/disable  
the satellite alert status which alerts you when your selected songs are  
playing on a satellite radio channel. (The system default is disabled.)  
SONG ALERTS ENABLED/DISABLED will appear in the display. The  
menu listing will display the opposite state. For example, if you have  
chosen to enable the song alerts, the menu listing will read DISABLE  
as the alerts are currently on, so your other option is to turn them off.  
Satellite radio is available only with a valid SIRIUS radio  
subscription. Check with your authorized dealer for availability.  
Setting the clock: Press MENU until SET HOURS or SET MINUTES is  
displayed. Use  
/
to manually increase/decrease. Press MENU  
again to disengage clock mode. Press OK to close and return to the main  
menu.  
52  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Entertainment Systems  
AUTOSET: Press MENU until the display reads AUTOSET. Autoset  
allows you to set the strongest local radio stations without losing your  
original manually set preset stations for AM/FM1/FM2.  
Use  
/
/
SEEK, SEEK  
to turn on/off.  
When the six strongest stations are filled, the station stored in preset 1  
will begin playing. If there are less than six strong stations, the system  
will store the last one in the remaining presets. Press OK to close and  
return to the main menu.  
RBDS: Available only in FM mode. This feature allows you to search  
RBDS-equipped stations for a certain category of music format:  
CLASSIC, COUNTRY, INFORM, JAZZ/RB, ROCK, etc.  
To activate, press MENU repeatedly until RBDS (ON/OFF) appears in  
the display. Use  
/
/
SEEK  
to toggle RBDS ON/OFF. When  
RBDS is OFF, you will not be able to search for RBDS equipped stations  
or view the station name or type. Press OK to close and return to the  
main menu.  
To search for specific RBDS music categories: When the desired  
category appears in the display, press  
/
to find the desired type,  
then press and release  
begin the search.  
SEEK, SEEK  
or press and hold SCAN to  
To view the station name or type: When the desired category appears  
in the display, press TEXT/SCAN to toggle between displaying the station  
type (COUNTRY, ROCK, etc.) or the station name (WYCD, WXYT, etc.).  
BASS: Press MENU to reach the bass setting. Use  
/
to adjust.  
Press OK to close and return to the main menu.  
TREB (Treble): Press MENU to reach the treble setting. Use  
/
to adjust. Press OK to close and return to the main menu.  
BAL (Balance): Press MENU to reach the balance setting. Use  
/
to adjust the audio between the left (L) and right (R) speakers. Press  
OK to close and return to the main menu.  
FADE: Press MENU to reach the fade setting. Use  
/
to adjust the  
audio between the back (B) and front (F) speakers. Press OK to close  
and return to the main menu.  
SPEED VOL (Speed sensitive volume, if equipped): Press MENU to  
reach the SPEEDVOL setting. Radio volume automatically gets louder  
with increasing vehicle speed to compensate for road and wind noise.  
Use  
/
to adjust. Press OK to close and return to the main menu.  
53  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
The default setting is off; increasing your vehicle speed will not change  
the volume level.  
Adjust 1–7: Increasing this setting from 1 (lowest setting) to 7 (highest  
setting) allows the radio volume to automatically change slightly with  
vehicle speed to compensate for road and wind noise.  
Recommended level is 1–3; SPEED OFF turns the feature off and level 7  
is the maximum setting.  
TRACK/FOLDER MODE: Available only on MP3 discs in CD mode.  
In track mode, press  
the disc  
SEEK, SEEK  
to scroll through all tracks on  
In folder mode, press  
SEEK, SEEK  
to scroll through tracks  
within the selected folder.  
Press  
FOLDER, FOLDER  
to access the previous/next folder (if  
available).  
Press OK to close and return to the main menu.  
COMPRESS (Compression): Available only in CD/MP3 mode. Press  
MENU until COMPRESS ON/OFF appears in the display.  
Use  
/
/
SEEK, SEEK  
to toggle ON/OFF. When COMPRESS  
is ON, the system will bring the soft and loud CD passages together for a  
more consistent listening level. Press OK to close and return to the main  
menu.  
ALL SEATS (Occupancy mode): Use  
/
to select and optimize  
sound for ALL SEATS, DRIVERS SEAT or REAR SEATS. Press OK to  
close and return to the main menu.  
SINGLE PLAY/DUAL PLAY (if equipped): If SINGLE PLAY is ON,  
press  
/
for DUAL PLAY. For further information on Single  
Play/Dual Play, please refer to the Family Entertainment DVD system  
later in this chapter.  
4. AUX: Press repeatedly to cycle  
through FES/DVD (if equipped),  
LINE IN (auxiliary audio mode),  
SYNC(if equipped) and SAT1, SAT2 and SAT3 modes (satellite radio, if  
equipped).  
For location and further information on auxiliary audio mode, refer to  
Auxiliary input jack later in this chapter.  
Satellite radio is available only with a valid SIRIUS radio  
subscription. Check with your authorized dealer for availability.  
54  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
If your vehicle is equipped with a Family Entertainment System (FES)  
please refer to the Family Entertainment DVD system later in this  
chapter.  
If your vehicle is equipped with the SYNC, please refer to the SYNC௡  
supplement for further information.  
5. SEEK: In radio and CD/MP3  
mode, press to access the previous  
(
) or next (  
or track.  
In satellite radio mode (if equipped), press  
the previous/next channel. If a specific category is selected, (Jazz, Rock,  
News, etc.), press SEEK, SEEK to seek to the previous/next  
) strong station  
SEEK  
to seek to  
channel in the selected category. Press and hold  
fast seek through the previous /next channels.  
SEEK, SEEK  
to view the  
to select a category.  
to  
In TEXT MODE, press  
SEEK, SEEK  
previous/additional display text.  
In CATEGORY MODE, press  
SEEK  
Satellite radio is available only with a valid SIRIUS subscription.  
Check with your authorized dealer for availability.  
6.  
/
(Play/Pause): This  
control is operational in CD and  
DVD mode (if equipped). When a  
CD or DVD is playing in the FES system, press this control to play or  
pause the current CD/DVD. The CD/DVD status will display in the radio  
display.  
OK: Your vehicle may be equipped with special phone and media  
features which will require you to confirm commands by pressing OK.  
For further information, refer to the SYNCsupplement.  
If your vehicle is equipped with a Family Entertainment System (FES)  
please refer to the Family Entertainment DVD system later in this  
chapter.  
7. SHUFFLE: Press SHUFFLE to  
engage shuffle mode. SHUFFLE ON  
will appear in the display. If you  
wish to engage shuffle mode right away, press SEEK to begin random  
play. Otherwise, random play will begin when the current track is  
finished playing. CD SHUF will appear in the display.  
To disengage, press SHUFFLE. SHUFFLE OFF will appear in the display.  
55  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
Note: In track mode, all tracks on the current disc will shuffle in  
random order. In MP3 folder mode, the system will randomly play all  
tracks within the current folder.  
8. FOLDER  
press FOLDER  
: In folder mode,  
to access next  
folder on MP3 discs, if available.  
9.  
FOLDER: In folder mode,  
press  
FOLDER to access the  
previous folder on MP3 discs, if  
available.  
10. FF (Fast forward): Press FF  
to manually advance in a CD.  
11. REW (Rewind): Press REW to  
manually reverse in a CD/MP3 track.  
12. Memory presets: To set a  
station, select the desired frequency  
band, AM, FM1 or FM2. Tune to the  
desired station. Press and hold a preset button until sound returns and  
PRESET # SAVED appears in the display. You can save up to 18 stations,  
six in AM, six in FM1 and FM2.  
In satellite radio mode (if equipped), there are 18 available presets,  
six each for SAT1, SAT2 and SAT3. To save satellite channels in your  
memory presets, tune to the desired channel then press and hold a  
preset control until sound returns.  
Satellite radio is available only with a valid SIRIUS radio  
subscription. Check with your authorized dealer for availability.  
13. TEXT/SCAN: In radio and  
CD/MP3 mode, press and hold for  
a brief sampling of radio stations or  
CD tracks. Press again to stop.  
In MP3 mode, press and release to display track title, artist name, and  
disc title.  
In satellite radio mode (if equipped), press and release to enter  
TEXT MODE and display the current song title. While in TEXT MODE,  
press again to scroll through the current song title, artist, channel  
category and the SIRIUS long channel name.  
56  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
Press and hold to hear a brief sampling of the next channels. Press again  
to stop.  
In CATEGORY MODE, press SCAN to hear a brief sampling of the  
channels in the selected category. Press again to stop.  
Satellite radio is available only with a valid SIRIUS radio  
subscription. Check with your authorized dealer for availability.  
In TEXT MODE, sometimes the display requires additional text to be  
displayed. When the “>” indicator is active, press SEEK  
additional display text. When the “<” indicator is active, press  
to view the previous display text.  
to view the  
SEEK  
14. AM/FM: Press to select  
AM/FM1/FM2 frequency band.  
15. ON/OFF/Volume: Press to turn  
ON/OFF. Turn to increase/decrease  
volume.  
Note:If the volume is set above a  
certain level and the ignition is  
turned off, the volume will come back on at a “nominal” listening level  
when the ignition switch is turned back on.  
16. CD: Press to enter CD mode. If  
a disc is already loaded into the  
system, CD/MP3 play will begin  
where it ended last. If no CD is loaded, NO DISC will appear in the  
display.  
17. LOAD: To load a disc into the  
system, press LOAD. Select a slot  
number using memory presets 1–6.  
When the display reads LOAD CD#,  
load the desired disc, label side up.  
If you do not choose a slot within five seconds, the system will choose  
for you. Once loaded, the first track will begin to play.  
To auto load up to 6 discs, press and hold LOAD until the display  
reads AUTOLOAD#. Load the desired disc, label side up. The system will  
prompt you to load discs for the remaining available slots. Insert the  
discs, one at a time, label side up, when prompted. Once loaded, the last  
loaded disc will begin to play.  
Note: An MP3 formatted disc with folders will show F001 (folder #)  
T001 (track #) in the display. An MP3 disc without folders will show  
T001 (track#) in the display. Refer to MP3 track and folder structure  
later in this chapter for further information.  
57  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
18.  
from the system, press  
the correct slot number using  
(CD eject): To eject a disc  
. Select  
memory presets 1–6. When ready, the system will eject the disc and the  
display will read REMOVE CD. If the disc is not removed in 15 seconds,  
the system will reload the disc.  
If there is only one disc present in the system, press  
.
To auto eject up to 6 CDs, press and hold until the system begins  
ejecting a loaded disc. Remove the disc and the next slot will be ejected.  
If the ejected disc is not removed from the slot, the system will reload  
the disc and cancel the auto eject function.  
19. CD slot: When prompted by the  
system, insert a CD label side up.  
Auxiliary input jack (Line in)  
WARNING: Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle  
control, accident and injury. Ford strongly recommends that  
drivers use extreme caution when using any device that may take their  
focus off the road. The driver’s primary responsibility is the safe  
operation of their vehicle. Only use cell phones and other devices not  
essential to the driving task when it is safe to do so.  
The Auxiliary Input Jack provides a  
way to connect your portable music  
player to the in-vehicle audio  
system. This allows the audio from a  
portable music player to be played  
through the vehicle speakers with  
high fidelity. To achieve optimal  
performance, please observe the  
following instructions when  
attaching your portable music  
device to the audio system.  
If your vehicle is equipped with a navigation system, refer to Auxiliary  
input jack section in the Audio features chapter of your Navigation  
system supplement.  
58  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Entertainment Systems  
Required equipment:  
1. Any portable music player designed to be used with headphones  
2. An audio extension cable with stereo male 1/8 in. (3.5 mm)  
connectors at each end  
To play your portable music player using the auxiliary input jack:  
1. Begin with the vehicle parked and the radio turned off.  
2. Ensure that the battery in your portable music player is new or fully  
charged and that the device is turned off.  
3. Attach one end of the audio extension cable to the headphone output  
of your player and the other end of the audio extension cable to the AIJ  
in your vehicle.  
4. Turn the radio on, using either a tuned FM station or a CD loaded into  
the system. Adjust the volume to a comfortable listening level.  
5. Turn the portable music player on and adjust the volume to 1/2 the  
volume.  
6. Press AUX on the vehicle radio repeatedly until LINE, LINE IN or  
SYNC LINE IN appears in the display.  
You should hear audio from your portable music player although it may  
be low.  
7. Adjust the sound on your portable music player until it reaches the  
level of the FM station or CD by switching back and forth between the  
AUX and FM or CD controls.  
Troubleshooting:  
1. Do not connect the audio input jack to a line level output. Line level  
outputs are intended for connection to a home stereo and are not  
compatible with the AIJ. The AIJ will only work correctly with devices  
that have a headphone output with a volume control.  
2. Do not set the portable music player’s volume level higher than is  
necessary to match the volume of the CD or FM radio in your audio  
system as this will cause distortion and will reduce sound quality. Many  
portable music players have different output levels, so not all players  
should be set at the same levels. Some players will sound best at full  
volume and others will need to be set at a lower volume.  
3. If the music sounds distorted at lower listening levels, turn the  
portable music player volume down. If the problems persists, replace or  
recharge the batteries in the portable music player.  
4. The portable music player must be controlled in the same manner  
when it is used with headphones as the AIJ does not provide control  
(play, pause, etc.) over the attached portable music player.  
59  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
5. For safety reasons, connecting or adjusting the settings on your  
portable music player should not be attempted while the vehicle is  
moving. Also, the portable music player should be stored in a secure  
location, such as the center console or the glove box, when the vehicle is  
in motion. The audio extension cable must be long enough to allow the  
portable music player to be safely stored while the vehicle is in motion.  
USB port (if equipped)  
WARNING: Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle  
control, accident and injury. Ford strongly recommends that  
drivers use extreme caution when using any device that may take their  
focus off the road. The driver’s primary responsibility is the safe  
operation of their vehicle. Only use cell phones and other devices not  
essential to the driving task when it is safe to do so.  
Your vehicle may be equipped with a  
USB port inside your center console.  
This feature allows you to plug in  
media playing devices, memory  
sticks, and also to charge devices if  
they support this feature. For  
further information on this feature,  
refer to Accessing and using your  
USB port in the SYNCsupplement  
or Navigation System supplement.  
GENERAL AUDIO INFORMATION  
Radio frequencies:  
AM and FM frequencies are established by the Federal Communications  
Commission (FCC) and the Canadian Radio and Telecommunications  
Commission (CRTC). Those frequencies are:  
AM: 530, 540–1700, 1710 kHz  
FM: 87.7, 87.9–107.7, 107.9 MHz  
Radio reception factors:  
There are three factors that can affect radio reception:  
Distance/strength: The further you travel from an FM station, the  
weaker the signal and the weaker the reception.  
Terrain: Hills, mountains, tall buildings, power lines, electric fences,  
traffic lights and thunderstorms can interfere with your reception.  
60  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Entertainment Systems  
Station overload: When you pass a broadcast tower, a stronger signal  
may overtake a weaker one and play while the weak station frequency  
is displayed.  
CD/CD player care  
Do:  
Handle discs by their edges only.  
(Never touch the playing  
surface).  
Inspect discs before playing.  
Clean only with an approved CD  
cleaner.  
Wipe discs from the center out.  
Don’t:  
Expose discs to direct sunlight or heat sources for extended periods  
of time.  
Clean using a circular motion.  
CD units are designed to play commercially pressed 4.75 in  
(12 cm) audio compact discs only. Due to technical  
incompatibility, certain recordable and re-recordable compact  
discs may not function correctly when used in Ford CD players.  
Do not use any irregular shaped  
CDs or discs with a scratch  
protection film attached.  
61  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
CDs with homemade paper  
(adhesive) labels should not be  
inserted into the CD player as  
the label may peel and cause the  
CD to become jammed. It is  
recommended that homemade  
CDs be identified with  
permanent felt tip marker rather  
than adhesive labels. Ballpoint pens may damage CDs. Please  
contact your authorized dealer for further information.  
Audio system warranty and service  
Refer to the Warranty Guide/Customer Information Guide for audio  
system warranty information. If service is necessary, see your dealer or  
qualified technician.  
MP3 track and folder structure  
Your MP3 system recognizes MP3 individual tracks and folder structure  
as follows:  
There are two different modes for MP3 disc playback: MP3 track mode  
(system default) and MP3 folder mode. For more information on track  
and folder mode, refer to Sample MP3 structure in the following  
section.  
MP3 track mode ignores any folder structure on the MP3 disc. The  
player numbers each MP3 track on the disc (noted by the .mp3 file  
extension) from T001 to a maximum of T255.  
Note: The maximum number of playable MP3 files may be less  
depending on the structure of the CD and exact model of radio  
present.  
MP3 folder mode represents a folder structure consisting of one level  
of folders. The CD player numbers all MP3 tracks on the disc (noted  
by the .mp3 file extension) and all folders containing MP3 files, from  
F001 (folder) T001 (track) to F253 T255.  
Creating discs with only one level of folders will help with navigation  
through the disc files.  
62  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
Sample MP3 structure  
If you are burning your own MP3  
discs, it is important to understand  
how the system will read the  
structures you create. While various  
files may be present, (files with  
extensions other than mp3), only  
files with the .mp3 extension will be  
played. Other files will be ignored  
by the system. This enables you to  
use the same MP3 disc for a variety  
of tasks on your work computer,  
home computer and your in vehicle  
system.  
.mp3  
.mp3  
1
1
2
3
.mp3  
2
3
4
5
.mp3  
.mp3  
.mp3  
4
6
7
.mp3  
.doc  
.ppt  
.xls  
In track mode, the system will display and play the structure as if it were  
only one level deep (all .mp3 files will be played, regardless of being in a  
specific folder). In folder mode, the system will only play the .mp3 files  
in the current folder.  
Satellite radio information (if equipped)  
Satellite radio channels: SIRIUS broadcasts a variety of music, news,  
sports, weather, traffic and entertainment satellite radio channels. For  
more information and a complete list of SIRIUS satellite radio channels,  
visit www.sirius.com in the United States, www.sirius-canada.ca in  
Canada, or call SIRIUS at 1–888–539–7474.  
Satellite radio reception factors: To receive the satellite signal, your  
vehicle has been equipped with a satellite radio antenna located on the  
roof of your vehicle. The vehicle roof provides the best location for an  
unobstructed, open view of the sky, a requirement of a satellite radio  
system. Like AM/FM, there are several factors that can affect satellite  
radio reception performance:  
Antenna obstructions: For optimal reception performance, keep the  
antenna clear of snow and ice build-up and keep luggage and other  
material as far away from the antenna as possible.  
63  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Entertainment Systems  
Terrain: Hills, mountains, tall buildings, bridges, tunnels, freeway  
overpasses, parking garages, dense tree foliage and thunderstorms can  
interfere with your reception.  
Station overload: When you pass a ground based broadcast repeating  
tower, a stronger signal may overtake a weaker one and result in an  
audio mute.  
Unlike AM/FM audible static, you will hear an audio mute when there is  
a satellite radio signal interference. Your radio display may display NO  
SIGNAL to indicate the interference.  
SIRIUS satellite radio service: SIRIUS Satellite Radio is a subscription  
based satellite radio service that broadcasts music, sports, news and  
entertainment programming. A service fee is required in order to receive  
SIRIUS service. Vehicles that are equipped with a factory installed  
SIRIUS Satellite Radio system include:  
Hardware and limited subscription term, which begins on the date of  
sale or lease of the vehicle.  
Use of online media player providing access to all SIRIUS music  
channels over the internet using any computer connected to the  
internet (U.S. customers only).  
For information on extended subscription terms, contact SIRIUS at  
1–888–539–7474.  
Note: SIRIUS reserves the unrestricted right to change, rearrange, add  
or delete programming including canceling, moving or adding particular  
channels, and its prices, at any time, with or without notice to you. Ford  
Motor Company shall not be responsible for any such programming  
changes.  
Satellite Radio Electronic Serial Number (ESN): This 12–digit  
Satellite Serial Number is needed to activate, modify or track your  
satellite radio account. You will need this number when communicating  
with SIRIUS. While in Satellite Radio mode, you can view this number on  
the radio display by pressing AUX and Preset 1 control simultaneously.  
64  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
Radio Display  
ACQUIRING  
Condition  
Action Required  
No action required.  
This message should  
disappear shortly.  
Radio requires more  
than two seconds to  
produce audio for the  
selected channel.  
Internal module or  
system failure  
SAT FAULT  
If this message does  
not clear within a short  
period of time, or with  
an ignition key cycle,  
your receiver may have  
a fault. See your  
present.  
authorized dealer for  
service.  
INVALID CHNL  
Channel no longer  
available.  
This previously  
available channel is no  
longer available. Tune  
to another channel. If  
the channel was one of  
your presets, you may  
choose another channel  
for that preset button.  
Contact SIRIUS at  
1–888–539–7474 to  
subscribe to the  
UNSUBSCRIBED  
NO TEXT  
Subscription not  
available for this  
channel.  
channel or tune to  
another channel.  
Artist information not Artist information not  
available.  
available at this time on  
this channel. The  
system is working  
properly.  
65  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
Radio Display  
NO TEXT  
Condition  
Action Required  
Song title information Song title information  
not available.  
not available at this  
time on this channel.  
The system is working  
properly.  
NO TEXT  
Category information  
not available.  
Category information  
not available at this  
time on this channel.  
The system is working  
properly.  
NO SIGNAL  
Loss of signal from  
the SIRIUS satellite or  
SIRIUS tower to the  
vehicle antenna.  
You are in a location  
that is blocking the  
SIRIUS signal (i.e.,  
tunnel, under an  
overpass, dense foliage,  
etc). The system is  
working properly. When  
you move into an open  
area, the signal should  
return.  
UPDATING  
Update of channel  
programming in  
progress.  
No action required. The  
process may take up to  
three minutes.  
CALL SIRIUS  
1–888–539–7474  
Satellite service has  
been deactivated by  
SIRIUS Satellite  
Radio.  
Call SIRIUS at  
1–888–539–7474 to  
re-activate or resolve  
subscription issues.  
FAMILY ENTERTAINMENT DVD SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)  
WARNING: Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle  
control, accident and injury. Ford strongly recommends that  
drivers use extreme caution when using any device that may take their  
focus off the road. The driver’s primary responsibility is the safe  
operation of their vehicle. Only use cell phones and other devices not  
essential to the driving task when it is safe to do so.  
66  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Entertainment Systems  
Your vehicle may be equipped with a Family Entertainment System  
(FES) which allows you to listen to audio CDs, MP3 discs, watch DVDs  
and to plug in and play a variety of standard video game systems. The  
DVD player is capable of playing standard DVDs, CDs, MP3s and is  
compatible with CD-R/W, CD-R and certain CD-ROM media.  
Please review this material to become familiar with the FES features and  
controls as well as the very important safety information.  
Note: Any notations or restrictions on individual DVD system controls  
are applicable to the overhead controls as well as to duplicate controls  
found on the remote control.  
Quick start  
Your Family Entertainment System includes a DVD system, two sets of  
wireless infrared (IR) headphones and a wireless infrared (IR) remote  
control.  
Note: To disable the DVD rear-seat controls:  
If your vehicle is equipped with the navigation system, press the  
MEDIA or RADIO hard button. Select the ’Rear Zone’ tab on the  
touchscreen. Press the ’disabled’ button. (Press the ’enabled’ button to  
turn the rear controls on again.)  
If your vehicle is equipped with an audio system, press the 3 and 5  
preset buttons simultaneously. (Press again to enable the controls).  
To play a DVD in the DVD system:  
The DVD system can play DVD-Video, DVD-R, DVD-R/W discs as well as  
audio CDs and video CDs. To ensure proper disc operation, check the  
disc for finger prints, scratches and cleanliness. Clean with a soft cloth,  
wiping from center to edge.  
1. Ensure that the vehicle is on or the ignition is in accessory mode.  
2. Insert a DVD into the system, label-side up to turn on the system. It  
will load automatically.  
3. Press the power button on the  
DVD player, then press Play  
begin to play the disc.  
to  
If a DVD is already loaded into the  
system, press PLAY on the DVD  
player.  
Note: If sound can be heard, but no video is present, press VIDEO to  
select the video source (DVD or aux-inputs).  
67  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
Note (navigation-based radio  
systems only): When a disc is  
inserted, the FES switches to  
dual-play mode–rear speakers turn off, and headphones turn on. To  
switch back to all four speakers on, press the headphone button.  
Press VIDEO to change the source  
displayed on the screen. Press  
repeatedly to cycle through:  
DVD-DISC, DVD-AUX, NON-DVD,  
OFF.  
Press the power button to turn the  
system off. The indicator light will  
turn off indicating the system is off.  
Note: The audio from the DVD system will play over all vehicle speakers  
and can be adjusted by the radio volume control.  
To play a CD in the DVD system:  
The DVD system can play audio CDs, CD-R and CD-R/W, CD-ROM and  
video CDs. To ensure proper disc operation, check the disc for finger  
prints and scratches. Clean the disc with a soft cloth, wiping from the  
center to the edge.  
1. Ensure that the vehicle is on or the ignition is in accessory mode.  
2. Insert a CD into the system,  
label-side up to turn on the DVD  
system. It will load and  
automatically begin to play. If there  
is already a CD in the system, press  
PLAY on the DVD player.  
3. The disc will begin to play and  
the ‘CD Audio Disc’ screen will  
display. From this screen, you can  
also select from COMPRESSION,  
SHUFFLE and SCAN features.  
68  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
Note (navigation-based radio  
systems only): When a disc is  
inserted, the FES switches to  
dual-play mode–rear speakers turn off, and headphones turn on. To  
switch back to all four speakers on, press the headphone button.  
To play an MP3 disc in the DVD system:  
1. Ensure that the vehicle is on or the ignition is in accessory mode.  
2. Insert an MP3 disc into the  
system, label-side up to turn on the  
DVD system. It will load and  
automatically begin to play. If there  
is already a disc in the system, press  
PLAY on the DVD player.  
3. The disc will begin to play and  
the ‘MP3 Audio Disc’ screen will  
display and allow you to access the  
COMPRESSION, SHUFFLE, SCAN  
and FOLDER MODE features.  
Note (navigation-based radio  
systems only): When a disc is  
inserted, the FES switches to  
dual-play mode–rear speakers turn off, and headphones turn on. To  
switch back to all four speakers on, press the headphone button.  
To play an auxiliary source through the DVD system  
The DVD system can be used to connect and play auxiliary electronic  
devices such as game systems, personal camcorders, video cassette  
recorders, etc.  
1. Ensure that the vehicle is on or the ignition is in accessory mode.  
2. Press the power button to turn  
the DVD system on. The indicator  
light next to the power button will  
illuminate.  
69  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
3. Connect an auxiliary audio/video  
source by connecting RCA cords  
(not included) to the RCA jacks on  
the left hand side of the system.  
Yellow (1) — video input  
White (2) — left channel audio  
input  
Red (3) — right channel audio  
input  
4. Press MEDIA on the DVD system to change the media source to AUX.  
5. Press VIDEO on the DVD system to change the video source to  
DVD-AUX. If your source is properly plugged in, it will appear on the  
LCD (Liquid Crystal Display) screen. If your auxiliary source does not  
have a video signal, or if the DVD system does not detect a video signal  
from the auxiliary source, the screen will remain black. If the video  
source is set to DVD-AUX, the display will automatically turn on if a  
video signal is detected.  
To listen to audio over the headphones— Dual play mode  
(Navigation-based radio systems only):  
You may listen to channels A and B over wired or wireless headphones.  
Refer to Using the infrared wireless headphones and Using wired  
headphones for further information.  
Black (4) — wired headphone output (wired headphones not  
included)  
There are two ways to get into dual  
play mode:  
1. After initially switching ignition  
on, when a is disc inserted, the FES immediately switches to dual-play  
mode.  
2. Press the headphone/speaker  
navigation radio touch screen.  
/
button on the DVD player or  
3. Press the 2 and 4 memory presets on the radio at the same time.  
Repeating each of these actions will switch back to single play mode, all  
speakers playing and headphones off.  
A green light will illuminate next to either the A or B Headphone Control  
Button to indicate which channel is active (able to be controlled).  
70  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
4. Press MEDIA to change the audio source of the active channel (A or  
B). The audio source will be shown on the display. You may change the  
active channel by pressing the A or B headphone control button.  
Note: Channel A can access any possible media source (AM, FM1, FM2,  
SAT (if equipped), CD, DVD, AUX). Channel B can only access DVD and  
AUX sources.  
Note: Refer to Single play/Dual play for more information.  
To listen to audio over the headphones— Dual play mode  
(Non-navigation based radio systems):  
You may listen to channels A and B over wired or wireless headphones.  
Refer to Using the infrared wireless headphones and Using wired  
headphones for further information.  
Black (4) — wired headphone output (wired headphones not  
included)  
1. Press the  
headphone/speaker  
/
button  
on the DVD player or press the 2  
and 4 memory presets on the radio at the same time.  
A green light will illuminate next to either the A or B Headphone Control  
Button to indicate which channel is active (able to be controlled).  
2. Press MEDIA to change the audio source of the active channel (A or  
B). The audio source will be shown on the display. You may change the  
active channel by pressing the A or B headphone control button.  
Note: Channel A can access any possible media source (AM, FM1, FM2,  
SAT (if equipped), CD, DVD, AUX). Channel B can only access DVD and  
AUX sources.  
Note: Refer to Single play/Dual play for more information.  
Using the infrared (IR) wireless headphones:  
1. Press the power control on the earpiece to turn the headphones ON.  
2. Select Channel A or B for each set of wireless headphones by using  
the A/B control on the ear piece.  
3. Adjust the headphone volume using the rotary dial on the earpiece.  
71  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
Using wired headphones (not included):  
WARNING: Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle and  
do not let children operate the system while unsupervised. If  
wired headphones or auxiliary systems are used, children may become  
entangled in the cords and seriously injure themselves.  
1. Connect the wired headphones in to the headphone jacks on either  
side of the DVD system. Each side is labeled  
A or  
B. Headphones  
plugged into jack A will listen to Channel A and headphones plugged into  
jack B will listen to Channel B.  
2. Adjust the volume levels using  
the volume controls on the DVD  
system.  
To adjust display brightness:  
To decrease/increase the brightness  
level on the display screen, press  
the brightness control on the DVD  
system. A display will appear at the  
bottom of the screen indicating the  
brightness level. The brightness display will only appear when the menu  
is not displayed.  
72  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
DVD player controls  
16  
1
2
6
4
3
5
A
B
ENTER  
MENU  
RETURN  
MEDIA  
VIDEO  
VOLUME  
10  
14  
12  
7
15 13  
11  
8
9
1. Headphone control A/B: While  
in Dual Play mode, press to select  
either the A or B headphone source.  
Then press MEDIA to select the  
desired playing media for that  
headset. When a headphone channel has been selected (A or B),  
selections will affect the source on that channel only.  
Note: Headphone A can access any possible media (AM, FM1, FM2, SAT  
(if equipped), CD, DVD, DVD-AUX). Headphone B can only access DVD  
and DVD-AUX.  
For further information, refer to Single play/Dual play later in this  
section.  
2.  
/
(Stop/Eject): Press  
once to stop and press a second  
time to eject a disc from the DVD  
system.  
3.  
(Reverse): Press and  
release for the previous chapter or  
track. Press and hold to reverse  
search a DVD, Video CD, or FES CD in DVD/CD mode.  
73  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
4.  
(Fast forward): Press and  
release for the next chapter or  
track. Press and hold to forward  
search a DVD, Video CD, or FES CD in DVD/CD mode.  
5.  
/
(Play/Pause): Press  
(Play) to select DVD mode (and to  
turn the DVD system on if it is off).  
If a disc is present, it will resume or begin to play. Press (Pause) while  
playing a disc to pause a DVD or CD.  
6. On/Off: Press to turn the DVD  
system On/Off.  
7. VIDEO: Press repeatedly to cycle  
through the following video state  
options which will be indicated on  
the bottom right hand corner of the  
display: DVD DISC, DVD-AUX,  
NON-DVD and Off (no indicator). If you select the DVD-AUX video  
source, the display will turn off if there is no video signal detected. When  
a video signal is detected on the auxiliary video input, and the display is  
in the DVD-AUX video mode, the display will automatically turn on.  
8. Infrared (IR) Receiver & Transmitter: System sensor which reads  
the signals from the remote control and sends audio signals to the  
infrared (IR) wireless headphones.  
9. LCD screen: The eight inch diagonal screen rotates down to view and  
up into housing to store when not in use. Ensure that the screen is  
latched into the housing when being stored.  
10. Volume: If your vehicle is  
equipped with a navigation system,  
this function is only available when  
in dual play mode. For all other  
vehicles, when in single play mode,  
press to increase (  
) or decrease (  
) the volume over all speakers.  
) or decrease ( ) the volume  
When in Dual Play, press to increase (  
for the wired headphones. (Wireless headphone volume is controlled  
with the rotary dial on the right ear piece.)  
74  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
11.  
/
(Headphones/Speakers): Press once for Dual Play  
(Headphone mode- the rear speakers are muted) and press again for  
Single Play (same media playing through all speakers). You can also  
press the 2 and 4 memory preset buttons on the audio system at the  
same time to perform the same function. For further interaction  
information, refer to Single Play/Dual play under Operation later in  
this section.  
12. MEDIA: Press repeatedly to  
select from the various possible  
playing media sources (AM, FM1,  
FM2, SAT (if equipped), CD, DVD, DVD-AUX). The media will show in  
the status display on the top of the screen when in Dual Play mode.  
When in Single Play mode, the media source will be displayed on the  
radio.  
Note: Channel A can access any possible media source (AM, FM1, FM2,  
SAT (if equipped), CD, DVD, DVD-AUX). Channel B can only access  
DVD and DVD-AUX sources.  
Note: If your vehicle is equipped with a navigation system, this function  
is only active in dual play mode.  
13. RETURN: Press to return to the  
playing media or to resume  
playback.  
14. MENU: When playing a DVD,  
press MENU once to enter the DVD  
disc menu (if available) and press  
twice to enter the system set-up menu. From the set-up menu, you may  
select from Angle, Aspect Ratio, Language, Subtitles, Disc resume,  
Compression, Restore Defaults and Back. For more detailed information,  
refer to Menu mode.  
15. ENTER: Press to select/confirm  
the current selection.  
16. Cursor /Brightness controls:  
Use the cursor controls to make  
various selections when in any  
menu. When not in a menu, and in  
DVD mode, press  
/
to adjust  
the brightness. A display bar will appear at the bottom of the screen  
indicating the brightness levels.  
75  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
Remote control  
Unless otherwise stated, all operations can be carried out with the  
remote control. Always point the remote control directly at the player.  
Ensure that there are no obstructions between the remote and player.  
1. Power control: Press to turn the FES (Family Entertainment  
System) ON/OFF.  
2. Cursor controls: Use in various active menus to advance the cursor  
up/down/left/right. When not in a Menu, the left and right cursor controls  
decrease and increase the display brightness.  
3. DISPLAY: Press to access the on-screen display of the FES functions  
and adjustments.  
4. RETURN: Press to return to the previous menu screen.  
5. ANGLE (DVD dependent): Press to select the angle to view the  
scene.  
6. Channel A/B: Press to select either A or B headphones and then use  
the MEDIA control to select the desired playing media for the  
headphones.  
76  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
7. VOL (Volume): When in Single Play, press to increase (  
) or  
decrease (  
) the volume over all speakers. When in Dual Play, press to  
increase (  
) or decrease (  
) the volume for the wired headphones.  
(Wireless headphone volume is controlled with the rotary dial on the  
right ear piece.)  
8. Fast Forward/Next: In DVD mode, press and hold for a quick  
advance within the DVD. Press and release to advance to the next  
chapter. In CD/MP3 mode, press to access the next track.  
9. Play/Pause: Press to play or pause a DVD.  
10. SHUFFLE: Press to play all tracks on the current CD/MP3 disc in  
random order.  
11. STOP: Press to stop the current DVD or CD/MP3.  
12.  
/
Speaker/Headphone (Single/Dual Play): Press to toggle  
between Single Play (same media playing through all speakers) and Dual  
Play (headphone mode — the rear speakers are muted). You can also  
press the 2 and 4 memory presets on the audio system at the same time  
to perform the same function.  
13. Numeric Keypad: Use the numeric controls to enter in a specific  
CD/MP3 track or DVD chapter to be played.  
14. C (Cancel): Press to cancel/clear the numeric input (i.e. chapter  
number).  
15. MEDIA: Press to cycle through the possible media sources: AM,  
FM1, FM2, SAT (if equipped), CD, DVD, LINE IN (if equipped),  
DVD-AUX.  
Channel B can only access DVD and AUX sources.  
16. VIDEO: Press to cycle through video states: DVD-DISC, DVD-AUX,  
NON-DVD, Off.  
17. EJECT: Press to eject a disc from the FES.  
18. Fast reverse/Previous: When a DVD is playing, press and hold for a  
quick reverse within the DVD. Press and release for the previous  
chapter. Press PLAY to resume normal playback speed and volume.  
In CD/MP3 mode, press to access the previous track.  
19. MENU: Press to access the DVD disc menu for selections. Press  
MENU again when in the DVD disc menu to access the system set-up  
menu.  
20. SUBTITLE (DVD dependent): Press to turn the subtitle feature ON  
or OFF.  
77  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
21. LANGUAGE (DVD dependent): Press to select the desired  
language.  
22. ENTER: Press to select the highlighted menu option.  
23. ILLUMINATION: Press to illuminate the remote control and  
backlight all of the buttons.  
Battery replacement  
Batteries are supplied with the  
remote control unit. Since all  
batteries have a limited shelf life,  
replace them when the unit fails to  
control the DVD player.  
Remove the screw and unlatch the battery cover to access the batteries.  
The remote control unit uses two AAA batteries which are supplied with  
the unit.  
78  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
Headphones  
Wireless headphones  
WARNING: The driver should never use the headphones while  
driving the vehicle. Using headphones may prevent the driver  
from hearing audible warnings such as horns or emergency sirens,  
which could result in a crash causing serious injury. Give your full  
attention to driving and to the road.  
Your FES system is equipped with  
two sets of battery powered,  
infrared wireless headphones. Two  
AAA batteries are needed to operate  
the headphones. (Batteries are  
included.)  
Additional infrared wireless  
headphones may be purchased for  
use with the system. Also, wired  
headphones may be purchased and  
plugged in where indicated on the  
left and right hand sides of the  
system. Refer to Wired  
Headphones following.  
79  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
To install the batteries, remove the screw at the bottom of the cover.  
Then, lightly press down on top and slide the cover off.  
When replacing the batteries, use two new batteries (alkaline  
recommended) and install them with the correct orientation as indicated  
in the battery housing.  
80  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
To operate the headphones:  
Press POWER on the ear piece to turn on the headphones. A red  
indicator light will illuminate indicating the headphones are ON. Press  
POWER again to turn the headphones off.  
Adjust the headphones to comfortably fit your head using the  
headband adjustment.  
Select the desired audio source (Channel A or B) for each set of  
wireless headphones by using the A/B selection switch on the ear  
piece.  
Adjust the volume control to the desired listening level.  
Ensure that the headphones are turned off when not in use. After  
approximately one minute of not being in use (no infrared signal is  
received), the wireless headphones will automatically turn off. They will  
also turn off after two hours of continuous use as a power save feature.  
If this happens, simply turn the headphones on again and continue use.  
81  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
Wired headphones  
WARNING: Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle and  
do not let children operate the system while unsupervised. If  
wired headphones or auxiliary systems are used, children may become  
entangled in the cords and seriously injure themselves.  
WARNING: The driver should never use the headphones while  
driving the vehicle. Using headphones may prevent the driver  
from hearing audible warnings such as horns or emergency sirens,  
which could result in a crash causing serious injury. Give your full  
attention to driving and to the road.  
You may purchase wired headphones for your FES (Family  
Entertainment System). Plug them into the 3.5 mm headphone jack(s)  
located on the left and right sides of the system. (Channel A is located  
on the left side and Channel B is located on the right side.) These  
headphones will be active when in Dual Play mode.  
To listen to the audio on wired headphones (not included), connect the  
wired headphones into the headphone jacks on the sides of the DVD  
system. The wired headphone jack for Channel A is located on the left  
side of the FES and is labeled  
A. Headphones plugged into this  
headphone jack will hear audio from the audio source selected to be the  
Channel A source. The wired headphone jack for Channel B is located on  
the right side of the FES and is labeled  
B. Headphones plugged into  
this headphone jack will hear audio from the audio source selected to be  
the Channel B source.  
Adjust the headphone volume using  
the volume control on the DVD  
system.  
Operation  
Single play/Dual play  
Your DVD and audio system work together with the infrared headphones  
and wired headphones (not included) to allow the rear seat passengers  
to listen to the radio (and other media sources) over the headphones.  
This enables the front and rear seat passengers to listen to a variety of  
sources a variety of ways.  
82  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
Single Play: Single play consists of all occupants in the vehicle listening  
to the same playing media over the front and rear speakers. When the  
DVD system is on, and the same source is playing through the front and  
rear speakers, SINGLE PLAY will appear in the front radio display.  
Dual Play (navigation-based radio systems only): Dual play is when  
the rear seat passengers choose to listen to a different playing media  
than the front seat passengers. With the DVD and rear seat controls  
turned ON, the rear seat passengers may choose to listen to the radio,  
CD, MP3, SYNC, DVD, or DVD-AUX media sources over headphones  
while the front speakers play the chosen selection for the front audio  
system, they may listen to another over the headphones. DUAL PLAY  
will appear in the radio display.  
When both the front seat passengers and the rear seat passengers listen  
to the same audio source, SHARED MODE will appear on the radio.  
Note: If the front seat passengers are listening to the radio, the rear seat  
passengers can also listen to the radio; however, they will be limited to  
listening to the same radio channel.  
There are two ways to get into dual play mode:  
1. After initially turning ignition on, when a disc is inserted, the FES  
immediately switches to dual-play mode.  
2. Press  
the  
/
headphone/speaker  
button on the DVD player or  
navigation radio touch screen.  
3. Press the 2 and 4 memory presets on the radio at the same time.  
Repeating each of these actions will switch back to single play mode, all  
speakers playing and headphones off.  
The headphone control will now be active and a green light next to the  
A or B headphone control buttons will illuminate. The system can output  
two different audio sources over the headphones. These are called  
Channel A and Channel B. Both Channel A and Channel B can be  
listened to on the wired headphones (not included) or on the infrared  
(IR) wireless headphones.  
Press the Headphone Control button  
A to change the audio source for  
Channel A.  
83  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
Press MEDIA to change the audio  
source for Channel A. This  
information will display on the DVD  
system screen.  
Press the Headphone Control button  
B to change the audio source for  
Channel B.  
Press MEDIA to change the audio source for Channel B. This information  
will display on the DVD system screen. Channel B can listen to either  
the DVD media or the DVD system auxiliary inputs (DVD-AUX).  
Dual Play (non-navigation based radio systems): Dual play is when  
the rear seat passengers choose to listen to a different playing media  
than the front seat passengers. With the DVD and rear seat controls  
turned ON, the rear seat passengers may choose to listen to the radio,  
CD, MP3, DVD, or DVD-AUX media sources over headphones while the  
front speakers play the chosen selection for the front audio system, they  
may listen to another over the headphones. DUAL PLAY will appear in  
the radio display.  
When both the front seat passengers and the rear seat passengers listen  
to the same audio source, SHARED MODE will appear on the radio.  
Note: If the front seat passengers are listening to the radio, the rear seat  
passengers can also listen to the radio; however, they will be limited to  
listening to the same radio channel.  
Press the  
/
headphone/speaker  
button on the DVD player or  
navigation radio touch screen.  
The headphone control will now be active and a green light next to the  
A or B headphone control buttons will illuminate. The system can output  
two different audio sources over the headphones. These are called  
Channel A and Channel B. Both Channel A and Channel B can be  
listened to on the wired headphones (not included) or on the infrared  
(IR) wireless headphones.  
Press the Headphone Control button  
A to change the audio source for  
Channel A.  
84  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
Press MEDIA to change the audio  
source for Channel A. This  
information will display on the DVD  
system screen.  
Press the Headphone Control button  
B to change the audio source for  
Channel B.  
Press MEDIA to change the audio source for Channel B. This information  
will display on the DVD system screen. Channel B can listen to either  
the DVD media or the DVD system auxiliary inputs (DVD-AUX).  
Operation with an aftermarket audio system  
(Headphone only mode)  
When the Family Entertainment System (FES) detects that the original  
radio supplied by Ford Motor Company has been removed from the  
vehicle, the Family Entertainment System will work in a state referred to  
as “Headphone Only Mode”.  
While operating in Headphone Only Mode, the system will have limited  
functionality.  
The system will only output audio to the headphones. It will not be  
capable of providing audio to the speakers.  
The available sources in FES Headphone Only Mode are DVD-DISC  
and DVD-AUX, regardless of headphone channel (A or B).  
When a disc is inserted into the FES while in Headphone Only Mode,  
both headphone channels (A&B) will be connected to FES-DISC.  
85  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
Menu mode  
Press MENU once on the DVD system to access the DVD disc menu if  
available.  
Press MENU twice to access the DVD set-up menu and the following  
features:  
1. ZOOM  
2. ANGLE  
3. ASPECT RATIO  
4. LANGUAGE  
5. SUB TITLES  
Angle mode  
Select ANGLE to select various  
angles of view for the DVD.  
This is disc dependent — some  
DVD discs may have more viewing  
angles to select from. Once you  
have made your selection, press  
ENTER to confirm. The system  
default is Angle 1.  
Aspect ratio  
Select ASPECT RATIO to select the  
viewing size and shape of the video  
displayed on the LCD screen. This is  
disc dependent.  
86  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
You can select from: WIDE, LETTER  
BOX or PAN SCAN. Once you have  
made your selection, press ENTER  
to confirm. The LCD screen display  
will immediately change to your  
selection after the system resumes  
playback of the DVD. The system  
default is WIDE (16:9).  
Language  
Select LANGUAGE to select the  
language you would like to use for  
audio output (English, Spanish,  
French). This is disc dependent.  
Once you have made your selection,  
press ENTER to confirm. The  
system default is English.  
Subtitles  
Select SUBTITLES to turn the  
subtitle option on or off. The system  
default is OFF.  
87  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
Once you have made your selection,  
press ENTER to confirm. This is  
disc dependent.  
Audio CDs  
To play audio CDs on your DVD system:  
1. Ensure that the vehicle is on or the ignition is in accessory mode.  
2. Ensure that the DVD system is on.  
3. Insert an audio CD into the DVD system, label side up.  
4. The track and elapsed time will  
appear in the status bar. Use the  
DVD cursor controls on the bezel to  
highlight which track you would like  
to play. You can also use the cursor  
controls to highlight  
COMPRESSION, SHUFFLE or  
SCAN. Once you have highlighted  
the desired track or function, press ENTER on the DVD bezel to confirm  
your selection.  
COMP (Compression): Compression brings soft and loud CD passages  
together for a more consistent listening level when in CD mode. Press to  
turn the feature on/off.  
SHUFFLE: Press to hear all tracks on the current CD in random order.  
Press again to stop.  
SCAN: Press for a brief sampling of all tracks on the current CD. Press  
again to stop.  
Playing MP3 discs  
To play an MP3 disc on your DVD system:  
1. Ensure that the vehicle is on or the ignition is in accessory mode.  
2. Ensure that the DVD system is on.  
3. Insert the MP3 disc into the DVD system, label side up.  
88  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
4. The folder, track and elapsed  
time will appear in the status bar.  
The screen will list the Artist, Title,  
Album and File Name.  
COMP (Compression):  
Compression brings soft and loud  
CD/MP3 passages together for a  
more consistent listening level when  
in CD mode. Press to turn the feature on/off.  
SHUFFLE: Press to hear all tracks on the current MP3 folder in random  
order. Press again to stop.  
SCAN: Press for a brief sampling of all tracks on the current MP3 folder.  
Press again to stop.  
FOLDER LIST: Press access folder mode and to go to the previous/next  
folder in the MP3 disc.  
MP3 disc quality factors  
Several factors can effect disc playback quality:  
Disc capacity — Each disc contains about 650 MB of storage capacity.  
We do not recommend using high capacity discs containing 700MB of  
storage.  
Disc type — Some CD-RW discs may operate inconsistently and may  
cause an error message to appear. We recommend burning MP3 files  
onto CD-R discs.  
Disc finalization — The disc may be left open for the purpose of  
adding sessions to it at a later time, but be sure to close each session  
or the disc will not play.  
Bit rate — The player supports bit rates from 32–320 kbps, as well as  
variable bit rate MP3 files, but lower bit rates will have a noticeable  
effect on sound quality and are recommended only for speech or low  
fidelity music material. We recommend that you encode MP3 files  
using a high quality encoder.  
PC configuration — Encoding MP3 files requires intensive use of your  
computer’s resources. Follow the PC configuration recommendations  
of the encoder software vendor. We recommend that you avoid  
running other software applications on your PC during MP3 encoding  
to avoid undesirable noise and distortion.  
89  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
CD, MP3 and CD player care  
Handle discs by their edges only. Never touch the playing surface.  
Do not expose discs to direct sunlight or heat sources for extended  
periods of time.  
Do not insert more than one disc into the slot of the CD player (if  
equipped).  
Always store discs out of direct sunlight. Excessive heat may damage  
or warp discs.  
Use care when handling and playing CD-R and CD-RW discs, which  
are more susceptible to damage from heat, light and stress than are  
regular CDs.  
Always insert and remove a disc by holding the disc flat, with the  
playing surface facing down, in order to prevent damage to the disc or  
the player.  
Never insert any object other than a compact disc (CD) or digital  
versatile disc (DVD) into the player, as doing so may damage the  
player and may cause injury to you.  
Do not disassemble the player. The laser used in disc playback is  
extremely harmful to the eyes.  
The FES DVD system is designed to play commercially pressed  
12 cm (4.75 in) audio compact discs and digital versatile discs  
(DVD), DVD-R and R/W discs only. Due to technical  
incompatibility, certain recordable and re-recordable compact  
discs may not function correctly when used in Ford CD and DVD  
players. Irregular shaped CDs or DVDs, CDs or DVDs with a  
scratch protection film attached, and CDs with homemade paper  
(adhesive) labels should not be inserted into the FES DVD  
system. The label may peel and cause the CD or DVD to become  
jammed. It is recommended that homemade CDs or DVDs be  
identified with permanent felt tip marker rather than adhesive  
labels. Ball point pens may damage CDs or DVDs. Please contact  
your authorized dealer for further information.  
Playing a DVD  
1. Ensure that the vehicle is on or the ignition is in accessory mode.  
2. Ensure that the navigation system is on.  
3. Insert a DVD label-side up into the system.  
90  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
4. Use the DVD bezel controls to:  
Press to play or pause a DVD.  
Press to stop or eject a DVD.  
Press and release to go to the  
previous chapter. Press and hold for  
a fast reverse search.  
Press and release to go to the next  
chapter. Press and hold for a fast  
forward search.  
Press when not in menu mode to  
adjust brightness, or when in menu  
mode to navigate through the menu  
selections.  
Press to adjust volume levels.  
Slow play  
1. With a DVD playing, press pause.  
2. Press and hold the reverse or  
advance button to enter into slow  
play mode. Once in slow play mode,  
press and release the reverse or advance button repeatedly to cycle  
through 1/4 and 1/2. These will display on the status bar on top of the  
screen as the screens cycle through at this rate.  
Frame by frame  
1. With a DVD playing, press pause.  
91  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
2. Press the right cursor button. The  
DVD will advance one frame. Each  
press of the right cursor button will  
advance the DVD video by one  
frame.  
Headphone/auxiliary jacks  
There are wired headphones (not included) and auxiliary jacks on the  
left and right side of your DVD system. They can be used to plug in  
wired headphones or to connect and play auxiliary electronic devices  
such as game systems, personal camcorders, video cassette recorders,  
etc.  
On the left side of the system is the  
Headphone A input jack. This  
headphone will listen to the media  
selected on the Channel A source.  
When you need to make any  
adjustments to the media, volume,  
etc, ensure that the Channel A  
source is highlighted.  
Also located here are the various  
auxiliary jacks which can be used to  
plug in a VCR, camcorder, video  
games, etc. The specific jacks are as follows:  
1. Yellow: video input  
2. White: left channel audio input  
3. Red: right channel audio input  
4. Black: wired headphone jack (not included)  
The B headphone jack (5) is located  
on the right side of the DVD system.  
Plug in wired headphones (not  
included) here.  
Note: The B headphones can only  
access DVD and AUX modes. They  
cannot access radio sources.  
92  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
Audio displays  
Your DVD system interacts closely with the front audio system. Status  
messages will appear in the radio display showing the DVD status. Some  
possible radio display messages:  
SINGLE PLAY or DUAL PLAY  
DVD LOAD  
DVD MENU  
DVD STOP  
Audio interaction  
You can then also use the front audio controls to advance, reverse, play  
and pause a DVD. While a DVD is playing you may use the following  
controls on the front radio:  
SEEK: Press to advance to the previous (  
) or next (  
) DVD  
chapters.  
: Press to play a DVD or to pause the DVD.  
When the radio displays “DVD MENU”, press PLAY on the radio  
(memory preset #6), to play the disc.  
Parental control for the DVD system  
Your Family Entertainment System (FES) allows you to have control  
over the rear seat controls in a few different ways. The DVD system is  
automatically activated when the vehicle ignition is ON, which allows the  
rear seat passengers to use the DVD system.  
There are three levels of control of  
the FES buttons. The states are  
FULL (enabled), LOCAL or  
LOCKED (disabled). To change the level of control, press the memory  
preset controls 3 and 5 simultaneously on the front audio controls. The  
control level will cycle each time the buttons are pressed simultaneously.  
The three states are described as:  
FULL (enabled): The FES has control over the primary (speaker) and  
secondary (headphone) audio sources.  
LOCAL: The FES has control over the secondary source (headphones)  
only. The radio will ignore button presses that affect the primary  
(speaker) audio source.  
LOCKED (disabled): The FES buttons are locked and all FES button  
presses are ignored by the radio and the FES except for load and eject.  
93  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
When the DVD system is ON, you  
can then press the memory preset  
controls 2 and 4 simultaneously to  
1
2
3
4
5
6
toggle between Single Play and Dual Play. In Single Play mode, all  
speakers listen to the same media. In Dual Play mode, rear seat  
passengers can use the infrared wireless, or wired (not included)  
headphones to listen to a different playing media than the front seat  
passengers.  
General information  
Note: DVDs are formatted by  
regions. US and Canada systems can  
only play region 1 DVDs and Mexico  
systems can only play region 4  
DVDs. Systems sold in vehicles  
targeted for other parts of the world  
would have different regions. If a  
playback problem is encountered,  
please ensure that you are using a  
disc designed for your vehicle. The  
region coding can be found stamped  
on the disc or on the box, and can say ‘region-1’ or ‘region 4’, etc. They  
may also be marked by a numerical symbol.  
Macrovision: This product incorporates copyright protection technology  
that is protected by method claims of certain U.S. patents and other  
intellectual property rights owned by Macrovision Corporation and other  
rights owners. Use of this copyright protection technology must be  
authorized by Macrovision Corporation, and is intended for home and  
other limited viewing uses only unless otherwise authorized by  
Macrovision Corporation. Reverse engineering or disassembly is  
prohibited.  
MP3: Supply of this product only conveys a license for private,  
non-commercial use and does not convey a license nor imply any right to  
use this product in any commercial (i.e. revenue generating) real time  
broadcasting (terrestrial, satellite, cable and /or any other media)  
broadcasting/streaming via internet, intranets and/or other networks or in  
other electronic content distribution systems, such as pay-audio or  
audio-on-demand applications. An independent license for such use is  
required. For details, please visit http:// www.mp3licensing.com.  
94  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
Safety information  
WARNING: Driving while distracted can result in loss of vehicle  
control, accident and injury. Ford strongly recommends that  
drivers use extreme caution when using any device that may take their  
focus off the road. The driver’s primary responsibility is the safe  
operation of their vehicle. Only use cell phones and other devices not  
essential to the driving task when it is safe to do so.  
Read all of the safety and operating instructions before operating the  
system and retain for future reference.  
Do not attempt to service, repair or modify the Family Entertainment  
System (FES). See your dealer.  
Do not insert foreign objects into the DVD compartment.  
WARNING: Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle and  
do not let children operate the system while unsupervised. If  
wired headphones or auxiliary systems are used, children may become  
entangled in the cords and seriously injure themselves.  
WARNING: The front glass on the liquid crystal display (LCD)  
flip-down screen may break when hit with a hard surface. If the  
glass breaks, do not touch the liquid crystalline material. In case of  
contact with skin, wash immediately with soap and water.  
WARNING: The driver should not attempt to operate any  
function of the DVD system while the vehicle is in motion. Give  
full attention to driving and to the road. Pull off the road in a safe  
place before inserting or extracting DVDs from the system. A remote  
control is included in the system to allow the rear seat occupants to  
operate the FES functions without distracting the driver.  
Do not expose the liquid crystal display (LCD) flip-down screen  
to direct sunlight or intensive ultraviolet rays for extensive  
periods of time. Ultraviolet rays deteriorate the liquid crystal.  
Be sure to review User Manuals for video games and video game  
equipment when used as auxiliary inputs for your Family Entertainment  
System (FES).  
95  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
Do not operate video games or video equipment if the power cords  
and/or cables are broken, split or damaged. Carefully place cords and/or  
cables where they will not be stepped on or interfere with the operation  
of seats and/or compartments.  
Disconnect video games and video equipment power cords and/or cables  
when not in use.  
Avoid touching auxiliary input jacks with your fingers. Do not blow on  
them or allow them to get wet or dirty.  
Do not clean any part of the DVD player with benzene, lacquer thinner,  
acetone, or any other solvent.  
Federal Communication Commission (FCC) Compliance  
Changes or modifications not approved by Ford Lincoln-Mercury could  
void user’s authority to operate the equipment. This equipment has been  
tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital device,  
pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC Rules. These limits are designed to  
provide reasonable protection against harmful interference in a  
residential installation. This equipment generates, uses and can radiate  
radio frequency energy and, if not installed and used in accordance with  
the instructions, may cause harmful interference and radio  
communications.  
However, there is no guarantee that interference will not occur in a  
particular installation. If this equipment does cause harmful interference  
to radio or television reception, which can be determined by turning the  
equipment off and on, the user is encouraged to consult the dealer or an  
experienced radio/TV technician for help.  
Care and service of the DVD player  
Environmental extremes  
DVD players which are subjected to harsh environmental conditions may  
be damaged or perform at less than maximum capability. To avoid these  
outcomes, whenever possible avoid exposing your DVD player to:  
extremely hot or cold temperatures.  
direct sunlight.  
high humidity.  
a dusty environment.  
locations where strong magnetic fields are generated.  
96  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
Temperature extremes  
When the vehicle is parked under direct sunlight or in an extremely cold  
place for a long period of time, wait until the cabin temperature of the  
vehicle is at normal temperature before operating the system.  
Humidity and moisture condensation  
Moisture in the air will condense in the DVD player under extremely  
humid conditions or when moving from a cold place to a warm one.  
Moisture condensation may cause damage to the DVD and/or player. If  
moisture condensation occurs, do not insert a CD or DVD into the  
player. If one is already in the player, remove it. Turn the DVD player ON  
to dry the moisture before inserting a DVD. This could take an hour or  
more.  
Foreign substances  
Exercise care to prevent dirt and foreign objects from entering the DVD  
player compartment. Be especially careful not to spill liquids of any kind  
onto the media controls or into the system. If liquid is accidentally  
spilled onto the system, immediately turn the system OFF and consult a  
qualified service technician.  
Cleaning the liquid crystal display (LCD) flip-down screen  
Clean the display screen by applying a small amount of water or any  
ammonia-based household glass cleaner directly to a soft cloth. Rub the  
screen gently until the dust, dirt or fingerprints are removed. Do not  
spray the screen directly with water or glass cleaning solvents. Overspray  
from these fluids could drip down into the internal electronics of the  
screen and cause damage. Do not apply excessive pressure while  
cleaning the screen.  
Cleaning DVD and CD discs  
Inspect all discs for contamination before playing. If necessary, clean  
discs only with an approved DVD and CD cleaner and wipe from the  
center out to the edge. Do not use circular motion.  
97  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Entertainment Systems  
Compatibility with aftermarket audio systems  
(headphone only mode)  
When the Family Entertainment System (FES) detects that the original  
radio supplied by Ford Motor Company has been removed from the  
vehicle, the FES will work in a state referred to as “Headphone Only  
Mode.” This mode allows the FES to operate as a standalone system,  
without interface to the radio.  
While operating in Headphone Only Mode, the system will have limited  
functionality.  
The system will only output audio to the headphones. It will not be  
capable of providing audio to the speakers.  
The available sources in FES Headphone Only Mode are DVD-DISC  
and DVD-AUX, regardless of headphone channel (A or B).  
When a disc is inserted into the FES while in Headphone Only Mode,  
both headphone channels (A and B) will be connected to FES-DISC.  
NAVIGATION SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)  
Your vehicle may be equipped with a navigation system. Refer to the  
Navigation System supplement for further information.  
SYNC(IF EQUIPPED)  
Your vehicle may be equipped with SYNC, a hands-free communications  
and entertainment system with special phone and media features. For  
more information, please refer to the SYNCsupplement or to the  
SYNCsection in the Navigation system supplement (if equipped).  
98  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Climate Controls  
MANUAL HEATING AND AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM  
(IF EQUIPPED)  
1. Temperature selection:  
Controls the temperature of the  
airflow in the vehicle.  
2. Air flow selections: Controls  
the direction of the airflow in the  
vehicle. See the following for a brief  
description on each control.  
MAX A/C: Distributes recirculated  
air through the instrument panel vents to cool the vehicle. This recooling  
of the interior air is more economical and efficient. Recirculated air may  
also help reduce undesirable odors from entering the vehicle.  
: Distributes outside air through the instrument panel vents.  
: Distributes outside air through the instrument panel vents and the  
floor vents.  
O (OFF): Outside air is shut out and the fan will not operate.  
: Distributes outside air through the floor vents. Note: Some airflow  
will come out of the small vents near the side windows.  
: Distributes outside air through the windshield defroster vents and  
floor vents. Note: Some airflow will come out of the small vents near the  
side windows.  
: Distributes outside air through the windshield defroster vents.  
3. A/C: Press to turn A/C on/off. Uses outside air to cool the vehicle. Air  
flows primarily from the instrument panel register vents.  
4. Rear defroster: Clears ice and fog from the rear window.  
5. Fan speed adjustment: Controls the volume of air circulated in the  
vehicle.  
Operating tips  
To reduce fog build up on the windshield during humid weather, place  
the air flow selector in the  
position.  
To reduce humidity build up inside the vehicle, do not drive with the  
air flow selector in the off position.  
Do not put objects under the front seats that will interfere with the  
airflow to the rear seats.  
99  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Climate Controls  
Remove any snow, ice or leaves from the air intake area at the base of  
the windshield.  
To improve the A/C cool down when the vehicle interior is  
significantly warmer than the outside temperature, drive with the  
windows slightly open for 2–3 minutes after start up or until the  
vehicle has been “aired out.”  
If you are driving during extreme high ambient temperatures and  
idling for extended periods of time in gear, it is recommended to run  
the A/C in the MAX A/C position, adjust the blower fan speed to the  
lowest setting, turn off the rear A/C unit and put the vehicle’s  
transmission into the P (Park) to continue to receive cool air from  
your A/C system.  
For maximum cooling performance in panel (  
) mode:  
Select MAX A/C mode. MAX A/C uses recirculated air with A/C to  
provide a cooler airflow.  
Move the temperature control to the coolest setting.  
Set the fan to the highest speed initially, then adjust in order to  
maintain comfort.  
To allow side window defogging and demisting while warming up the  
vehicle cabin:  
1. Select  
.
2. Select A/C.  
3. Set the temperature control to maintain comfort.  
4. Set the fan speed to the highest setting.  
5. Direct the outer instrument panel vents towards the side windows. To  
increase airflow to the outer instrument panel vents, close the vents  
located in the middle of the instrument panel.  
To allow windshield defogging and demisting while warming up vehicle:  
1. Select  
floor/defrost mode.  
2. Set temperature control to maintain comfort.  
3. Set fan to highest setting.  
100  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Climate Controls  
DUAL AUTOMATIC TEMPERATURE CONTROL (DATC) SYSTEM  
(IF EQUIPPED)  
14  
15  
16 17  
1
2
3
EXT  
A/C  
F
F
F C  
DUAL  
R
AUTO  
OFF  
13 12  
11  
10  
9
8
7
6
5
4
1. A/C control: Manually turns A/C  
on or off.  
A/C  
2. Recirculation control: Cools  
the vehicle more quickly by  
recirculating the cabin air instead of  
using outside air and helps prevent unpleasant outside odors or fumes  
from entering the vehicle. Press to turn on/off.  
3. Passenger side temperature  
control: Controls the temperature  
on the passenger side of the vehicle  
when in dual zone mode. To enter  
dual zone, press the passenger temperature control or DUAL. The  
passenger temperature will appear in the display.  
4. Rear defroster control:  
R
Removes ice and fog from the rear  
window. Press to turn on/off.  
101  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Climate Controls  
5. DUAL (Single/dual electric  
temperature control): Allows the  
driver to have full control of the  
DUAL  
cabin temperature settings (single zone) or allows the passenger to have  
control of their individual temperature settings (dual zone control). Press  
to turn on dual zone mode, press again to return to single zone.  
6.  
: Distributes outside air through the windshield defroster vents.  
7.  
: Distributes outside air through the windshield defroster vents  
and floor vents. Note: Some airflow will come out of the small vents  
near the side windows.  
8.  
: Distributes air through the floor vents. Note: Some airflow will  
come out of the small vents near the side windows.  
9.  
vents.  
: Distributes air through the instrument panel vents and the floor  
: Distributes air through the instrument panel vents.  
10.  
11. OFF: Outside air is shut out and  
the fan will not operate. Note: If  
equipped with the auxiliary system,  
OFF  
the auxiliary fan can still operate with the front system off.  
12. AUTO: Press to select the  
AUTO  
desired temperature shown in the  
display window. The system will  
automatically determine the fan speed, the direction of the airflow,  
outside or recirculated air to heat or cool the vehicle to the selected  
temperature.  
13. Manual override controls:  
OFF  
Allows you to manually determine  
where airflow is directed. To return  
to fully automatic control, press AUTO.  
14. Driver’s side temperature  
control: Controls the temperature  
of the vehicle cabin. When DUAL  
zone is pressed, controls the driver’s  
side temperature.  
102  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Climate Controls  
15. Fan Speed: Manually increases  
or decreases the fan speed.  
EXT  
16. EXT: Displays the outside air  
temperature. It will remain  
displayed until the EXT control is  
pressed again. The external temperature will be most accurate when the  
vehicle has been moving for a period of time.  
F C  
17. Temperature conversion:  
Press to toggle between Fahrenheit  
and Celsius temperature on the  
DATC display only. The set point temperatures in Celsius will be  
displayed in half-degree increments.  
Operating tips  
To reduce fog build up on the windshield during humid weather, place  
the air flow selector in the  
position.  
To reduce humidity build up inside the vehicle, do not drive with the  
air flow selector in OFF or with recirculated air engaged.  
Do not put objects under the front seats that will interfere with the  
airflow to the rear seats.  
Remove any snow, ice or leaves from the air intake area at the base of  
the windshield.  
To improve the A/C cool down, drive with the windows slightly open  
for 2–3 minutes after start up or until the vehicle has been “aired out.”  
If you are driving during extreme high ambient temperatures and  
idling for extended periods of time in gear, it is recommended to run  
the A/C in the MAX A/C position, adjust the blower fan speed to the  
lowest setting, turn off the rear A/C unit and put the vehicle’s  
transmission into the P (Park) to continue to receive cool air from  
your A/C system.  
For maximum cooling performance:  
Select and A/C and recirculated air. Use recirculated air with A/C to  
provide a cooler airflow.  
Move the temperature control to the coolest setting.  
103  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Climate Controls  
To allow side window defogging and demisting while warming up the  
vehicle cabin:  
1. Select  
.
2. Select A/C.  
3. Set the temperature control to maintain comfort.  
4. Set the fan speed to the highest setting.  
5. Direct the outer instrument panel vents towards the side windows. To  
increase airflow to the outer instrument panel vents, close the vents  
located in the middle of the instrument panel.  
AUXILIARY SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)  
Your vehicle may be equipped with an auxiliary climate system. These  
auxiliary controls, located in the overhead console, allow the front  
passengers to control airflow direction, temperature and fan level of the  
rear compartment to quickly heat or cool the entire vehicle.  
Front auxiliary controls:  
1. Temperature control:  
Determines temperature level.  
2. Mode selector: Press to select  
air flow direction to  
(floor)  
or  
(panel).  
directs air to the floor of the  
third row seating.  
directs air to the overhead  
registers of the second and third  
row seating.  
The selected mode will illuminate on the temperature control.  
3. Fan control: Determines fan speed levels. If your vehicle is equipped  
with the front Dual Automatic Temperature Control (DATC) system,  
when the front system is turned off, the fan and heat mode will operate  
and A/C will be unavailable.  
104  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Climate Controls  
FLOOR CONSOLE CLIMATE CONTROLS  
Controls the direction of the airflow  
to the rear of the vehicle.  
directs air flow primarily  
through the console panel  
register.  
directs air flow through the console floor register.  
REAR WINDOW DEFROSTER  
The rear defroster control is located  
on the instrument panel.  
Press the rear defroster control to  
clear the rear window of thin ice  
and fog.  
R
An indicator lamp will illuminate  
when the rear defroster is  
activated.  
The ignition must be in the on position to operate the rear window  
defroster.  
The defroster turns off automatically after 10 minutes or when the  
ignition is turned to off or the accessory position. To manually turn off  
the defroster before 10 minutes have passed, push the control again.  
105  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Lights  
HEADLAMP CONTROL  
Turns the lamps off.  
Turns on the parking lamps,  
instrument panel lamps, license  
plate lamps and tail lamps.  
Turns the headlamps on.  
Autolamp control  
(if equipped)  
P
A
The autolamp control sets the  
headlamps to turn on and off  
automatically. The autolamp control,  
located on the headlamp control,  
may be set to:  
turn on the lamps automatically  
at night  
turn off the lamps automatically  
during the daylight  
keep the lamps on for up to three minutes after the key is turned to  
off.  
To turn the autolamps on, rotate the control counterclockwise to  
.
Note: With autolamps, your vehicle has a windshield wiper rainlamp  
feature. When the headlamp control is in the autolamp position and the  
windshield wipers are turned on during daylight, the exterior lamps will  
turn on after a brief delay.  
106  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Lights  
Fog lamp control  
The fog lamps can be turned on  
only when the headlamp control is  
in the  
,
or  
position and  
the high beams are not turned on.  
Pull headlamp control towards you  
to turn fog lamps on. The fog lamp  
indicator light below the  
icon  
will illuminate when fog lamp is  
activated.  
Push the headlamp control towards  
the instrument panel to deactivate the fog lamps.  
Daytime running lamps (DRL) (if equipped)  
To activate DRL:  
the ignition must be in the on position and  
the headlamp control is in the  
or  
position  
the transmission is not in P (Park).  
WARNING: Always remember to turn on your headlamps at  
dusk or during inclement weather. The Daytime Running Light  
(DRL) System does not activate your tail lamps and generally may not  
provide adequate lighting during these conditions. Failure to activate  
your headlamps under these conditions may result in a collision.  
High beams  
Push the lever toward the  
instrument panel to activate. Pull  
the lever towards you to deactivate.  
107  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Lights  
Flash to pass  
Pull the lever toward you to  
activate. Release the lever to  
deactivate.  
PANEL DIMMER CONTROL  
Use to adjust the brightness of the  
instrument panel when exterior  
lights are on.  
Rotate the thumbwheel from left  
to right to brighten the  
instrument panel.  
Rotate the thumbwheel from right  
to left to dim the instrument  
panel.  
Rotate fully to the right (past detent) to turn on interior lamps.  
Rotate to the left position (past detent) to turn off the interior lamps  
and to disable the illuminated entry feature. When the control is in the  
far left position, it acts as a dome lamp defeat/override.  
Note: If the battery is disconnected, discharged, or a new battery is  
installed, the dimmer switch requires re-calibration. Rotate the dimmer  
switch from the full dim position to the full dome/on position to reset.  
This will ensure that your displays are visible under all lighting  
conditions.  
AIMING THE HEADLAMPS  
The headlamps on your vehicle are properly aimed before leaving the  
assembly plant. If your vehicle is involved in an accident or if you have  
problems fixing the alignment of your headlamps, have them checked by  
a qualified service technician.  
Headlamp aim adjustment  
The headlamps on your vehicle can only be vertically adjusted. Your  
vehicle does not require horizontal aim adjustments.  
108  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Lights  
To adjust the headlamps:  
1. Park your vehicle on a level surface about 25 feet (7.6 meters) away  
from a vertical plain surface (3). Check your headlamp alignment at  
night or in a dark area so that you can see the headlamp beam pattern.  
(1) 8 feet (2.4 m)  
(2) Center height of lamp to  
ground  
(3) 25 feet (7.6 m)  
(4) Horizontal reference line  
2. The center of the headlamp has a  
3.0 mm circle on the lens. Measure  
the height from the center of your  
headlamp to the ground (2) and  
mark an 8 foot (2.4 m) long  
horizontal line on the plain surface (1) at this height (masking tape  
works well).  
3. Turn on the low beam headlamps.  
The brightest part of the light  
should be below the horizontal line  
(4). If it is above the line the  
headlamp will need to be adjusted.  
4. Open the hood.  
5. Locate the vertical adjuster for  
each headlamp. Adjust the aim by  
turning the adjuster control either  
clockwise (to adjust down) or  
counterclockwise (to adjust up).  
Note: Use a 4 mm socket or box  
wrench to turn the vertical adjuster  
control.  
6. Horizontal aiming is not required  
for this vehicle and is  
non-adjustable.  
109  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lights  
TURN SIGNAL CONTROL  
Push down to activate the left  
turn signal.  
Push up to activate the right turn  
signal.  
INTERIOR LAMPS  
Dome/reading lamps  
The dome lamp lights when:  
any door is opened.  
the instrument panel dimmer  
switch is rotated up until the  
courtesy lamps come on.  
any of the remote entry controls  
are pressed and the ignition is  
off.  
The reading portion, the two outer lights, can only be toggled on and off  
at the lamp.  
The front map lamps are located in  
the overhead console (if equipped).  
Press the controls on either side of  
each map lamp to activate the  
lamps.  
110  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Lights  
Cargo/reading lamps  
The dome portion of the lamp or  
the center light can be turned on  
when the panel dimmer control is  
rotated fully up or when a door is  
opened.  
The rear dome lamp can be turned  
on or off by sliding the control.  
BULB REPLACEMENT  
Lamp assembly condensation  
Exterior lamps are vented to accommodate normal changes in pressure.  
Condensation can be a natural by-product of this design. When moist air  
enters the lamp assembly through the vents, there is a possibility that  
condensation can occur when the temperature is cold. When normal  
condensation occurs, a thin film of mist can form on the interior of the  
lens. The thin mist eventually clears and exits through the vents during  
normal operation. Clearing time may take as long as 48 hours under dry  
weather conditions.  
Examples of acceptable condensation are:  
Presence of thin mist (no streaks, drip marks or droplets)  
Fine mist covers less than 50% of the lens  
Examples of unacceptable moisture (usually caused by a lamp water  
leak) are:  
Water puddle inside the lamp  
Large water droplets, drip marks or streaks present on the interior of  
the lens  
Take your vehicle to dealer for service if any of the above conditions of  
unacceptable moisture are present.  
111  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Lights  
Using the right bulbs  
Replacement bulbs are specified in the chart below. Headlamp bulbs  
must be marked with an authorized “D.O.T.” for North America and an  
“E” for Europe to ensure lamp performance, light brightness and pattern  
and safe visibility. Using incorrect bulbs may damage the lamp assembly  
or void the lamp assembly warranty or may not provide quality bulb burn  
time.  
Function  
Number of bulbs  
Trade number  
Headlamp low & high  
beam  
2
H13  
Front park/turn lamp  
Side park/turn lamp  
Upper rear tail lamp  
Rear backup lamp  
Lower rear  
stop/tail/turn lamp  
High-mount stop  
lamps  
2
2
2
2
2
3457 NAK (amber)  
194  
194  
921  
3057K  
W5WL  
168  
5
2
Rear license plate  
lamps  
Front fog lamp  
Cargo lamp  
Interior overhead lamp  
Front door courtesy  
lamp  
2
1
1
1
9145  
211-2  
912 (906)  
168  
Map lamps  
2
1
2
168 (T10)  
161  
Ashtray lamp  
Visor vanity lamp -  
Slide on rail system  
(SOR)  
A6224PF  
All replacement bulbs are clear in color except where noted.  
To replace all instrument panel lights - see your authorized dealer .  
Replacing interior bulbs  
Check the operation of the bulbs frequently. To replace any of the  
interior bulbs, see a dealer or qualified technician.  
112  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Lights  
Replacing exterior bulbs  
Check the operation of all the bulbs frequently.  
Replacing headlamp bulbs  
Do not touch the glass of a halogen bulb.  
1. Turn off the headlamps and open  
the hood.  
2. Remove three screws from the  
headlamp assembly and pull  
headlamp forward.  
3. Disconnect the electrical  
connector.  
4. Remove the old bulb by turning  
counterclockwise and pull it out.  
WARNING: Handle a halogen headlamp bulb carefully and keep  
out of children’s reach. Grasp the bulb only by its plastic base  
and do not touch the glass. The oil from your hand could cause the  
bulb to break the next time the headlamps are operated.  
Reverse steps to reinstall bulb(s).  
113  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lights  
Replacing front parking lamp/turn signal/sidemarker bulbs  
1. Turn off the headlamps and open  
the hood.  
2. Remove three screws from the  
headlamp assembly and pull  
headlamp forward.  
3. Rotate the bulb socket  
counterclockwise and remove it  
from the lamp assembly.  
4. Pull the bulb straight out of the  
socket.  
Reverse steps to reinstall bulb(s).  
Replacing tail/brake/turn/backup lamp bulbs  
1. Turn the headlamps off and open  
the liftgate.  
2. Remove the two bolts from the  
lamp assembly.  
3. Remove the lamp assembly by  
pulling it away from the vehicle at  
an angle to disengage the two snap  
attachments.  
114  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lights  
4. Rotate the bulb socket  
counterclockwise and remove it  
from the lamp assembly.  
5. Pull the bulb straight out of the  
socket.  
Reverse steps to reinstall bulb(s).  
Replacing fog lamp bulbs  
1. Make sure the headlamp switch is  
off.  
2. Remove the bulb socket from the  
fog lamp by turning it  
counterclockwise.  
3. Disconnect the electrical  
connector.  
Reverse steps to reinstall bulb(s).  
Replacing license plate lamp bulbs  
1. Make sure the headlamp switch is  
off.  
2. Remove the lamp assembly by  
pressing the small tab and rocking  
the lamp assembly out.  
3. Remove the bulb socket from the  
lamp assembly by turning  
counterclockwise and pull the bulb  
straight out.  
Reverse steps to reinstall bulb(s).  
115  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Lights  
Replacing high-mount brakelamp bulb  
1. Remove the two screws and lamp  
assembly away from the vehicle.  
2. Remove the bulb holder from the  
lamp assembly by pressing the  
snaps.  
3. Pull the bulb straight out of the  
socket and push in the new bulb.  
Reverse steps to reinstall bulb(s).  
116  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driver Controls  
MULTI-FUNCTION LEVER  
Windshield wiper: Rotate the end  
of the control away from you to  
increase the speed of the wipers;  
rotate towards you to decrease the  
speed of the wipers.  
Windshield washer: Press the end  
of the stalk:  
briefly: causes a single swipe of  
the wipers without washer fluid.  
a quick press and hold: the  
wipers will swipe three times with  
washer fluid.  
a long press and hold: the wipers and washer fluid will be activated for  
up to ten seconds.  
Note: Do not operate the washer when the washer reservoir is empty.  
This may cause the washer pump to overheat. Check the washer fluid  
level frequently. Do not operate the wipers when the windshield is dry.  
This may scratch the glass, damage the wiper blades and cause the wiper  
motor to burn out. Before operating the wiper on a dry windshield,  
always use the windshield washer. In freezing weather, be sure the wiper  
blades are not frozen to the windshield before operating the wipers.  
Windshield wiper rainlamp feature (if equipped with Autolamp)  
When the windshield wipers are turned on during daylight, and the  
headlamp control is in the autolamp position, the exterior lamps will turn  
on after a brief delay and will remain on until the wipers are turned off.  
Rear window wiper/washer controls  
For rear wiper operation, rotate the  
rear window wiper and washer  
control to the desired position.  
Select:  
INT 1 — 8–10 second interval rear  
wiper.  
INT 2 — 3–4 second interval rear  
wiper.  
117  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
O (off) — Rear wiper and washer off.  
For rear wash cycle, rotate (and hold as desired) the rear wiper/washer  
control to either  
position.  
From either position, the control will automatically return to the INT 2  
or O (off) position.  
TILT STEERING COLUMN  
Pull the lever down and release, to  
unlock the steering column tilt lock.  
With the lever in the down position,  
tilt the steering column and wheel  
to its desired orientation. Do not  
push or pull the lever while tilting  
the wheel.  
Lift the lever back to its original  
position to lock the steering column.  
WARNING: Never adjust  
the steering column when  
the vehicle is moving.  
ILLUMINATED VISOR MIRROR  
(IF EQUIPPED)  
Lift the mirror cover to turn on the  
visor mirror lamp.  
118  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
Slide on rod feature  
Rotate the visor towards the side  
window and extend it rearward for  
additional sunlight coverage.  
Note: To stow the visor back into  
the headliner, visor must be  
retracted before moving it back  
towards the windshield.  
OVERHEAD CONSOLE (IF EQUIPPED)  
The appearance of your vehicle’s overhead console will vary according to  
your option package.  
Storage compartment  
Press the latch to open the storage  
compartment.  
119  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
Installing a garage door opener (if equipped)  
The storage compartment can be converted to accommodate a variety of  
aftermarket garage door openers:  
Place the VELCROhook onto  
the side of the aftermarket  
transmitter opposite of the  
button.  
Place the transmitter into storage  
compartment, button down.  
Place the provided height  
adaptors onto the back of the  
door as needed.  
Close the door.  
Press the depression in the door  
to activate the transmitter.  
CENTER CONSOLE  
1. Cupholders  
2. Tissue holder in lid  
3. Rear power point  
4. Large utility compartment has an  
exterior power point in front of the  
lid, and inside the compartment has  
coin holder slots, a power point, AIJ  
(Audio Input Jack), USB port and a  
business/credit card holder  
The rear side of the console may  
incorporate the following features:  
Air vents  
Cupholders  
120  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
WARNING: Use only soft cups in the cupholder. Hard objects  
can injure you in a collision.  
Rear center console features (if equipped)  
The rear center console incorporates the following features:  
Utility compartment  
Cupholders  
Flip forward armrest to provide a  
flat load floor  
AUXILIARY POWER POINTS (12VDC)  
Power outlets are designed for accessory plugs only. Do not insert  
any other object in the power outlet as this will damage the  
outlet and blow the fuse. Do not hang any type of accessory or  
accessory bracket from the plug. Improper use of the power  
outlet can cause damage not covered by your warranty.  
Auxiliary power points can be found in the following locations:  
On the front of the center console  
Inside the utility compartment  
On the rear of the console, accessible from the rear seats  
Do not use the power point for operating the cigarette lighter element (if  
equipped).  
To prevent the fuse from being blown, do not use the power point(s)  
over the vehicle capacity of 12 VDC/180W. If the power point or cigar  
lighter socket is not working, a fuse may have blown. Refer to Fuses and  
relays in the Roadside Emergencies chapter for information on  
checking and replacing fuses.  
121  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
To have full capacity usage of your power point, the engine is required to  
be running to avoid unintentional discharge of the battery. To prevent  
the battery from being discharged:  
do not use the power point longer than necessary when the engine is  
not running,  
do not leave battery chargers, video game adapters, computers and  
other devices plugged in overnight or when the vehicle is parked for  
extended periods.  
Always keep the power point caps closed when not being used.  
POWER WINDOWS  
WARNING: Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle and  
do not let children play with the power windows. They may  
seriously injure themselves.  
WARNING: When closing the power windows, you should verify  
they are free of obstructions and ensure that children and/or  
pets are not in the proximity of the window openings.  
Press and pull the window switches  
to open and close windows.  
Press down (to the first detent)  
and hold the switch to open.  
Pull up (to the first detent) and  
hold the switch to close.  
Rear Window Buffeting: When one or both of the rear windows are  
open, the vehicle may demonstrate a wind throb or buffeting noise. This  
noise can be alleviated by lowering a front window approximately two to  
three inches.  
One touch up or down (Driver’s window only) (if equipped)  
This feature allows the driver’s window to open or close fully without  
holding the control down.  
122  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
To operate one touch down:  
Press the switch completely down  
to the second detent and release  
quickly. The window will open  
fully. Momentarily press the  
switch to any position to stop the  
window operation.  
If the switch is pressed and held to  
the normal close or one touch up position during a one touch down  
event, the window will stop. If, after 1/2 second the switch is still held,  
the window will perform a normal close or one touch up.  
To operate one touch up:  
Pull the switch completely up to  
the second detent and release  
quickly. The window will close  
fully. Momentarily press the  
switch to any position to stop the  
window operation.  
If the switch is pressed and held to  
the normal open or one touch down position during a one touch up  
event, the window will stop. If, after 1/2 second the switch is still held,  
the window will perform a normal open or one touch down.  
Bounce-back (driver’s window only)  
When an obstacle has been detected in the window opening as the  
window is moving upward, the window will automatically reverse  
direction and move down. This is known as “bounce-back”. If the ignition  
is turned off (without accessory delay being active) during bounce-back,  
the window will move down until the bounce-back position is reached.  
Security override  
To override a bounce-back condition, within two seconds after the  
window reaches the bounce-back position, pull and hold the switch up  
and the window will travel up with no bounce-back or pinch  
protection. If the switch is released before the window is fully closed,  
the window will stop. For example, this can be used to overcome the  
resistance of ice on the window or seals.  
123  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driver Controls  
Window lock  
The window lock feature allows only  
the driver to operate the power  
windows.  
To lock out all the window controls  
(except for the driver’s) press the  
right side of the control. Press the  
left side to restore the window  
controls.  
Accessory delay  
With accessory delay, the audio system, power windows and moon roof  
(if equipped) operate for up to 10 minutes after the ignition switch is  
turned from the on to the off position or until either front door is  
opened.  
INTERIOR MIRROR  
The interior rear view mirror has two pivot points on the support arm  
which lets you adjust the mirror up or down and from side to side.  
WARNING: Do not adjust the mirror while the vehicle is in  
motion.  
Automatic dimming interior rear view mirror (if equipped)  
Your vehicle may be equipped with an interior rear view mirror which  
has an auto-dimming function. The electronic day/night mirror will  
change from the normal (high reflective) state to the non-glare  
(darkened) state when bright lights (glare) reach the mirror. When the  
mirror detects bright light from behind the vehicle, it will automatically  
adjust (darken) to minimize glare.  
The mirror will automatically return to the normal state whenever the  
vehicle is placed in R (Reverse) to ensure a bright clear view when  
backing up.  
Do not block the sensors on the front and back of the interior  
rear view mirror since this may impair proper mirror  
performance.  
Do not clean the housing or glass of any mirror with harsh  
abrasives, fuel or other petroleum-based cleaning products.  
124  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
EXTERIOR MIRRORS  
Power side view mirrors  
WARNING: Do not adjust the mirror while the vehicle is in  
motion.  
The ignition must be in the accessory or on position to adjust the power  
side view mirrors.  
To adjust your mirrors:  
1. Rotate the control clockwise to  
adjust the right mirror and rotate  
the control counterclockwise to  
adjust the left mirror.  
2. Move the control in the direction  
you wish to tilt the mirror.  
3. Return to the center position to lock mirrors in place.  
Fold-away mirrors  
Fold the side mirrors in carefully  
when driving through a narrow  
space, like an automatic car wash.  
Heated outside mirrors  
(if equipped)  
Both mirrors are heated  
automatically to remove ice, mist  
and fog when the rear window  
defrost is activated.  
Do not remove ice from the  
mirrors with a scraper or  
attempt to readjust the mirror  
glass if it is frozen in place.  
These actions could cause  
damage to the glass and mirrors.  
Do not clean the housing or glass of any mirror with harsh  
abrasives, fuel or other petroleum-based cleaning products.  
125  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
POWER ADJUSTABLE FOOT PEDALS (IF EQUIPPED)  
The accelerator and brake pedal  
should only be adjusted when the  
vehicle is stopped and the gearshift  
lever is in the P (Park) position.  
Press and hold the rocker control to  
adjust accelerator and brake pedal  
toward you or away from you.  
WARNING: Never adjust the accelerator and brake pedal with  
feet on the pedals while the vehicle is moving.  
POWER DEPLOYABLE RUNNING BOARDS (IF EQUIPPED)  
Deployable running boards (DRB) automatically move when the doors  
are opened to assist entering and exiting the vehicle.  
Automatic power deploy:  
The running boards will extend  
down and out when the doors are  
opened.  
Automatic power stow:  
The running boards will return to  
the stowed position when the  
doors are closed. There will be a  
two second delay before the  
running boards move in to the  
stowed position.  
Manual power deploy:  
To manually operate the running boards, refer to Message center in the  
Instrument Cluster chapter.  
This feature can manually set the running boards in the deployed  
(OUT) position for access to the roof.  
When running boards are manually set in the deployed position, the  
boards will return to the stowed position and enter automatic mode  
when the vehicle speed exceeds 5 mph (8 km/h).  
126  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
Enable/disable:  
To enable/disable the power running board feature, refer to Message  
center in the Instrument Cluster chapter.  
When this feature is disabled (OFF), the running boards will move to  
the stowed position regardless of the position of the doors.  
When this feature is enabled (AUTO), the running boards will move  
back to the correct positions based off of the door positions.  
Bounce-back:  
If an object is in the way of the moving running board, the running  
board will automatically bounce back in the reverse direction and  
move to the end of travel.  
Note: The running boards may operate slower in cooler temperatures. In  
adverse conditions, debris such as mud, dirt, and salt may become  
trapped in the running board mechanism, possibly leading to unwanted  
noise. If this occurs, manually set the running boards to the deployed  
position and flush the system (in particular the front and rear hinge  
arms) with a high-pressure car wash wand.  
Note: Do not use the running boards, front and rear hinge assemblies,  
running board motors, or the running board under body mounts to lift  
the vehicle when jacking. Please utilize proper jacking points. Refer to  
Changing the tires in the Roadside Emergencies chapter.  
WARNING: In extreme climates, excessive ice buildup may  
occur, causing the running boards not to deploy. Be sure that the  
running boards have deployed, and have finished moving before  
attempting to step on them. Note: The running boards will resume  
normal function once the blockage is cleared.  
WARNING: Turn off the running boards before jacking or  
placing any object under the vehicle. Never place your hand  
between the extended running board and the vehicle. A moving  
running board may cause injury.  
127  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driver Controls  
SPEED CONTROL (IF EQUIPPED)  
With speed control set, you can maintain a set speed without keeping  
your foot on the accelerator pedal.  
WARNING: Do not use the speed control in heavy traffic or on  
roads that are winding, slippery or unpaved.  
Setting speed control  
The controls for using your speed  
control are located on the steering  
wheel for your convenience.  
1. Press the ON control and release  
it.  
2. Accelerate to the desired speed.  
3. Press the SET + control and  
release it.  
4. Take your foot off the accelerator  
pedal.  
5. The indicator light  
on the  
instrument cluster will turn on.  
Note:  
Vehicle speed may vary momentarily when driving up and down a  
steep hill.  
If the vehicle speed increases above the set speed on a downhill, you  
may want to apply the brakes to reduce the speed.  
If the vehicle speed decreases more than 10 mph (16 km/h) below  
your set speed on an uphill, your speed control will disengage.  
128  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
Resuming a set speed  
Press the RES (resume) control and  
release it. This will automatically  
return the vehicle to the previously  
set speed.  
Increasing speed while using speed control  
There are two ways to set a higher  
speed:  
Press and hold the SET + control  
until you get to the desired  
speed, then release the control.  
You can also use the SET +  
control to operate the Tap-Up  
function. Press and release this  
control to increase the vehicle set  
speed in small amounts by 1 mph  
or 2 km/h.  
Use the accelerator pedal to get to the desired speed. When the  
vehicle reaches that speed press and release the SET + control.  
Reducing speed while using speed control  
There are two ways to reduce a set  
speed:  
Press and hold the SET - control  
until you get to the desired  
speed, then release the control.  
You can also use the SET -  
control to operate the Tap-Down  
function. Press and release this  
control to decrease the vehicle  
set speed in small amounts by  
1 mph or 2 km/h.  
Press the brake pedal until the desired vehicle speed is reached, press  
the SET + control.  
129  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driver Controls  
Turning off speed control  
There are two ways to turn off the speed control:  
Press the brake pedal. This will not erase your vehicle’s previously set  
speed.  
Press the speed control OFF  
control.  
Note: When you turn off the speed  
control or the ignition, your speed  
control set speed memory is erased.  
STEERING WHEEL CONTROLS  
These controls allow you to operate some radio control features.  
Audio control features  
Press MEDIA to select:  
AM, FM1, FM2  
SAT1, SAT2 or SAT3 (Satellite  
Radio mode if equipped).  
CD (if equipped)  
DVD/FES (if equipped)  
LINE IN (Auxiliary input jack)  
In AM, FM1, or FM2 mode:  
Press  
SEEK  
to  
select preset stations within the  
selected radio band or press and  
hold to select the next/previous  
radio frequency.  
In Satellite radio mode (if  
equipped):  
Press  
advance through preset channels.  
130  
SEEK  
to  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
In CD mode (if equipped):  
SEEK  
Press  
to select the next selection on the CD/USB  
or press and hold to forward or reverse through the CD/USB.  
In DVD mode (if equipped):  
Refer to the Family entertainment DVD system in the  
Entertainment Systems chapter.  
In any mode:  
Press VOL + or − to adjust  
volume.  
Navigation system hands free  
control features (if equipped)  
Press and hold VOICE briefly until  
the voice  
icon appears on the  
Navigation display to use the voice  
command feature.  
Press VOICE to complete a voice  
command.  
For further information on the  
Navigation system, refer to the  
Navigation System supplement.  
SYNCsystem hands free  
control feature (if equipped)  
Press VOICE briefly until the  
voice  
icon appears on the display  
to use the voice command feature.  
You will hear a tone and LISTENING  
will appear in the radio display.  
Press and hold VOICE to exit voice  
command.  
131  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driver Controls  
Press  
hold  
to activate phone mode or answer a phone call. Press and  
to end call or exit phone mode.  
Press  
to scroll through various menus and selections. Press  
OK to confirm your selection.  
For further information on the SYNCsystem, refer to the SYNC௡  
supplement.  
Navigation system/SYNChands  
free control features (if  
equipped)  
Press VOICE briefly until the  
voice  
icon appears on the  
Navigation display to use the voice  
command feature.  
Press  
to activate phone mode or  
answer a phone call. Press and  
hold  
call.  
to exit phone mode or end  
For further information on the Navigation system/SYNCsystem, refer to  
the Navigation System and SYNCsupplements.  
MOON ROOF (IF EQUIPPED)  
The moon roof control is located on the overhead console.  
WARNING: Do not let children play with the moon roof or leave  
children unattended in the vehicle. They may seriously hurt  
themselves.  
WARNING: When closing the moon roof, you should verify that  
it is free of obstructions and ensure that children and/or pets are  
not in the proximity of the moon roof opening.  
The moon roof is equipped with an automatic, one-touch, express  
opening and closing feature. To stop motion at any time during the  
one-touch operation, press the control a second time.  
132  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
To open the moon roof: Press and  
release the SLIDE control, the moon  
roof will open automatically. Press  
the switch again to stop the moon  
roof.  
TILT  
SLIDE  
To close the moon roof: Pull and  
release the SLIDE control, the moon  
roof will close automatically. Press  
the switch again to stop the moon  
roof.  
Bounce-back: When an obstacle has been detected in the moon roof  
opening as the moon roof is closing, the moon roof will automatically  
open and stop at a prescribed position.  
Bounce-back override: To override bounce-back function, pull and hold  
the SLIDE switch within two seconds of a bounce-back event. The  
closing force will begin to increase each time the moon roof is closed for  
the first three closing cycles, with bounce-back active. For example:  
Bounce-back can be used to overcome the resistance of ice on the moon  
roof or seals.  
To vent the moon roof: Press and release the TILT control, the moon  
roof will move to the vent position automatically from any moon roof  
position. Press the switch again to stop the moon roof. Pull and hold the  
TILT control to close the moon roof.  
The moon roof has a built-in sliding shade that can be manually opened  
or closed when the glass panel is shut. To close the shade, pull it toward  
the front of the vehicle.  
Accessory delay:  
With accessory delay, the window switches, audio system, and moon roof  
may be used for up to 10 minutes after the ignition switch is turned to  
the off position or until either front door is opened.  
UNIVERSAL GARAGE DOOR OPENER (IF EQUIPPED)  
The appearance of your vehicle’s universal garage door opener will vary  
according to your option package. Before programing, make sure your  
transmitter matches the graphic in the procedure.  
133  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
HomeLink௡  
Car2UHome Automation  
System  
HomeLinkWireless Control System (if equipped)  
The HomeLinkWireless Control System, located on the overhead  
console or on the driver’s visor, provides a convenient way to replace up  
to three hand-held transmitters with a single built-in device. This feature  
will learn the radio frequency codes of most transmitters to operate  
garage doors, entry gate operators, security systems, entry door locks,  
and home or office lighting.  
WARNING: When programming your HomeLinkWireless  
Control System to a garage door or gate, be sure that people and  
objects are out of the way to prevent potential injury or damage.  
Do not use the HomeLinkWireless Control System with any garage  
door opener that lacks safety stop and reverse features as required by  
U.S. federal safety standards (this includes any garage door opener  
model manufactured before April 1, 1982). A garage door which cannot  
detect an object, signaling the door to stop and reverse, does not meet  
current U.S. federal safety standards. For more information, contact  
HomeLinkat: www.homelink.com or 1–800–355–3515.  
Retain the original transmitter for use in other vehicles as well as for  
future programming procedures (i.e. new HomeLinkequipped vehicle  
purchase). It is also suggested that upon the sale of the vehicle, the  
programmed Homelinkbuttons be erased for security purposes, refer to  
Programming in this section.  
134  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
Programming  
Do not program HomeLinkwith the vehicle parked in the garage.  
Note: Some vehicles may require the ignition switch to be turned to the  
accessory position for programming and/or operation of the HomeLink.  
It is also recommended that a new battery be placed in the hand-held  
transmitter of the device being programmed to HomeLinkfor quicker  
training and accurate transmission of the radio-frequency signal.  
Console mount  
Visor mount  
1. Position the end of your hand-held transmitter 1–3 inches (2–8 cm)  
away from the HomeLinkbutton you wish to program while keeping the  
indicator light in view.  
2. Simultaneously press and hold both the chosen HomeLinkand  
hand-held transmitter buttons until the HomeLinkindicator light  
changes from a slow to a rapidly blinking light. Now you may release  
both the HomeLinkand hand-held transmitter buttons.  
Note: Some entry gates and garage door openers may require you to  
replace Step 2 with procedures noted in the Gate Operator and  
Canadian Programming section for Canadian residents.  
135  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driver Controls  
3. Firmly press and hold for five seconds and release the  
programmed HomeLinkbutton up to two separate times to activate the  
door. If the door does not activate, press and hold the just-trained  
HomeLinkbutton and observe the indicator light.  
If the indicator light stays on constantly, programming is complete  
and your device should activate when the HomeLinkbutton is pressed  
and released.  
If the indicator light blinks rapidly for two seconds and then turns  
to a constant light continue with “Programming” Steps 4 through  
6 to complete programming of a rolling code equipped device (most  
commonly a garage door opener).  
4. At the garage door opener receiver (motor-head unit) in the garage,  
locate the “learn” or “smart” button (usually near where the hanging  
antenna wire is attached to the unit).  
5. Firmly press and release the “learn” or “smart” button. (The name and  
color of the button may vary by manufacturer.)  
Note: There are 30 seconds in which to initiate Step 6.  
6. Return to the vehicle and firmly press, hold for two seconds and  
release the HomeLinkbutton. Repeat the press/hold/release  
sequence again and, depending on the brand of the garage door opener  
(or other rolling code equipped device), repeat this sequence a third  
time to complete the programming.  
HomeLinkshould now activate your rolling code equipped device. To  
program additional HomeLinkbuttons begin with Step 1 in this section.  
For questions or comments, please contact HomeLink at  
www.homelink.com or 1–800–355–3515.  
136  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driver Controls  
Gate Operator & Canadian Programming  
Console mount  
Visor mount  
During programming, your hand-held transmitter may automatically stop  
transmitting — not allowing enough time for HomeLinkto accept the  
signal from the hand-held transmitter.  
After completing Step 1 outlined in the Programming section, replace  
Step 2 with the following:  
Note: If programming a garage door opener or gate operator, it is  
advised to unplug the device during the “cycling” process to prevent  
overheating.  
Continue to press and hold the HomeLinkbutton (note Step 2 in the  
Programming section) while you press and release — every two  
seconds (“cycle”) your hand-held transmitter until the frequency  
signal has been accepted by the HomeLink. The indicator light will  
flash slowly and then rapidly after HomeLinkaccepts the radio  
frequency signal.  
Proceed with Step 3 in the Programming section.  
137  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driver Controls  
Operating the HomeLinkWireless Control System  
Console mount  
Visor mount  
To operate, simply press and release the appropriate HomeLinkbutton.  
Activation will now occur for the trained product (garage door, gate  
operator, security system, entry door lock, or home or office lighting  
etc.). For convenience, the hand-held transmitter of the device may also  
be used at any time. In the event that there are still programming  
difficulties, contact HomeLinkat www.homelink.com or  
1–800–355–3515.  
138  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driver Controls  
Erasing HomeLinkbuttons  
Console mount  
Visor mount  
To erase the three programmed buttons (individual buttons cannot be  
erased):  
Press and hold the two outer HomeLinkbuttons until the indicator  
light begins to flash-after 20 seconds. Release both buttons. Do not  
hold for longer that 30 seconds.  
HomeLinkis now in the train (or learning) mode and can be  
programmed at any time beginning with Step 1 in the Programming  
section.  
Reprogramming a single HomeLinkbutton  
To program a device to HomeLinkusing a HomeLinkbutton previously  
trained, follow these steps:  
1. Press and hold the desired HomeLinkbutton. Do NOT release the  
button.  
2. The indicator light will begin to flash after 20 seconds. Without  
releasing the HomeLinkbutton, follow Step 1 in the Programming  
section.  
For questions or comments, contact HomeLinkat www.homelink.com  
or 1–800–355–3515.  
139  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driver Controls  
Car2UHome Automation System (if equipped)  
The Car2UHome Automation  
System is a universal transmitter  
located in the driver’s visor that  
includes two primary features – a  
garage door opener and a platform  
for remote activation of devices  
within the home. The Car2U௡  
system’s garage door opener  
function replaces the common  
hand-held garage door opener with a three-button transmitter that is  
integrated into the interior of your vehicle. After being programmed for  
garage doors, the Car2Usystem transmitter can be programmed to  
operate security devices and home lighting systems.  
WARNING: Make sure that people and objects are clear of the  
garage door or security device you are programming. Do not  
program the Car2Usystem with the vehicle in the garage.  
Do not use the Car2Usystem with any garage door opener that lacks  
safety stop and reverse features as required by U.S. Federal Safety  
Standards (this includes any garage door opener manufactured before  
April 1, 1982).  
Be sure to keep the original remote control transmitter for use in other  
vehicles as well as for future Car2Usystem programming. It is also  
recommended that upon the sale or lease termination of the vehicle, the  
programmed Car2Usystem buttons should be erased for security  
reasons. Refer to Erasing the Car2UHome Automation System  
buttons later in this section.  
Read the instructions completely before attempting to program the  
Car2Usystem. Because of the steps involved, it may be helpful to have  
another person assist you in programming the transmitter.  
Additional Car2Usystem information can be found on-line at  
www.learcar2U.com or by calling the toll-free Car2Usystem help line at  
1-866-572-2728.  
Types of garage door openers (rolling code and fixed code)  
The Car2UHome Automation System may be programmed to operate  
rolling code and fixed code garage door openers.  
Rolling code garage door openers were produced after 1996 and are  
code protected. Rolling code means the coded signal is changed every  
time your remote control garage door opener is used.  
140  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
Fixed code garage door openers were produced prior to 1996. Fixed  
code uses the same coded signal every time. It is manually  
programmed by setting DIP switches for a unique personal code.  
If you do not know if your garage  
door opener is a rolling code or  
O
N
1
2
4
5
9
11  
12  
10  
3
6
7
8
fixed code device, open your garage  
door opener’s remote control battery  
cover. If a panel of DIP switches is  
present your garage door opener is  
a fixed code device. If not, your  
garage door opener is a rolling code  
device.  
CTS 206-12  
T
124  
Rolling code programming  
Note: Programming the rolling code garage door opener involves  
time-sensitive actions. Read the entire procedure prior to beginning so  
you will know which actions are time-sensitive. If you do not follow the  
time-sensitive actions, the device will time out and you will have to  
repeat the procedure.  
Note: Do not program the Car2Usystem with the vehicle in the garage.  
Make sure that your key is on and engine off while programming the  
transmitter.  
1. Firmly press the two outer  
Car2Usystem buttons for  
1–2 seconds, then release.  
141  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driver Controls  
2. Go to the garage to locate the  
garage door opener motor and its  
“learn” button. You may need a  
ladder to reach the unit and you  
may need to remove the unit’s cover  
or light lens to locate the “learn”  
button. Press the “learn” button,  
after which you will have  
10–30 seconds to return to your  
vehicle and complete the following  
steps. If you cannot locate the  
“learn” button, refer to the Owner’s Guide of your garage door opener or  
call the toll-free Car2Usystem help line at 1-866-57Car2U  
(1-866-572-2728).  
3. Return to your vehicle. Press and  
hold the Car2Usystem button you  
would like to use to control the  
garage door. You may need to hold  
the button from 5–20 seconds,  
during which time the selected  
button indicator light will blink  
slowly. Immediately (within  
1 second) release the button once the garage door moves. When the  
button is released, the indicator light will begin to blink rapidly until  
programming is complete.  
4. Press and release the button again. The garage door should move,  
confirming that programming is successful. If your garage door does not  
operate, repeat the previous steps in this section.  
After successful programming, you will be able to operate your Car2U௡  
system by pressing the button you programmed to activate the opener.  
The indicator light above the selected button will turn on to confirm that  
the Car2Usystem is responding to the button command.  
To program another rolling code device such as an additional garage door  
opener, a security device or home lighting, repeat Steps 1 through 4  
substituting a different function button in Step 3 than what you used for  
the garage door opener. For example, you could assign the left-most  
button to the garage door, the center button to a security device, and  
the right-most button to another garage door opener.  
142  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driver Controls  
Note: The Car2Usystem allows for three devices to be programmed. If  
you need to change or replace any of the three devices after it has been  
initially programmed, it is necessary to erase the current settings using  
the Erasing the Car2UHome Automation System buttons procedure  
and then programming all of the devices being used.  
Fixed code programming  
Note: Do not program the Car2Usystem with the vehicle in the garage.  
Make sure that your key is on and engine off while programming the  
transmitter.  
1. To program units with fixed code DIP switches, you will need the  
garage door hand-held transmitter, paper and a pen or pencil.  
2. Open the battery cover and record the switch settings from left to  
right for all 8 to 12 switches. Use the figure below:  
When a switch is in the up, on, or + position, circle “L.”  
When a switch is in the middle, neutral, or 0 position, circle “M.”  
When a switch is in the down, off, or – position, circle “R.”  
Switch  
position  
Up, on  
or +  
Middle,  
neutral  
or 0  
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10 11 12  
L
L
L
L
L
L
L
L
L
L
M
R
L
M
R
L
M
R
M
M
M
M
M
R
M
R
M
R
M
R
M
R
Down,  
off or –  
R
R
R
R
L=left; M=middle; R=right  
143  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driver Controls  
3. To input these positions into the  
Car2Usystem, simultaneously  
press all three Car2Usystem  
buttons for a few seconds and then  
release to put the device into  
programming mode. The indicator  
lights will blink slowly. Within  
2.5 minutes enter your  
corresponding DIP switch settings  
from left to right into your Car2Usystem by pressing and releasing the  
buttons corresponding to the settings you circled.  
4. After inputting switch settings, simultaneously press and release all  
three Car2Usystem buttons. The indicator lights will turn on.  
5. Press and hold the Car2U௡  
system button you would like to use  
to control the garage door.  
Immediately (within 1 second)  
release the button once the garage  
door moves. During this time the  
selected button indicator light will  
blink slowly. Do not release the  
button until you see the garage door move. Most garage doors open  
quickly. You may need to hold the button from 5–55 seconds before  
observing movement of the garage door.  
6. The indicator light will (begin to) blink rapidly until programming is  
complete. If your garage door opener does not operate following these  
steps, repeat Steps 2 through 6. Otherwise, call the toll-free Car2Uhelp  
line at 1-866-57Car2U (1-866-572-2728).  
After successful programming, you will be able to operate your Car2U௡  
system by pressing the button you programmed to activate the opener.  
The indicator light above the selected button will turn on to confirm that  
the Car2Usystem is responding to the button command.  
Erasing the Car2UHome Automation System buttons  
Note: The system allows for three devices to be programmed. If you  
need to change or replace any of the three devices after it has been  
initially programmed, it will be necessary to erase the current settings  
using the procedure below and then reprogramming all of the devices  
being used.  
144  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driver Controls  
To erase programming on the Car2Usystem (individual buttons cannot  
be erased), use the following procedure:  
1. Firmly press the two outside  
Car2Usystem buttons  
simultaneously for approximately  
20 seconds until the indicator lights  
begin to blink rapidly. The indicator  
lights are located directly above the  
buttons.  
2. Once the indicator lights begin to  
blink, release your fingers from the  
buttons. The codes for all buttons  
are erased.  
If you sell your vehicle equipped with the Car2Usystem, it is  
recommended that you erase the programming for security reasons.  
FCC and RSS-210 Industry Canada Compliance  
The Car2Usystem complies with Part 15 of the FCC rules and with  
RSS-210 of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the following two  
conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2)  
This device must accept any interference received including interference  
that may cause undesired operation.  
Changes and modifications to the Car2Usystem transmitter by other  
than an authorized service facility could void authorization to use the  
equipment.  
CARGO COVER (IF EQUIPPED)  
Your vehicle may be equipped with a cargo area cover that covers the  
luggage compartment of your vehicle.  
To install the cover:  
Press both ends of the cover into  
the depressions (right side first) in  
the trim panels behind the second  
row seat.  
WARNING: To reduce the  
risk of injuries, the cargo  
area cover must be properly  
installed on the rear trim panels.  
145  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
WARNING: Do not place any objects on the cargo area cover.  
They may obstruct your vision or strike occupants of the vehicle  
in the case of a sudden stop or collision.  
Cargo management system  
The cargo management system consists of storage compartments located  
in the floor of the rear cargo area.  
7 passenger stowage:  
1. To open, lift up on the handle and  
the lid.  
2. To close, lower and press the lid  
down.  
5 passenger stowage:  
When the lid is open, it will stand  
up on its own.  
1. To open, lift the release handle  
and the lid.  
2. To close, lower the lid, lift the  
release handle and press down on  
the lid.  
146  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
REAR LIFTGATE  
The liftgate area is only intended for cargo, not passengers. You can open  
and close the liftgate from outside the vehicle. It cannot be opened from  
inside the cargo area.  
To open the liftgate window,  
press the control on the remote  
entry transmitter or, with the  
liftgate unlocked, press the  
control button on the right side  
under the license plate lamp  
shield.  
To open the liftgate, unlock the  
liftgate (with the power door  
locks, the remote entry or the  
keyless entry pad) and pull the  
middle lever under the license plate lamp shield.  
To lock the liftgate and the liftgate window, use the power door locks.  
The liftgate door and window should be closed before driving. If not,  
possible damage may occur to your vehicle.  
WARNING: Always close liftgate window before opening liftgate.  
Liftgate glass and liftgate should never be open at the same  
time. Failure to observe this warning may result in personal injury or  
damage to your vehicle.  
WARNING: Make sure the liftgate door and/or window are  
closed to prevent exhaust fumes from being drawn into the  
vehicle. This will also reduce the risk of passengers and cargo falling  
out.  
147  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
LUGGAGE RACK  
Your vehicle is equipped with a roof rack for transporting items on the  
exterior of the vehicle.  
The maximum recommended load to  
be carried on the roof rack is 100 lb  
(45 kg), evenly distributed. The  
cross-bars (if equipped) can be  
adjusted by using the thumbwheels  
at each end. Use the tie-down loops  
on the thumbwheels to secure load.  
To adjust cross-bar position (if  
equipped):  
1. Loosen the thumbwheel at both  
ends of the cross-bar (If the  
thumbwheel is too tight to release  
by hand, a small screwdriver or  
similar device can be used to release  
the torque by inserting the shaft  
into the tie-down loop and twisting  
the thumbwheel counterclockwise).  
Both cross-bars are adjustable.  
2. Slide the cross-bar to the desired location.  
3. Firmly retighten the thumbwheel at both ends of the cross-bar.  
Be sure to check that the thumbwheels are tight each time load is added  
or removed from the roof rack, and periodically while traveling. Always  
ensure that the load is secure before traveling.  
Note: When the cross-bars are not in use, they can either be removed or  
adjusted so that the rear crossbar is fully rearward, and the front  
crossbar is 10 inches from the front end-cap to decrease wind noise.  
Ford Motor Company recommends loading the roof rack only when  
equipped with (optional) crossbars, to avoid unintended damage to the  
roof panel.  
148  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driver Controls  
WARNING: Loaded vehicles, with a higher center of gravity,  
may handle differently than unloaded vehicles. Extra  
precautions, such as slower speeds and increased stopping distance,  
should be taken when driving a heavily loaded vehicle.  
WARNING: Vehicles with a higher center of gravity such as  
utility and four-wheel drive vehicles handle differently than  
vehicles with a lower center of gravity. Utility and four-wheel drive  
vehicles are not designed for cornering at speeds as high as passenger  
cars any more than low-slung sport cars are designed to perform  
satisfactorily under off-road conditions. Avoid sharp turns, excessive  
speed and abrupt maneuvers in these vehicles. Failure to drive  
cautiously could result in an increase risk of loss of vehicle control,  
vehicle rollover, personal injury and death.  
149  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Locks and Security  
KEYS  
One key operates all the locks and starts the vehicle. Always carry a  
spare key with you in case of an emergency.  
Your keys are programmed to your vehicle; using a non-programmed key  
will not permit your vehicle to start. If you lose your authorized dealer  
supplied keys, replacement keys are available through your authorized  
dealer. Refer to the SecuriLockpassive anti-theft system section later  
in this chapter for more information.  
POWER DOOR LOCKS  
Press control to unlock or lock all  
doors.  
Smart unlocking feature  
The smart unlocking feature helps prevent you from locking yourself out  
of the vehicle. With the key in any ignition position, the driver’s door will  
automatically unlock if it is locked using the lock control on the driver’s  
door panel while the driver’s door is open.  
Autolock  
The autolock feature will lock all the doors, liftgate and liftgate window  
when:  
all doors are closed,  
the ignition is in the on position,  
you shift into any gear putting the vehicle in motion, and  
the vehicle attains a speed greater than 12 mph (20 km/h).  
The autolock feature repeats when:  
any door is opened then closed while the ignition is in the on position  
and the vehicle speed is 9 mph (15 km/h) or lower, and  
the vehicle attains a speed greater than 12 mph (20 km/h).  
150  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Locks and Security  
Deactivating/activating autolock  
Your vehicle comes with the autolock feature enabled. There are four  
methods to enable/disable this feature:  
Through your authorized dealer, or  
Performing the power door lock control procedure, or  
Performing the keyless entry keypad (if equipped) procedure, or  
Performing the message center (if equipped) procedure.  
Note: The autolock feature can be activated/deactivated independently  
of the autounlock feature.  
Before following the activation or deactivation procedures, make sure  
that the anti-theft system is not armed, ignition is in the off position and  
all vehicle doors, liftgate and liftgate window are closed.  
Power door unlock/lock procedure  
You must complete Steps 1-5 within 30 seconds or the procedure will  
have to be repeated. If the procedure needs to be repeated, you must  
wait 30 seconds. Note: All doors must be closed and remain closed  
throughout the configuration process.  
1. Turn the ignition to the on  
position.  
2. Press the power door unlock  
control three times.  
3. Turn the ignition from the on to  
the off position.  
4. Press the power door unlock  
control three times.  
5. Turn the ignition back to the on position. The horn will chirp.  
6. Press the unlock control, then press the lock control. The horn will  
chirp once if autolock was deactivated or twice (one short and one long  
chirp) if autolock was activated.  
7. Turn the ignition to the off position. The horn will chirp once to  
confirm the procedure is complete.  
151  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Locks and Security  
Keyless entry keypad procedure  
1. Turn the ignition to the off position.  
2. Close all doors, the liftgate and liftgate window.  
3. Enter 5–digit entry code  
4. Press and hold the 3 4. While holding the 3 4 press the 7 8.  
5. Release the 7 8.  
6. Release the 3 4.  
The user should receive a horn chirp to indicate the system has been  
disabled or a chirp followed by a honk to indicate the system has been  
enabled.  
Message center procedure  
For information on activating/deactivating the autolock feature using the  
vehicle’s message center (if equipped), refer to Message center  
information in the Instrument cluster chapter.  
Autounlock  
The autounlock feature will unlock all the doors when:  
the ignition is in the on position, all the doors are closed, and the  
vehicle has been in motion at a speed greater than 12 mph (20 km/h);  
the vehicle has then come to a stop and the ignition is turned to the  
off or accessory position; and  
the driver door is opened within 10 minutes of the ignition being  
transitioned to the off or accessory position.  
Note: The doors will not autounlock if the vehicle has been  
electronically locked before the driver door is opened.  
Deactivating/activating autounlock  
Your vehicle comes with the autounlock feature activated. There are four  
methods to enable/disable this feature:  
Through your authorized dealer, or  
Performing the power door lock control procedure, or  
Performing the keyless entry keypad (if equipped) procedure, or  
Performing the message center (if equipped) procedure.  
Before following the activation or deactivation procedures, make sure  
that the anti-theft system is not armed, ignition is in the off position, and  
all vehicle doors, liftgate and liftgate window are closed.  
152  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Locks and Security  
Power door unlock/lock procedure  
You must complete Steps 1-5 within 30 seconds or the procedure will  
have to be repeated. If the procedure needs to be repeated, you must  
wait 30 seconds. Note: All doors must be closed and remain closed  
throughout the configuration process.  
1. Turn the ignition to the on  
position.  
2. Press the power door unlock  
control three times.  
3. Turn the ignition from the on to  
the off position.  
4. Press the power door unlock  
control three times.  
5. Turn the ignition back to the on position. The horn will chirp.  
6. Press the lock control, then press the unlock control. The horn will  
chirp once if autounlock was deactivated or twice (one short and one  
long chirp) if autounlock was activated.  
7. Turn the ignition to the off position. The horn will chirp once to  
confirm the procedure is complete.  
Keyless entry keypad procedure  
1. Turn the ignition to the off position.  
2. Close all doors, the liftgate and liftgate window.  
3. Enter 5–digit entry code  
4. Press and hold the 3 4. While holding the 3 4 press the 7 8  
twice.  
5. Release the 7 8.  
6. Release the 3 4.  
The user should receive a horn chirp to indicate the system has been  
disabled or a chirp followed by a honk to indicate the system has been  
enabled.  
Message center procedure  
For information on activating/deactivating the autounlock feature using  
the vehicle’s message center (if equipped), refer to Message center  
information in the Instrument cluster chapter.  
153  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Locks and Security  
Power door lock/unlock inhibit feature (if equipped)  
If the key is not in the ignition, all doors are closed, and the vehicle has  
been locked using the remote entry transmitter, keypad (if equipped) or  
the power door unlock control on the door panel while a front door is  
open (then subsequently closed), the power door unlock control on the  
door panel will become disabled 20 seconds after the lock event  
occurred. Your vehicle comes with this feature enabled, but there are  
two methods to disable it:  
Through your authorized dealer, or  
Performing the following power door lock control procedure.  
Before following the activation or deactivation procedures, make sure  
that the anti-theft system is not armed, ignition is in the off position, and  
all vehicle doors, liftgate and liftgate window are closed.  
You must complete Steps 1-5 within 30 seconds or the procedure will  
have to be repeated. If the procedure needs to be repeated, you must  
wait 30 seconds. Note: All doors must be closed and remain closed  
throughout the configuration process.  
1. Place the key in the ignition and turn the ignition to the on position.  
2. Press the power door unlock control on the door panel three times.  
3. Turn the ignition from the on position to the off position.  
4. Press the power door unlock control on the door panel three times.  
5. Turn the ignition back to the on position. The horn will chirp one time  
to confirm programming mode has been entered and is active.  
6. Press the power door lock control on the door panel two times within  
five seconds. The horn will chirp once if trim switch inhibit was  
deactivated or twice (one short and one long chirp) if trim switch inhibit  
was activated.  
7. Turn the ignition to the off position. The horn will chirp once to  
confirm the procedure is complete.  
154  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Locks and Security  
CHILDPROOF DOOR LOCKS  
When these locks are set, the  
rear doors cannot be opened from  
the inside.  
The rear doors can be opened  
from the outside when the doors  
are unlocked.  
The childproof locks are located on  
rear edge of each rear door and  
must be set separately for each  
door. Setting the lock for one door  
will not automatically set the lock for both doors.  
Move lock control up to engage the childproof lock.  
Move control down to disengage childproof locks.  
REMOTE ENTRY SYSTEM  
This device complies with part 15 of the FCC rules and with RSS-210 of  
Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the following two conditions:  
(1) This device may not cause harmful interference, and (2) This device  
must accept any interference received, including interference that may  
cause undesired operation.  
Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party  
responsible for compliance could void the user’s authority to  
operate the equipment.  
The typical operating range for your remote entry transmitter is  
approximately 33 feet (10 meters). A decrease in operating range could  
be caused by:  
weather conditions,  
nearby radio towers,  
structures around the vehicle, or  
other vehicles parked next to your vehicle.  
155  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Locks and Security  
The remote entry system allows you  
to lock or unlock all vehicle doors  
and liftgate, open the liftgate  
window without a key and activate  
the panic alarm.  
The remote entry lock/unlock  
feature operates in any ignition  
position. The liftgate glass feature  
operates as long as the vehicle’s  
speed is less than 3 mph (5 km/h).  
The panic feature operates with the  
key in the off position.  
If there is any potential remote keyless entry problem with your vehicle,  
ensure ALL remote entry transmitters are brought to the authorized  
dealer to aid in troubleshooting.  
Two step door unlocking  
1. Press  
and release to unlock the driver’s door. Note: The interior  
lamps will illuminate (refer to the Illuminated entry feature later in this  
section) if the control on the overhead lamp is not set to the off  
position and the perimeter alarm system (if equipped) will deactivate.  
2. Press  
and release again within three seconds to unlock the  
passenger doors, the liftgate and liftgate glass.  
The battery saver feature will turn off the interior lamps 30 minutes after  
the ignition is turned to the off position.  
One step door unlocking  
If the one step door unlocking feature is activated, press  
and release  
once to unlock all of the doors, the liftgate and liftgate glass. Note: The  
interior lamps will illuminate (refer to the Illuminated entry feature  
later in this section). If the control on the overhead lamp is in the door  
position, the perimeter alarm system (if equipped) will deactivate.  
Switching from two step to one step door unlocking  
Your vehicle comes with two step unlocking enabled. Unlocking can be  
switched between two step and one step door unlocking by pressing and  
holding both the  
and  
buttons simultaneously on the remote entry  
transmitter for approximately four seconds. The parklamps will flash  
twice to indicate that the vehicle has switched to one step unlocking.  
Repeat the procedure to switch back to two-step unlocking.  
156  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Locks and Security  
Locking the doors/liftgate  
1. Press and release to lock all the doors and liftgate. The lamps will  
flash. Note: If any door, the liftgate or the liftgate glass are not closed  
properly, the lamps will not flash.  
2. Press  
and release again within three seconds to confirm that all the  
doors are closed and locked. Note: The doors will lock again, the horn  
will chirp and the lamps flash once.  
Note: If any door, the liftgate or the liftgate glass are not closed  
properly, the horn will make two quick chirps.  
Opening the liftgate window  
Press  
to unlatch the liftgate window.  
Car finder  
Press  
twice within three seconds. The horn will chirp and the turn  
lamps will flash. It is recommended that this method be used to locate  
your vehicle, rather than using the panic alarm.  
Sounding a panic alarm  
Press  
to activate the alarm. The horn will sound and the parklamps  
will flash for a maximum of three minutes. Press again or turn the  
ignition to the on position to deactivate, or wait for the alarm to timeout  
in three minutes.  
Note: The panic alarm will only operate when the ignition is in the off  
position .  
Memory seats and adjustable pedals feature (if equipped)  
The remote entry system can also control the memory seat/adjustable  
pedals/easy entry-exit feature.  
Press  
to automatically move the seat and adjustable pedals to the  
desired memory position (the seat position corresponds to the  
transmitter being used).  
Activating the memory seat feature  
To activate this feature:  
1. Position the seat and adjustable pedals to the position desired.  
157  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Locks and Security  
2. Press the SET control on the  
lower-center portion of the  
instrument panel.  
3. Within five seconds, press one  
control on the remote transmitter  
and then press the 1 or 2 control on  
the lower-center portion of the  
instrument panel which you would  
like to associate with the seat and  
Driver 1 or Driver 2 positions.  
4. Repeat this procedure for another remote transmitter if desired.  
Deactivating the memory seat feature  
To deactivate this feature:  
1. Press the SET control on the driver’s door panel.  
2. Within five seconds, press any control on the remote transmitter  
which you would like to deactivate and then press the SET control on  
the lower-center portion of the instrument panel.  
3. Repeat this procedure for another remote transmitter if desired.  
Replacing the battery  
The remote entry transmitter uses one coin type three-volt lithium  
battery CR2032 or equivalent.  
To replace the battery:  
1. Twist a thin coin between the two  
halves of the remote entry  
transmitter near the key ring. DO  
NOT TAKE THE RUBBER COVER  
AND CIRCUIT BOARD OFF THE  
FRONT HOUSING OF THE  
REMOTE ENTRY TRANSMITTER.  
158  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Locks and Security  
2. Do not wipe off any grease on the  
battery terminals on the back  
surface of the circuit board.  
3. Remove the old battery.  
Note: Please refer to local  
regulations when disposing of  
transmitter batteries.  
4. Insert the new battery. Refer to  
the diagram inside the remote entry  
transmitter for the correct  
orientation of the battery. Press the battery down to ensure that the  
battery is fully seated in the battery housing cavity.  
5. Snap the two halves back together.  
Note: Replacement of the battery will not cause the remote transmitter  
to become deprogrammed from your vehicle. The remote transmitter  
should operate normally after battery replacement.  
Replacing lost remote entry transmitters  
If you would like to have your remote entry transmitter reprogrammed  
because you lost one, or would like to buy additional remote entry  
transmitters, you can either reprogram them yourself, or take all  
remote entry transmitters to your authorized dealer for  
reprogramming.  
How to reprogram your remote entry transmitters  
You must have all remote entry transmitters (maximum of six)  
available before beginning this procedure. If all remote entry transmitters  
are not present during the programming procedure, the transmitters that  
are not present during programming will no longer operate the vehicle.  
Note: Ensure the brake pedal is not depressed during this sequence.  
To reprogram the remote entry transmitters:  
1. Ensure the vehicle is electronically unlocked.  
2. Put the key in the ignition.  
159  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Locks and Security  
3. Turn the key from the 1 (off)  
position to 3 (on).  
3
4. Cycle eight times rapidly (within  
10 seconds) between the 1 (off)  
position and 3 (on). Note: The  
eighth turn must end in the 3 (on)  
position.  
2
4
5. The doors will lock, then unlock,  
to confirm that the programming  
mode has been activated.  
1
6. Within 20 seconds press any button on the remote entry transmitter.  
Note: If more than 20 seconds have passed you will need to start the  
procedure over again.  
7. The doors will lock, then unlock, to confirm that this remote entry  
transmitter has been programmed.  
8. Repeat Step 6 to program each additional remote entry transmitter.  
9. Turn the ignition to the 1 (off) position after you have finished  
programming all of the remote entry transmitters.  
10. The doors will lock, then unlock, to confirm that the programming  
mode has been exited.  
Illuminated entry  
The interior lamps illuminate when the remote entry system is used to  
unlock the door(s) or sound the personal alarm.  
The illuminated entry system will turn off the interior lights if:  
the ignition is turned to the accessory or on position, or  
the remote transmitter lock control is pressed, or  
after 25 seconds of illumination.  
The dome lamp control (if equipped) must not be set to the off position  
for the illuminated entry system to operate.  
The inside lights will not turn off if:  
they have been turned on with the dimmer control, or  
any door is open.  
The battery saver will shut off the interior lamps 10 minutes after the  
ignition has been turned to the off position.  
160  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Locks and Security  
SECURICODE™ KEYLESS ENTRY SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)  
You can use the keyless entry  
keypad to:  
lock or unlock the doors without  
using a key.  
open the liftgate window.  
activate or deactivate the  
autolock feature.  
The keypad can be operated with  
the factory set 5–digit entry code;  
this code is located on the owner’s  
wallet card in the glove box, is  
marked on the computer module,  
and is available from your  
authorized dealer. You can also  
create your own 5–digit personal  
entry code. In the event the wallet card is lost, the factory set code  
cannot be reprogrammed.  
When pressing the controls on the keypad, press the middle of the  
controls to ensure a good activation.  
Programming a personal entry code  
Up to three personal entry codes may be programmed to the vehicle. To  
create your own personal entry code:  
1. Enter the factory set code.  
2. Within five seconds press the 1 2 on the keypad.  
3. Enter your personal 5-digit code. Each number must be entered  
within five seconds of each other.  
4. Press 1 2, 3 4 or 5 6 to indicate which of the three personal  
entry code positions you wish to use.  
5. The doors will again lock then unlock to confirm that your personal  
key code has been programmed to the module.  
Tips:  
Do not set a code that uses five of the same number.  
Do not use five numbers in sequential order.  
The factory set code will work even if you have set your own personal  
code.  
161  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Locks and Security  
If you program a code to a position that already contains a set code,  
the previously-set code will be erased.  
Erasing personal code  
1. Enter the factory set 5–digit code.  
2. Within five seconds, press the 1 2 on the keypad and release.  
3. Press and hold the 1 2 for two seconds. This must be done within  
five seconds of completing Step 2.  
All personal codes are now erased and only the factory set 5–digit code  
will work.  
Anti-scan feature  
If the wrong code has been entered seven times (35 consecutive button  
presses), the keypad will go into an anti-scan mode. This mode disables  
the keypad for one minute and the keypad lamp will flash.  
The anti-scan feature will turn off after:  
one minute of keypad inactivity.  
pressing the  
control on the remote entry transmitter.  
the ignition is turned to the on position.  
Unlocking and locking the doors, liftgate and liftgate window using  
keyless entry  
To unlock the driver’s door, enter the factory set 5-digit code or one  
of the vehicle’s personal codes. Each number must be pressed within five  
seconds of each other. The interior lamps will illuminate.  
To unlock all doors and liftgate, press the 3 4 control within five  
seconds.  
To open the liftgate window, press the 5 6 control within five  
seconds.  
To lock all doors, liftgate and liftgate window, press the 7 8 and  
the 9 0 at the same time. Note: The driver’s door must be closed. You  
do not need to enter the keypad code first.  
SECURILOCKPASSIVE ANTI-THEFT SYSTEM  
SecuriLockpassive anti-theft system is an engine immobilization  
system. This system is designed to help prevent the engine from being  
started unless a coded key programmed to your vehicle is used. The  
use of the wrong type of coded key may lead to a “no-start” condition.  
162  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Locks and Security  
Your vehicle comes with two coded keys; additional coded keys may be  
purchased from your authorized dealer. The authorized dealer can  
program your spare keys to your vehicle or you can program the keys  
yourself. Refer to Programming spare keys for instructions on how to  
program the coded key.  
Note: The SecuriLockpassive anti-theft system is not compatible with  
non-Ford aftermarket remote start systems. Use of these systems may  
result in vehicle starting problems and a loss of security protection.  
Note: Large metallic objects, electronic devices that are used to  
purchase gasoline or similar items, or a second coded key on the same  
key chain may cause vehicle starting issues. You need to prevent these  
objects from touching the coded key while starting the engine. These  
objects will not cause damage to the coded key, but may cause a  
momentary issue if they are too close to the key when starting the  
engine. If a problem occurs, turn the ignition off, remove all objects on  
the key chain away from the coded key and restart the engine.  
Note: Do not leave a duplicate coded key in the vehicle. Always  
take your keys and lock all doors when leaving the vehicle.  
Anti-theft indicator  
The anti-theft indicator is located on top of the instrument panel.  
When the ignition is in the off position, the indicator will flash once  
every two seconds to indicate the SecuriLocksystem is functioning  
as a theft deterrent.  
When the ignition is in the on position, the indicator will glow for  
three seconds to indicate normal system functionality.  
If a problem occurs with the SecuriLocksystem, the indicator will flash  
rapidly or glow steadily when the ignition is in the on position. If this  
occurs, turn the ignition off then back to on to make sure there was no  
electronic interference with the programmed key. If the vehicle doesn’t  
start, try to start it with the 2nd programmed key and if successful  
contact your authorized dealership for key replacement. If the indicator  
still flashes rapidly or glows steadily, the vehicle will not start, contact  
your authorized dealer as soon as possible for service.  
Automatic arming  
The vehicle is armed immediately after switching the ignition to the  
accessory position.  
The theft indicator will flash every two seconds when the vehicle is  
armed.  
163  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Locks and Security  
Automatic disarming  
Switching the ignition to the on position with a coded key disarms the  
vehicle.  
The theft indicator will illuminate for three seconds and then go out.  
If the theft indicator stays on for an extended period of time or  
flashes rapidly, contact your authorized dealer as soon as possible.  
Replacement keys  
If your keys are lost or stolen and you don’t have an extra coded key,  
you will need to have your vehicle towed to an authorized dealer. The  
key codes need to be erased from your vehicle and new coded keys will  
need to be programmed.  
Replacing coded keys can be very costly. Store an extra programmed key  
away from the vehicle in a safe place to help prevent any  
inconveniences. Please visit an authorized dealer to purchase additional  
spare or replacement keys.  
Programming spare keys  
You can program your own coded keys to your vehicle.  
Tips:  
A maximum of eight keys can be coded to your vehicle.  
Only use SecuriLockkeys.  
You must have two previously programmed coded keys (keys that  
already operate your vehicle’s engine) and the new unprogrammed  
key(s) readily accessible.  
If two previously programmed coded keys are not available, you must  
take your vehicle to your authorized dealer to have the spare key(s)  
programmed.  
Please read and understand the entire procedure before you begin.  
1. Insert the first previously programmed coded key into the ignition.  
164  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Locks and Security  
2. Turn the ignition from the 1 (off)  
position to the 3 (on) position. Keep  
the ignition in the 3 (on) position  
for at least three seconds, but no  
more than 10 seconds.  
3. Turn the ignition to the 1 (off)  
position and remove the first coded  
key from the ignition.  
4. After three seconds but within  
ten seconds of turning the ignition  
to the 1 (off) position, insert the second previously coded key into the  
ignition.  
5. Turn the ignition from the 1 (off) position to the 3 (on) position. Keep  
the ignition in the 3 (on) position for at least three seconds, but no more  
than 10 seconds.  
6. Turn the ignition to the 1 (off) position and remove the second  
previously programmed coded key from the ignition.  
7. After three seconds but within twenty seconds of turning the ignition  
to the 1 (off) position and removing the previously programmed coded  
key, insert the new unprogrammed key (new key/valet key) into the  
ignition.  
8. Turn the ignition from the 1 (off) position to the 3 (on) position. Keep  
the ignition in the 3 (on) position for at least three seconds, but not  
more than 10 seconds.  
9. Remove the newly programmed coded key from the ignition.  
If the key has been successfully programmed it will start the vehicle’s  
engine and the theft indicator light will illuminate for three seconds and  
then go out.  
If the key was not successfully programmed, it will not start your  
vehicle’s engine and the theft indicator light will flash on and off, and  
you may repeat Steps 1 through 5. If failure repeats, bring your vehicle  
to your authorized dealer to have the new key(s) programmed.  
To program additional new unprogrammed key(s), wait twenty seconds  
and then repeat this procedure from Step 1.  
165  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
SEATING  
WARNING: Reclining the seatback can cause an occupant to  
slide under the seat’s safety belt, resulting in severe personal  
injuries in the event of a collision.  
WARNING: Do not pile cargo higher than the seatbacks to  
reduce the risk of injury in a collision or sudden stop.  
WARNING: Before returning the seatback to its original  
position, make sure that cargo or any objects are not trapped  
behind the seatback. After returning the seatback to its original  
position, pull on the seatback to ensure that it has fully latched. An  
unlatched seat may become dangerous in the event of a sudden stop or  
collision.  
Adjustable head restraints  
Your vehicle is equipped with front row outboard head restraints that are  
vertically adjustable.  
WARNING: To minimize the risk of neck injury in the event of a  
crash, the driver and passenger occupants should not sit in  
and/or operate the vehicle, until the head restraint is placed in its  
proper position. The driver should never adjust the head restraint  
while the vehicle is in motion.  
The adjustable head restraints  
consist of :  
a trimmed energy absorbing foam  
and structure (1),  
two steel stems (2),  
a guide sleeve adjust/release  
button (3),  
and a guide sleeve unlock/remove  
button (4).  
166  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
To adjust the head restraint, do the following:  
1. Adjust the seatback to an upright driving/riding position.  
2. Raise the head restraint by  
pulling up on the head restraint.  
3. Lower the head restraint by  
pressing and holding the guide  
sleeve adjust/release button and  
pushing down on the head restraint.  
Properly adjust the head restraint so that the top of the head restraint is  
even with the top of your head and positioned as close as possible to the  
back of your head. For occupants of extremely tall stature, adjust the  
head restraint to its full up position.  
WARNING: The adjustable head restraint is a safety device.  
Whenever possible it should be installed and properly adjusted  
when the seat is occupied.  
167  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
To remove the adjustable head restraint, do the following:  
1. Pull up the head restraint until it  
reaches the highest adjustment  
position.  
2. Simultaneously press and hold  
both the adjust/release button and  
the unlock/remove button, then pull  
up on the head restraint.  
To reinstall the adjustable head restraint, do the following:  
1. Insert the two stems into the  
guide sleeve collars.  
2. Push the head restraint down  
until it locks.  
Properly adjust the head restraint so that the top of the head restraint is  
even with the top of your head and positioned as close as possible to the  
back of your head. For occupants of extremely tall stature, adjust the  
head restraint to its full up position.  
168  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
WARNING: To minimize the risk of neck injury in the event of a  
crash, head restraints must be installed properly.  
Adjusting the front manual seat (if equipped)  
WARNING: Never adjust the driver’s seat or seatback when the  
vehicle is moving.  
WARNING: Always drive and ride with your seatback upright  
and the lap belt snug and low across the hips.  
Lift handle to move seat forward or  
backward.  
Pull lever up to adjust seatback.  
WARNING: Before  
returning the seatback to its  
original position, make sure that  
cargo or any objects are not  
trapped behind the seatback. After  
returning the seatback to its  
original position, pull on the  
seatback to ensure that it has fully  
latched. An unlatched seat may  
become dangerous in the event of  
a sudden stop or collision.  
169  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Using the manual lumbar support (if equipped)  
For more lumbar support, turn the  
lumbar support control toward the  
front of vehicle.  
For less lumbar support, turn the  
lumbar support control toward the  
rear of vehicle.  
Adjusting the front power seat (if equipped)  
WARNING: Never adjust the driver’s seat or seatback when the  
vehicle is moving.  
WARNING: Do not pile cargo higher than the seatbacks to avoid  
injuring people in a collision or sudden stop.  
WARNING: Always drive and ride with your seatback upright  
and the lap belt snug and low across the hips.  
WARNING: Reclining the seatback can cause an occupant to  
slide under the seat’s safety belt, resulting in severe personal  
injuries in the event of a collision.  
WARNING: Sitting improperly out of position or with the seat  
back reclined too far can take off weight from the seat cushion  
and affect the decision of the passenger sensing system, resulting in  
serious injury or death in a crash. Always sit upright against your  
seatback, with your feet on the floor.  
170  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
WARNING: To reduce the risk of possible serious injury: Do not  
hang objects off seat back or stow objects in the seatback map  
pocket (if equipped) when a child is in the front passenger seat. Do  
not place objects underneath the front passenger seat or between the  
seat and the center console (if equipped). Check the “passenger airbag  
off” or “pass airbag off” indicator lamp for proper airbag status. Refer  
to Front passenger sensing system section for additional details.  
Failure to follow these instructions may interfere with the front  
passenger seat sensing system.  
The control is located on the outboard side of the seat cushion.  
Press front to raise or lower the  
front portion of the seat cushion.  
Press rear to raise or lower the rear  
portion of the seat cushion.  
Press the control to move the seat  
forward, backward, up or down.  
171  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Press the control to recline the  
seatback forward or rearward.  
Using the power lumbar support (if equipped)  
The power lumbar control is located on the outboard side of the seat.  
Press one side of the control to  
adjust firmness.  
Press the other side of the control  
to adjust softness.  
Memory seats and adjustable pedals (if equipped)  
This system allows automatic  
positioning of the driver seat and  
adjustable pedals to two  
programmable positions.  
The memory seat control is located  
on the lower-center portion of the  
instrument panel.  
To program position 1, move the  
driver seat and pedals (if  
equipped) to the desired position  
using the associated controls. Press the SET control. The SET control  
indicator light will briefly illuminate. While the light is illuminated,  
press control 1.  
To program position 2, repeat the previous procedure using control 2.  
172  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
A position can be recalled:  
in any gearshift position if the ignition is not in the on position.  
only in P (Park) or N (Neutral) if the ignition is in the on position.  
A memory seat position may be programmed at any time.  
The memory positions are also recalled when you press your remote  
entry transmitter UNLOCK control if the transmitter is programmed to a  
memory position or when you enter a valid personal entry code that is  
programmed to a memory position.  
To program the memory feature to a remote entry transmitter and for  
more information on how to use the keypad, refer to Remote entry  
system and Keyless entry system in the Locks and Security chapter.  
Easy entry/exit feature (if equipped)  
The easy entry feature automatically moves the driver’s seat 2 inches  
(5 cm) forward when:  
the transmission is in P (Park)  
the key is inserted into the ignition cylinder  
(If the seat is located less than 2 inches [5 cm] from the front of the seat  
1
track, the seat will travel up to 4 inch (.64 cm) to the front of the seat  
track).  
The easy out feature automatically moves the driver’s seat 2 inches  
(5 cm) backward when:  
the transmission is in P (Park)  
the key is removed from the ignition cylinder  
(If the seat is located less than 2 inches (5 cm) from the rear of the seat  
1
track, the seat will travel up to 4 inch (.64 cm) to the rear of the seat  
track).  
If the memory setting is programmed through the remote transmitter,  
upon unlocking the door via remote entry system, the seat position will  
travel to the desired memory setting less 2 inches (5 cm). Once entering  
the vehicle and inserting the key in the ignition while in P (Park), the  
easy entry feature will move the seat an additional 2 inches (5 cm) to  
the desired memory location. See Locks and Security for activating the  
memory seat feature through the remote entry system.  
173  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Deactivating/activating the easy access/easy out feature  
The easy entry/exit feature can be turned off or on through the vehicle  
message center (if equipped). If your vehicle does not have a message  
center, the feature can be turned off or on through the following process:  
1. Put the key into the ignition (The driver seat may move forward if the  
easy entry/exit feature is activated).  
2. Place the ignition key into the on position (do not start the vehicle).  
When the vehicle is in the on position, the interior and exterior lights,  
the climate controls, and the radio are functional without the engine  
started. See Programming remote transmitters for ignition switch  
diagram.  
3. Turn the ignition key to the off position.  
4. Cycle the ignition key between the off position and the on position a  
total of three times ending with the ignition in the off position.  
5. Engage the forward or rearward seat switch.  
6. Remove the ignition key from the ignition switch. (The driver seat  
may move rearward if the easy entry/exit feature is activated).  
Steps 2 through 6 must be performed within a 20 second period. The  
easy entry/exit feature will be deactivated. Repeating the above process  
will also reactivate the easy entry/exit feature.  
Heated seats (if equipped)  
WARNING: Persons who are unable to feel pain to the skin  
because of advanced age, chronic illness, diabetes, spinal cord  
injury, medication, alcohol use, exhaustion, or other physical  
conditions, must exercise care when using the seat heater. The seat  
heater may cause burns even at low temperatures, especially if used  
for long periods of time. Do not place anything on the seat that  
insulates against heat, such as a blanket or cushion, because this may  
cause the seat heater to overheat. Do not puncture the seat with pins,  
needles, or other pointed objects because this may damage the heating  
element which may cause the seat heater to overheat. An overheated  
seat may cause serious personal injury.  
Note: Do not do the following:  
Place heavy objects on the seat  
Operate the seat heater if water or any other liquid is spilled on the  
seat. Allow the seat to dry thoroughly.  
174  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
The heated seat control is located in the lower center of the instrument  
panel.  
To operate the heated seats:  
Push control to activate.  
Push again to deactivate.  
REAR SEATS  
To have an unobstructed rear view, you can fold down the second and  
third row head restraints. Refer to the Folding down the 2nd row  
60/40 seats and bucket seats and 3rd row folding seat (if equipped)  
sections later in this chapter.  
If needed, when installing some high back child restraints, the head  
restraints of the second row seating positions can be removed. Insert a  
thin pointed object, such as a paper clip or pushpin, into the hole of  
each head restraint guide and while lifting up remove the head restraint.  
Store the head restraint in a secure location in the vehicle, such as on  
the floor against the rear of the front seats. To re-install the head  
restraint, line the posts up in the holes on the seat back with the head  
restraint strap facing the outside of the vehicle and push down until the  
head restraint locks into place. Lift gently to ensure it is locked into  
place.  
175  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Refer to Safety seats for children later in this chapter.  
WARNING: If the head restraint has been removed from a  
seating position to accommodate a high back child restraint, the  
head restraint must be re-installed prior to use of the seat by any other  
occupant in order to reduce the risk of personal injury in the event of  
a collision.  
Folding down the 2nd row 60/40 seats and bucket seats  
Ensure that the head restraint is in the down position and no objects  
such as books, purses or briefcases are on the floor in front of the  
second row seats before folding them down.  
1. Lower the head restraints by  
pulling on the strap.  
2. Locate the recline handle situated  
on the side of the seat cushion by  
the door.  
3. Pull up on the handle and push  
the seatback forward toward the  
front of the vehicle.  
176  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
To return the seat to the upright position (seats not equipped  
with E-Z entry):  
1. Pull up on the handle, and rotate  
the seatback until you hear a click,  
locking it in the upright position.  
2. Lift up on the head restraint until  
it locks into its original position.  
To return the seat to the upright position (E-Z entry equipped  
seats):  
1. Lift the seatback toward the rear  
of the vehicle.  
2. Rotate the seatback until you  
hear a click, locking it in the upright  
position.  
177  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
3. If the seat is to be occupied, lift  
up on the head restraint until it  
locks into its original position.  
WARNING: Before returning the seatback to its original  
position, make sure that cargo or any objects are not trapped  
behind the seatback. After returning the seatback to its original  
position, pull on the seatback to ensure that it has fully latched. An  
unlatched seat may become dangerous in the event of a sudden stop or  
collision.  
Placing the 2nd row 60/40 seats in cargo mode (if equipped)  
The 2nd row seats can be placed in a kneel down load floor position to  
allow more cargo space.  
To place the seats in the cargo mode:  
1. Fold down the 2nd row seat. See Folding down the 2nd row 60/40  
seats and bucket seats above.  
2. Lift the cargo mode lever located  
on the back of the seatback to kneel  
the seat down and get a flat loading  
floor.  
178  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Returning to the upright position from full lowered load floor  
position  
The seatback cannot be returned to the upright position until the seat is  
returned from the kneel down position. To return the seat to the upright  
position:  
1. Push the seat rearward until the  
latch is engaged. Use the cushion or  
seatback to return to the fold-down  
position. Do not use the recliner  
handle as it could cause damage to  
the handle.  
2. Return the seatback to the  
upright position.  
Adjusting the 2nd row seat for E-Z Entry  
The E-Z entry seat allows for easier entry and exit to and from the 3rd  
row seat.  
To enter the 3rd row seat:  
1. Fold down the 2nd row seat and release the handle. Refer to Folding  
down the 2nd row 60/40 seats and bucket seats earlier in this section.  
Note: When folding down the seat, lift the handle only once. When the  
seatback releases and folds, the handle should be released. Any further  
turning of the handle while the seatback releases, may damage the  
handle. Once the seatback is folded, a second lifting of the handle will  
detach the seat rear leg locking mechanism from the floor allowing the  
seat to tumble forward.  
2. Pull the handle up again until the  
seat releases from the floor.  
3. Push the seat upward and fold it  
away from the third row.  
179  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
WARNING: Always return the seat to the fully latched position  
before operating the vehicle.  
Returning the seat to the upright position  
Note: To return the seat from its tumbled position to its upright  
position, its rear legs should first be latched to the floor by dumping the  
seat down into position. The interlock mechanism will not allow the  
release of the seatback until the seat’s rear legs are fully latched to the  
floor. Once the rear legs are fully latched, the interlock will release the  
seatback, and it can then be returned to the upright position.  
To return the seat to a seating position:  
1. Push the seat down and latch to  
the floor with a moderate amount of  
effort and speed.  
2. Make sure the seat is latched to  
the floor.  
3. Bring the seat back to an upright  
position. The seatback should lock  
into position.  
Note: If the seat back will not  
return to the upright position,  
tumble the seat again and re-latch it to the floor. Be sure that cargo or  
other objects are not trapped underneath the seatback.  
4. Lift up on the head restraint until  
it locks into its original position.  
180  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
WARNING: Before returning the seatback to its original  
position, make sure that cargo or any objects are not trapped  
behind the seatback. After returning the seatback to its original  
position, pull on the seatback to ensure that it has fully latched. An  
unlatched seat may become dangerous in the event of a sudden stop or  
collision.  
Note: In vehicles equipped with 3rd row seats, the 2nd row  
recline/unlatch handle on the outboard sides of both 60% and 40% seats  
should not be used as a grab handle to raise the entire seat up from  
cargo mode (kneeling position), or to lower it from its tumbled position.  
This handle is there only to recline the seat back and to unlatch the rear  
seat/floor attachment, in order to tumble the seat in the forward  
direction. To raise the seat up from the cargo mode (kneeling position),  
the entire seat should be lifted up using the seat back or the seat  
cushion area as a grabbing surface.  
Exiting the 3rd row  
1. Lower the head restraints. See  
Folding down the 2nd row 60/40  
seats and buckets seats earlier in  
this section.  
2. Pull on the lever/strap (as  
equipped) located at the bottom  
right of the seat back to release the  
seat from the floor, and rotate the  
seat up towards the front seat.  
3. Follow the directions above to  
return the seatback from the load floor and to the upright position.  
181  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
3rd row folding seat (if equipped)  
Before folding the third row seats,  
fold the head restraints down by  
pulling on the strap located under  
the restraint.  
Pull up on the handle located  
behind the seatback while pushing  
the seatback forward and down into  
the seat cushion.  
WARNING: Before returning the seatback to its original  
position, make sure that cargo or any objects are not trapped  
behind the seatback. After returning the seatback to its original  
position, pull on the seatback to ensure that it has fully latched. An  
unlatched seat may become dangerous in the event of a sudden stop or  
collision.  
3rd row power folding seat (if equipped)  
Note: Be sure that head restraints are folded down before powering the  
3rd row seat down.  
182  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
The control buttons are located on  
the driver-side rear quarter trim  
panel (accessible from the liftgate  
area).  
Push the bottom portion of the  
control button to lower the desired  
seatback.  
Push the top of the control button  
to return the seatback to its original  
position.  
The power fold down seats will operate for 30 minutes after the  
ignition switch is in the 1 (off) position. The transmission must  
be in P (Park), and the liftgate or liftgate glass must be open.  
Similar to the battery saver feature, the power 3rd row seat will  
be disabled 30 minutes after turning the vehicle off. If the power  
3rd row seat is disabled after 30 minutes, the seat can be enabled  
by opening any door, pressing the unlock control on the remote  
entry transmitter, pressing any keyless keypad button (if  
equipped), or turning the ignition key.  
183  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
WARNING: Before returning the seatback to its original  
position, make sure that cargo or any objects are not trapped  
behind the seatback. After returning the seatback to its original  
position, pull on the seatback to ensure that it has fully latched. An  
unlatched seat may become dangerous in the event of a sudden stop or  
collision.  
SAFETY RESTRAINTS  
Personal Safety Systemா  
The Personal Safety Systemprovides an improved overall level of  
frontal crash protection to front seat occupants and is designed to help  
further reduce the risk of airbag-related injuries. The system is able to  
analyze different occupant conditions and crash severity before activating  
the appropriate safety devices to help better protect a range of  
occupants in a variety of frontal crash situations.  
Your vehicle’s Personal Safety Systemconsists of:  
Driver and passenger dual-stage airbag supplemental restraints.  
Front safety belts with pretensioners, energy management retractors,  
and safety belt usage sensors.  
Driver’s seat position sensor.  
Front passenger sensing system  
“Passenger airbag off” or “pass airbag off” indicator lamp  
Front crash severity sensor.  
Restraints Control Module (RCM).  
Restraint system warning light and back-up tone.  
The electrical wiring for the airbags, crash sensor(s), safety belt  
pretensioners, front safety belt usage sensors, driver seat position  
sensor, front passenger sensing system, and indicator lights.  
How does the Personal Safety Systemwork?  
The Personal Safety Systemcan adapt the deployment strategy of your  
vehicle’s safety devices according to crash severity and occupant  
conditions. A collection of crash and occupant sensors provides  
information to the Restraints Control Module (RCM). During a crash, the  
RCM may activate the safety belt pretensioners and/or either one or both  
stages of the dual-stage airbag supplemental restraints based on crash  
severity and occupant conditions.  
184  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
The fact that the pretensioners or airbags did not activate for both front  
seat occupants in a collision does not mean that something is wrong with  
the system. Rather, it means the Personal Safety Systemdetermined  
the accident conditions (crash severity, belt usage, etc.) were not  
appropriate to activate these safety devices. Front airbags are designed  
to activate only in frontal and near-frontal collisions, not rollovers,  
side-impacts, or rear-impacts unless the collision causes sufficient  
longitudinal deceleration.  
Driver and passenger dual-stage airbag supplemental restraints  
The dual-stage airbags offer the capability to tailor the level of airbag  
inflation energy. A lower, less forceful energy level is provided for more  
common, moderate-severity impacts. A higher energy level is used for  
the most severe impacts. Refer to Airbag supplemental restraints  
(SRS) section in this chapter.  
Front crash severity sensor  
The front crash severity sensor enhances the ability to detect the  
severity of an impact. Positioned up front, it provides valuable  
information early in the crash event on the severity of the impact. This  
allows your Personal Safety Systemto distinguish between different  
levels of crash severity and modify the deployment strategy of the  
dual-stage airbags and safety belt pretensioners.  
Driver’s seat position sensor  
The driver’s seat position sensor allows your Personal Safety Systemto  
tailor the deployment level of the driver dual-stage airbag based on seat  
position. The system is designed to help protect smaller drivers sitting  
close to the driver airbag by providing a lower airbag output level.  
Front passenger sensing system  
For airbags to do their job they must inflate with great force, and this  
force can pose a potentially deadly risk to occupants that are very close  
to the airbag when it begins to inflate. For some occupants, this occurs  
because they are initially sitting very close to the airbag. For other  
occupants, this occurs when the occupant is not properly restrained by  
safety belts or child safety seats and they move forward during pre-crash  
braking. The most effective way to reduce the risk of unnecessary  
injuries is to make sure all occupants are properly restrained. Accident  
statistics suggest that children are much safer when properly restrained  
in the rear seating positions than in the front.  
185  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
WARNING: Air bags can kill or injure a child in a child seat.  
NEVER place a rear-facing child seat in front of an active air  
bag. If you must use a forward-facing child seat in the front seat, move  
the seat all the way back.  
WARNING: Always transport children 12 years old and under in  
the back seat and always properly use appropriate child  
restraints.  
The front passenger sensing system can automatically turn off the front  
passenger airbag and passenger seat-mounted side airbag. The system is  
designed to help protect small (child size) occupants from frontal airbag  
deployments when they are seated or restrained in the front passenger  
seat contrary to proper child-seating or restraint usage  
recommendations. Even with this technology, parents are STRONGLY  
encouraged to always properly restrain children in a rear seating  
position. The sensor also turns off the passenger front airbag and  
passenger seat-mounted side airbag when the passenger seat is empty.  
Front safety belt usage sensors  
The front safety belt usage sensors detect whether or not the driver and  
front outboard passenger safety belts are fastened. This information  
allows your Personal Safety Systemto tailor the airbag deployment and  
safety belt pretensioner activation depending upon safety belt usage.  
Front safety belt pretensioners  
The safety belt pretensioners at the front outboard seating positions are  
designed to tighten the safety belts firmly against the occupant’s body  
during frontal collisions, and in side collisions and rollovers. This helps  
increase the effectiveness of the safety belts. In frontal collisions, the  
safety belt pretensioners can be activated alone or, if the collision is of  
sufficient severity, together with the front airbags.  
Front safety belt energy management retractors  
The front outboard safety belt energy management retractors allow  
webbing to be pulled out of the retractor in a gradual and controlled  
manner in response to the occupant’s forward momentum. This helps  
reduce the risk of force-related injuries to the occupant’s chest by  
limiting the load on the occupant. Refer to Energy management feature  
section in this chapter.  
Determining if the Personal Safety Systemis operational  
The Personal Safety Systemuses a warning light in the instrument  
cluster or a back-up tone to indicate the condition of the system. Refer  
186  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
to the Warning lights and chimes section in the Instrument Cluster  
chapter. Routine maintenance of the Personal Safety Systemis not  
required.  
The Restraints Control Module (RCM) monitors its own internal circuits  
and the circuits for the airbag supplemental restraints, crash sensor(s),  
safety belt pretensioners, front safety belt buckle sensors, front  
passenger sensing system, and the driver seat position sensor. In  
addition, the RCM also monitors the restraints warning light in the  
instrument cluster. A difficulty with the system is indicated by one or  
more of the following:  
The warning light will either flash or stay lit.  
The warning light will not illuminate immediately after the ignition is  
turned on.  
A series of five beeps will be heard. The tone pattern will repeat  
periodically until the problem and warning light are repaired.  
If any of these things happen, even intermittently, contact your  
authorized dealer as soon as possible. Unless serviced, the system may  
not function properly in the event of a collision.  
Safety restraints precautions  
WARNING: Always drive and ride with your seatback upright  
and the lap belt snug and low across the hips.  
WARNING: To reduce the risk of injury, make sure children sit  
in a rear seating position where they can be properly restrained.  
WARNING: Never let a passenger hold a child on his or her lap  
while the vehicle is moving. The passenger cannot protect the  
child from injury in a collision.  
WARNING: All occupants of the vehicle, including the driver,  
should always properly wear their safety belts, even when an  
airbag supplemental restraint system (SRS) is provided.  
WARNING: It is extremely dangerous to ride in a cargo area,  
inside or outside of a vehicle. In a collision, people riding in  
these areas are more likely to be seriously injured or killed. Do not  
allow people to ride in any area of your vehicle that is not equipped  
with seats and safety belts. Be sure everyone in your vehicle is in a  
seat and using a safety belt properly.  
187  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
WARNING: In a rollover crash, an unbelted person is  
significantly more likely to die than a person wearing a safety  
belt.  
WARNING: Each seating position in your vehicle has a specific  
safety belt assembly which is made up of one buckle and one  
tongue that are designed to be used as a pair. 1) Use the shoulder belt  
on the outside shoulder only. Never wear the shoulder belt under the  
arm. 2) Never swing the safety belt around your neck over the inside  
shoulder. 3) Never use a single belt for more than one person.  
WARNING: When possible, all children 12 years old and under  
should be properly restrained in a rear seating position.  
WARNING: Safety belts and seats can become hot in a vehicle  
that has been closed up in sunny weather; they could burn a  
small child. Check seat covers and buckles before you place a child  
anywhere near them.  
WARNING: Front and rear seat occupants, including pregnant  
women, should wear safety belts for optimum protection in an  
accident.  
Energy management feature  
This vehicle has a safety belt system with an energy management  
feature at the front seating positions to help further reduce the risk of  
injury in the event of a head-on collision.  
This safety belt system has a retractor assembly that is designed to  
extend the safety belt webbing in a controlled manner. This helps  
reduce the belt force acting on the user’s chest.  
WARNING: BELT AND RETRACTOR ASSEMBLY MUST BE  
REPLACED if the safety belt assembly automatic locking  
retractor feature or any other safety belt function is not operating  
properly when checked by an authorized dealer. Failure to replace the  
Belt and Retractor assembly could increase the risk of injury in  
collisions.  
188  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Combination lap and shoulder belts  
1. Insert the belt tongue into the proper buckle (the buckle closest to  
the direction the tongue is coming from) until you hear a snap and feel it  
latch. Make sure the tongue is securely fastened in the buckle.  
Front and rear seats  
2. To unfasten, push the release button and remove the tongue from the  
buckle.  
Front and rear seats  
All safety restraints in the vehicle are combination lap and shoulder  
belts. All of the passenger combination lap and shoulder belts have three  
types of locking modes described below:  
Vehicle sensitive mode  
This is the normal retractor mode, which allows free shoulder belt length  
adjustment to your movements and locking in response to vehicle  
movement. For example, if the driver brakes suddenly or turns a corner  
sharply, or the vehicle receives an impact of approximately 5 mph  
(8 km/h) or more, the combination safety belts will lock to help reduce  
forward movement of the driver and passengers.  
Webbing extraction sensitive mode  
The webbing sensitive locking mode locks the webbing and prevents  
more belt from being pulled out if the belt is pulled out too quickly. The  
belt will unlock when you stop pulling on it.  
189  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Automatic locking mode  
When to use the automatic locking mode  
In this mode, the shoulder belt is automatically pre-locked. The belt will  
still retract to remove any slack in the shoulder belt. The automatic  
locking mode is not available on the driver safety belt.  
This mode should be used any time a child safety seat, except a  
booster, is installed in passenger front or rear seating positions. Children  
12 years old and under should be properly restrained in a rear seating  
position whenever possible. Refer to Safety restraints for children or  
Safety seats for children later in this chapter.  
How to use the automatic locking mode  
Buckle the combination lap and  
shoulder belt.  
Grasp the shoulder portion and  
pull downward until the entire  
belt is pulled out.  
Allow the belt to retract. As the belt retracts, you will hear a clicking  
sound. This indicates the safety belt is now in the automatic locking  
mode.  
190  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
How to disengage the automatic locking mode  
Unbuckle the combination lap and shoulder belt and allow it to retract  
completely to disengage the automatic locking mode and activate the  
vehicle sensitive mode.  
WARNING: After any vehicle collision, the combination lap and  
shoulder belt system at all passenger seating positions must be  
checked by an authorized dealer to verify that the “automatic locking  
retractor” feature for child seats is still functioning properly, in addition  
to other checks for proper safety belt system function.  
WARNING: BELT AND RETRACTOR ASSEMBLY MUST BE  
REPLACED if the safety belt assembly “automatic locking  
retractor” feature or any other safety belt function is not operating  
properly. In addition, all safety belts should be checked for proper  
function. Failure to replace the belt and retractor assembly could  
increase the risk of injury in collisions.  
Safety belt pretensioner  
Your vehicle is equipped with safety belt pretensioners at the driver and  
right front passenger seating positions.  
The safety belt pretensioner tightens the safety belts firmly against the  
occupant’s body at the start of the crash.  
When the Safety Canopysystem, seat-mounted side airbags, and/or the  
front airbags are activated, the safety belt pretensioners for the driver  
and right front passenger seating positions will be activated when the  
respective seatbelt is properly buckled.  
WARNING: The driver and front passenger safety belt system  
(including retractors, buckles and height adjusters) must be  
replaced if the vehicle is involved in a collision that results in  
deployment of front airbags, seat-mounted side airbags and Safety  
Canopy, and safety belt pretensioners.  
Refer to the Safety belt maintenance section in this chapter.  
191  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Front safety belt height adjustment  
Your vehicle has safety belt height  
adjustments at the front outboard  
seating positions. Adjust the height  
of the shoulder belt so the belt rests  
across the middle of your shoulder.  
To adjust the shoulder belt height,  
squeeze and hold the buttons on the  
side and slide the height adjuster up  
or down. Release the buttons and  
pull down on the height adjuster to  
make sure it is locked in place.  
WARNING: Position the safety belt height adjusters so that the  
belt rests across the middle of your shoulder. Failure to adjust  
the safety belt properly could reduce the effectiveness of the safety  
belt and increase the risk of injury in a collision.  
Second row comfort guide  
The second row outboard  
lap/shoulder belt is equipped with a  
belt comfort guide. This guide is  
attached to the quarter trim panel  
and is used to adjust the comfort of  
the shoulder belt for smaller  
occupants in the outboard second  
row seats.  
192  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
To adjust the comfort guide:  
1. Slip the shoulder belt into the  
belt guide.  
2. Slide the guide up or down along  
the webbing so that the belt is  
centered on the occupant’s shoulder.  
WARNING: Position the safety belt comfort guide so that the  
belt rests across the middle of your shoulder. Failure to adjust  
the safety belt properly could reduce the effectiveness of the safety  
belt and increase the risk of injury in a collision.  
Safety belt extension assembly  
If the safety belt is too short when fully extended, there is an 8 inch  
(20 cm) safety belt extension assembly that can be added (part number  
611C22). This assembly can be obtained from an authorized dealer.  
Use only extensions manufactured by the same supplier as the safety  
belt. Manufacturer identification is located at the end of the webbing on  
the label. Also, use the safety belt extension only if the safety belt is too  
short for you when fully extended.  
WARNING: Do not use extensions to change the fit of the  
shoulder belt across the torso.  
Safety belt warning light and indicator chime  
The safety belt warning light illuminates in the instrument cluster and a  
chime sounds to remind the occupants to fasten their safety belts.  
193  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Conditions of operation  
If...  
Then...  
The driver’s safety belt is not  
buckled before the ignition  
switch is turned to the on  
position...  
The safety belt warning light  
illuminates 1-2 minutes and the  
warning chime sounds 4-8 seconds.  
The driver’s safety belt is  
buckled while the indicator  
light is illuminated and the  
warning chime is sounding...  
The driver’s safety belt is  
buckled before the ignition  
switch is turned to the on  
position...  
The safety belt warning light and  
warning chime turn off.  
The safety belt warning light and  
indicator chime remain off.  
Belt-Minderா  
The Belt-Minderfeature is a supplemental warning to the safety belt  
warning function. This feature provides additional reminders by  
intermittently sounding a chime and illuminating the safety belt warning  
light in the instrument cluster when the driver’s and front passenger’s  
safety belt is unbuckled.  
The Belt-Minderfeature uses information from the front passenger  
sensing system to determine if a front seat passenger is present and  
therefore potentially in need of a warning. To avoid activating the  
Belt-Minderfeature for objects placed in the front passenger seat,  
warnings will only be given to large front seat occupants as determined  
by the front passenger sensing system.  
Both the driver’s and passenger’s safety belt usages are monitored and  
either may activate the Belt-Minderfeature. The warnings are the same  
for the driver and the front passenger. If the Belt-Minderwarnings have  
expired (warnings for approximately five minutes) for one occupant  
(driver or front passenger), the other occupant can still activate the  
Belt-Minderfeature.  
When the Belt-Minderfeature is activated, the safety belt warning light  
illuminates and the warning chime sounds for six seconds every  
30 seconds, repeating for approximately five minutes or until the safety  
belts are buckled.  
194  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
The Belt-Minderfeature uses two different warning chimes. During the  
first minute of activation, the warning chime will sound once every  
second. The remaining warning chimes will sound twice every second  
while the system is activated.  
If...  
Then...  
The driver’s and front  
passenger’s safety belts are  
buckled before the ignition  
switch is turned to the on  
position or less than  
The Belt-Minderfeature will not  
activate.  
1-2 minutes have elapsed since  
the ignition switch has been  
turned on...  
The driver’s or front  
The Belt-Minderfeature is activated  
- the safety belt warning light  
illuminates and the warning chime  
sounds for six seconds every  
passenger’s safety belt is not  
buckled when the vehicle has  
reached at least 3 mph  
(5 km/h) and 1-2 minutes have 30 seconds, repeating for  
elapsed since the ignition  
approximately five minutes or until  
switch has been turned to on... the safety belts are buckled.  
The driver’s or front  
The Belt-Minderfeature is activated  
passenger’s safety belt becomes - the safety belt warning light  
unbuckled for approximately  
1 minute while the vehicle is  
traveling at least 3 mph  
illuminates and the warning chime  
sounds for six seconds every  
30 seconds, repeating for  
(5 km/h) and more than  
approximately five minutes or until  
1-2 minutes have elapsed since the safety belts are buckled.  
the ignition switch has been  
turned to on...  
195  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
The following are reasons most often given for not wearing safety belts  
(All statistics based on U.S. data):  
Reasons given...  
Consider...  
“Crashes are rare events”  
36700 crashes occur every day. The  
more we drive, the more we are  
exposed to “rare” events, even for  
good drivers. 1 in 4 of us will be  
seriously injured in a crash during  
our lifetime.  
“I’m not going far”  
3 of 4 fatal crashes occur within 25  
miles (40 km) of home.  
“Belts are uncomfortable”  
We design our safety belts to enhance  
comfort. If you are uncomfortable -  
try different positions for the safety  
belt upper anchorage and seatback  
which should be as upright as  
possible; this can improve comfort.  
Prime time for an accident.  
Belt-Minderreminds us to take a few  
seconds to buckle up.  
“I was in a hurry”  
“Safety belts don’t work”  
Safety belts, when used properly,  
reduce risk of death to front seat  
occupants by 45% in cars, and by  
60% in light trucks.  
“Traffic is light”  
Nearly 1 of 2 deaths occur in  
single-vehicle crashes, many when  
no other vehicles are around.  
Possibly, but a serious crash can do  
much more than wrinkle your clothes,  
particularly if you are unbelted.  
Set the example, teen deaths occur 4  
times more often in vehicles with  
TWO or MORE people. Children and  
younger brothers/sisters imitate  
behavior they see.  
“Belts wrinkle my clothes”  
“The people I’m with don’t  
wear belts”  
196  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Reasons given...  
Consider...  
“I have an airbag”  
Airbags offer greater protection when  
used with safety belts. Frontal airbags  
are not designed to inflate in rear and  
side crashes or rollovers.  
“I’d rather be thrown clear”  
Not a good idea. People who are  
ejected are 40 times more likely  
to DIE. Safety belts help prevent  
ejection, WE CAN’T “PICK OUR  
CRASH”.  
WARNING: Do not sit on top of a buckled safety belt or insert a  
latchplate into the buckle to avoid the Belt-Minderchime. To  
do so may adversely affect the performance of the vehicle’s airbag  
system.  
One-time disable  
If at any time the driver/front passenger quickly buckles then unbuckles  
the safety belt for that seating position, the Belt-Minderis disabled for  
the current ignition cycle. The Belt-Minderfeature will enable during  
the same ignition cycle if the occupant buckles and remains buckled for  
approximately 30 seconds. Confirmation is not given for the one time  
disable.  
Deactivating/activating the Belt-Minderfeature  
The driver and front passenger Belt-Minderare  
deactivated/activated independently. When deactivating/activating  
one seating position, do not buckle the other position as this will  
terminate the process.  
Read Steps 1 - 4 thoroughly before proceeding with the  
deactivation/activation programming procedure.  
Note: The driver and front passenger Belt-Minderfeatures must be  
disabled/enabled separately. Both cannot be disable/enabled during the  
same key cycle.  
197  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
The driver and front passenger Belt-Minderfeatures can be  
deactivated/activated by performing the following procedure:  
Before following the procedure, make sure that:  
The parking brake is set  
The gearshift is in P (Park)  
The ignition switch is in the off position  
The driver and front passenger safety belts are unbuckled  
WARNING: While the design allows you to deactivate your  
Belt-Minder, this system is designed to improve your chances of  
being safely belted and surviving an accident. We recommend you  
leave the Belt-Mindersystem activated for yourself and others who  
may use the vehicle. To reduce the risk of injury, do not  
deactivate/activate the Belt-Minderfeature while driving the vehicle.  
1. Turn the ignition switch to the on position. DO NOT START THE  
ENGINE.  
2. Wait until the safety belt warning light turns off (Approximately one  
minute).  
Step 3 must be completed within 50 seconds after the safety belt  
warning light turns off.  
3. For the seating position being disabled, buckle then unbuckle the  
safety belt nine times at a moderate speed, ending in the unbuckled  
state. Step 3 must be completed within 50 seconds after the safety belt  
warning light turns off.  
After Step 3, the safety belt warning light will be turned on for three  
seconds.  
4. Within approximately seven seconds of the light turning off, buckle  
then unbuckle the safety belt.  
This will disable the Belt-Minderfeature for that seating position if it  
is currently enabled. As confirmation, the safety belt warning light will  
flash four times per second for three seconds.  
This will enable the Belt-Minderfeature for that seating position if it  
is currently disabled. As confirmation, the safety belt warning light will  
flash four times per second for three seconds, followed by three  
seconds with the light off, then followed by the safety belt warning  
light flashing four times per second for three seconds again.  
198  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
AIRBAG SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM (SRS)  
Important SRS precautions  
The SRS is designed to work with  
the safety belt to help protect the  
driver and right front passenger  
from certain upper body injuries.  
Airbags DO NOT inflate slowly;  
there is a risk of injury from a  
deploying airbag.  
WARNING: All occupants of the vehicle, including the driver,  
should always properly wear their safety belts, even when an air  
bag supplemental restraint system (SRS) is provided.  
WARNING: When possible, all children 12 years old and under  
should be properly restrained in a rear seating position.  
WARNING: The National Highway Traffic Safety Administration  
(NHTSA) recommends a minimum distance of at least 10 inches  
(25 cm) between an occupant’s chest and the driver airbag module.  
199  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
WARNING: Never place your arm over the airbag module as a  
deploying airbag can result in serious arm fractures or other  
injuries.  
To properly position yourself away from the airbag:  
Move your seat to the rear as far as you can while still reaching the  
pedals comfortably.  
Recline the seat slightly one or two degrees from the upright position.  
WARNING: Do not put anything on or over the airbag module.  
Placing objects on or over the airbag inflation area may cause  
those objects to be propelled by the airbag into your face and torso  
causing serious injury.  
WARNING: Do not attempt to service, repair, or modify the  
airbag supplemental restraint systems or its fuses. Contact your  
authorized dealer as soon as possible.  
WARNING: Modifications to the front end of the vehicle,  
including frame, bumper, front end body structure and non-Ford  
tow hooks may effect the performance of the airbag sensors increasing  
the risk of injury. Do not modify the front end of the vehicle with  
anything other than authorized Ford accessories for your vehicle.  
WARNING: Additional equipment may affect the performance of  
the airbag sensors increasing the risk of injury.  
200  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Children and airbags  
Children must always be properly  
restrained. Accident statistics  
suggest that children are safer when  
properly restrained in the rear  
seating positions than in the front  
seating position. Failure to follow  
these instructions may increase the  
risk of injury in a collision.  
WARNING: Airbags can kill  
or injure a child in a child  
seat. NEVER place a rear-facing  
child seat in front of an active  
airbag. If you must use a  
forward-facing child seat in the  
front seat, move the seat all the  
way back.  
How does the airbag supplemental restraint system work?  
The airbag SRS is designed to  
activate when the vehicle sustains  
longitudinal deceleration sufficient  
to cause the sensors to close an  
electrical circuit that initiates airbag  
inflation.  
The fact that the airbags did not  
inflate in a collision does not mean  
that something is wrong with the  
system. Rather, it means the forces  
were not of the type sufficient to  
cause activation. Front airbags are designed to activate in frontal and  
near-frontal collisions, not rollover, side-impact, or rear-impacts unless  
the collision causes sufficient longitudinal deceleration.  
201  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
The airbags inflate and deflate  
rapidly upon activation. After airbag  
deployment, it is normal to notice a  
smoke-like, powdery residue or  
smell the burnt propellant. This may  
consist of cornstarch, talcum  
powder (to lubricate the bag) or  
sodium compounds (e.g., baking  
soda) that result from the  
combustion process that inflates the  
airbag. Small amounts of sodium  
hydroxide may be present which  
may irritate the skin and eyes, but  
none of the residue is toxic.  
While the system is designed to help  
reduce serious injuries, contact with  
a deploying airbag may also cause abrasions, swelling or temporary  
hearing loss. Because airbags must inflate rapidly and with considerable  
force, there is the risk of death or serious injuries such as fractures,  
facial and eye injuries or internal injuries, particularly to occupants who  
are not properly restrained or are otherwise out of position at the time  
of airbag deployment. Thus, it is extremely important that occupants be  
properly restrained as far away from the airbag module as possible while  
maintaining vehicle control.  
WARNING: Several air bag system components get hot after  
inflation. Do not touch them after inflation.  
WARNING: If the air bag has deployed, the air bag will not  
function again and must be replaced immediately. If the air  
bag is not replaced, the unrepaired area will increase the risk of injury  
in a collision.  
The SRS consists of:  
driver and passenger airbag modules (which include the inflators and  
airbags).  
seat-mounted side airbags. Refer to Seat-mounted side airbag system  
later in this chapter  
Safety Canopysystem. Refer to Safety Canopysystem later in this  
chapter.  
202  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
one or more impact and safing sensors.  
a readiness light and tone.  
diagnostic module.  
and the electrical wiring which connects the components.  
Front passenger sensing system. Refer to Front passenger sensing  
system later in this chapter.  
“Passenger airbag off” or “pass airbag off” indicator lamp. Refer to  
Front passenger sensing system later in this chapter.  
The diagnostic module monitors its own internal circuits and the  
supplemental airbag electrical system wiring (including the impact  
sensors), the system wiring, the airbag system readiness light, the airbag  
back up power and the airbag ignitors.  
Front passenger sensing system  
The front passenger sensing system is designed to meet the regulatory  
requirements of Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard (FMVSS) 208  
and is designed to disable (will not inflate) the front passenger’s frontal  
airbag under certain conditions.  
The front passenger sensing system works with sensors that are part of  
the front passenger’s seat and safety belt. The sensors are designed to  
detect the presence of a properly seated occupant and determine if the  
front passenger’s frontal airbag should be enabled (may inflate) or  
disabled (will not inflate).  
The front passenger sensing system will disable (will not inflate) the  
front passenger’s frontal airbag if:  
the front passenger seat is unoccupied, or has small/medium objects in  
the front seat.  
the system determines that an infant is present in a rear-facing infant  
seat that is installed according to the manufacturer’s instructions.  
the system determines that a small child is present in a forward-facing  
child restraint that is installed according to the manufacturer’s  
instructions.  
the system determines that a small child is present in a booster seat.  
a front passenger takes his/her weight off of the seat for a period of  
time.  
When the passenger airbag off light is illuminated, the passenger side  
airbag may be disabled to avoid the risk of airbag deployment injuries.  
203  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
The front passenger sensing system  
uses a Љpassenger airbag offЉ or  
Љpass airbag offЉ indicator which will  
illuminate and stay lit to remind you  
that the front passenger frontal airbag is disabled. The indicator lamp is  
located in the center stack of the instrument panel above the radio.  
Note: The indicator lamp will illuminate for a short period of time when  
the ignition is turned to the on position to confirm it is functional.  
When the front passenger seat is not occupied (empty seat) or in the  
event that the front passenger frontal airbag is enabled (may inflate), the  
indicator lamp will be unlit.  
The front passenger sensing system is designed to disable (will not  
inflate) the front passenger’s frontal airbag when a rear facing infant  
seat, a forward-facing child restraint, or a booster seat is detected.  
When the front passenger sensing system disables (will not inflate)  
the front passenger frontal airbag, the indicator lamp will illuminate  
and stay lit to remind you that the front passenger frontal airbag is  
disabled.  
If the child restraint has been installed and the indicator lamp is not  
lit, then turn the vehicle off, remove the child restraint from the  
vehicle and reinstall the restraint following the child restraint  
manufacturer’s instructions.  
The front passenger sensing system is designed to enable (may inflate)  
the front passenger’s frontal airbag anytime the system senses that a  
person of adult size is sitting properly in the front passenger seat.  
When the front passenger sensing system enables the front passenger  
frontal airbag (may inflate), the indicator will be unlit and stay unlit.  
If a person of adult size is sitting in the front passenger’s seat, but the  
Љpassenger airbag offЉ or Љpass airbag offЉ indicator lamp is lit, it is  
possible that the person isn’t sitting properly in the seat. If this happens:  
Turn the vehicle off and ask the person to place the seatback in the  
full upright position.  
Have the person sit upright in the seat, centered on the seat cushion,  
with the person’s legs comfortably extended.  
Restart the vehicle and have the person remain in this position for  
about two minutes. This will allow the system to detect that person  
and enable the passenger’s frontal airbag.  
If the indicator lamp remains lit even after this, the person should be  
advised to ride in the rear seat.  
204  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Pass Airbag Off  
Passenger Airbag  
Indicator Lamp  
Occupant  
Empty seat  
Small child in child  
safety seat or booster  
Unlit  
Lit  
Disabled  
Disabled  
Small child with safety Lit  
belt buckled or  
unbuckled  
Disabled  
Enabled  
Adult  
Unlit  
WARNING: Even with Advanced Restraints Systems, children  
12 and under should be properly restrained in a rear seating  
position.  
After all occupants have adjusted their seats and put on safety belts, it’s  
very important that they continue to sit properly. A properly seated  
occupant sits upright, leaning against the seat back, and centered on the  
seat cushion, with their feet comfortably extended on the floor. Sitting  
improperly can increase the chance of injury in a crash event. For  
example, if an occupant slouches, lies down, turns sideways, sits forward,  
leans forward or sideways, or puts one or both feet up, the chance of  
injury during a crash is greatly increased.  
WARNING: Sitting improperly out of position or with the seat  
back reclined too far can take off weight from the seat cushion  
and affect the decision of the front passenger sensing system, resulting  
in serious injury or death in a crash.  
Always sit upright against your seatback, with your feet on the floor.  
The front passenger sensing system may detect small or medium objects  
placed on the seat cushion. For most objects that are in the front  
passenger seat, the passenger airbag will be disabled. Even though the  
passenger airbag is disabled, the Љpass airbag offЉ lamp may or may not  
be illuminated according to the table below.  
205  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Pass Airbag Off  
Objects  
Passenger Airbag  
Indicator Lamp  
Small (i.e. three-ring  
binder, small purse,  
bottled water)  
Unlit  
Disabled  
Medium (i.e. heavy  
briefcase, fully packed  
luggage)  
Empty seat, or small  
to medium object with  
safety belt buckled  
Lit  
Disabled  
Disabled  
Lit  
If you think that the status of the passenger airbag off indicator lamp is  
incorrect, check for the following:  
Objects lodged underneath the seat  
Objects between the seat cushion and the center console (if  
equipped)  
Objects hanging off the seat back  
Objects stowed in the seatback map pocket (if equipped)  
Objects placed on the occupant’s lap  
Cargo interference with the seat  
Other passengers pushing or pulling on the seat  
Rear passenger feet and knees resting or pushing on the seat  
Check to see if the clear objects by pass seat warning is displaying in  
the message center. Refer to Message center in the Driver controls  
chapter.  
The conditions listed above may cause the weight of a properly seated  
occupant to be incorrectly interpreted by the front passenger sensing  
system. The person in the front passenger seat may appear heavier or  
lighter due to the conditions described in the list above.  
WARNING: To reduce the risk of possible serious injury:  
Do not stow objects in seat back map pocket (if equipped) or  
hang objects off seat back if a child is in the front passenger seat.  
Do not place objects underneath the front passenger seat or between  
the seat and the center console (if equipped).  
Check the “passenger airbag off” or “pass airbag off” indicator lamp for  
proper airbag Status.  
Failure to follow these instructions may interfere with the front  
passenger seat sensing system.  
206  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
In case there is a problem with the  
front passenger sensing system, the  
airbag readiness lamp in the  
instrument cluster will stay lit.  
If the airbag readiness lamp is lit, do the following:  
The driver and/or adult passengers should check for any objects that  
may be lodged underneath the front passenger seat or cargo interfering  
with the seat.  
If objects are lodged and/or cargo is interfering with the seat; please take  
the following steps to remove the obstruction:  
Pull the vehicle over.  
Turn the vehicle off.  
Driver and/or adult passengers should check for any objects lodged  
underneath the front passenger seat or cargo interfering with the seat.  
Remove the obstruction(s) (if found).  
Restart the vehicle.  
Wait at least two minutes and verify that the airbag readiness lamp is  
no longer illuminated  
If the airbag readiness lamp remains illuminated, this may or may/not  
be a problem due to the front passenger sensing system.  
DO NOT attempt to repair or service the system; contact your authorized  
dealer as soon as possible.  
If it is necessary to modify an advanced front airbag system to  
accommodate a person with disabilities, contact the Ford Customer  
Relationship Center at the phone number shown in the Customer  
Assistance chapter of this Owner’s Guide.  
WARNING: Any alteration/modification to the front passenger  
seat may affect the performance of the front passenger sensing  
system.  
Determining if the system is operational  
The SRS uses a readiness light in the instrument cluster or a tone to  
indicate the condition of the system. Refer to Airbag readiness section  
in the Instrument Cluster chapter. Routine maintenance of the airbag is  
not required.  
207  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
A difficulty with the system is indicated by one or more of the following:  
The readiness light will either  
flash or stay lit.  
The readiness light will not  
illuminate immediately after  
ignition is turned on.  
A series of five beeps will be heard. The tone pattern will repeat  
periodically until the problem and/or light are repaired.  
If any of these things happen, even intermittently, contact your  
authorized dealer as soon as possible. Unless serviced, the system may  
not function properly in the event of a collision.  
Seat-mounted side airbag system  
WARNING: Do not place objects or mount equipment on or  
near the airbag cover on the side of the seatbacks of the front  
seats or in front seat areas that may come into contact with a  
deploying airbag. Failure to follow these instructions may increase the  
risk of personal injury in the event of a collision.  
WARNING: Do not use accessory seat covers. The use of  
accessory seat covers may prevent the deployment of the side  
airbags and increase the risk of injury in an accident.  
WARNING: Do not lean your head on the door. The side airbag  
could injure you as it deploys from the side of the seatback.  
WARNING: Do not attempt to service, repair, or modify the  
airbag SRS, its fuses or the seat cover on a seat containing an  
airbag. Contact your authorized dealer as soon as possible.  
WARNING: All occupants of the vehicle should always wear  
their safety belts even when an airbag SRS is provided.  
How does the side airbag system work?  
The design and development of the side airbag system included  
recommended testing procedures that were developed by a group of  
208  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
automotive safety experts known as the Side Airbag Technical Working  
Group. These recommended testing procedures help reduce the risk of  
injuries related to the deployment of side airbags.  
The side airbag system consists of  
the following:  
An inflatable nylon bag (airbag)  
with an inflator concealed behind  
the outboard bolster of the driver  
and front passenger seatbacks.  
A special seat cover designed to  
allow airbag deployment.  
The same warning light,  
electronic control and diagnostic  
unit as used for the front airbags.  
Crash sensors located on the  
front doors and C pillars (one  
sensor on each pillar on each side  
of the vehicle).  
Side airbags, in combination with  
safety belts, can help reduce the risk of severe injuries in the event of a  
significant side impact collision.  
The side airbags are fitted on the outboard side of the seatbacks of the  
front seats. In certain lateral collisions, the airbag on the side affected by  
the collision will be inflated. The airbag was designed to inflate between  
the door panel and occupant to further enhance the protection provided  
occupants in side impact collisions.  
The airbag SRS is designed to activate when the vehicle sustains lateral  
deceleration sufficient to cause the sensors to close an electrical circuit  
that initiates airbag inflation.  
The fact that the airbags did not inflate in a collision does not mean that  
something is wrong with the system. Rather, it means the forces were  
not of the type sufficient to cause activation. Side airbags are designed  
to inflate in side-impact collisions, not roll-over, rear-impact, frontal or  
near-frontal collisions, unless the collision causes sufficient lateral  
deceleration.  
WARNING: Several air bag system components get hot after  
inflation. Do not touch them after inflation.  
209  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
WARNING: If the side  
airbag has deployed, the  
airbag will not function again.  
The side airbag system  
(including the seat) must be  
inspected and serviced by an  
authorized dealer . If the airbag  
is not replaced, the unrepaired  
area will increase the risk of injury  
in a collision.  
Safety Canopysystem  
WARNING: Do not place  
objects or mount equipment  
on or near the headliner at the  
siderail that may come into  
contact with a deploying Safety  
Canopy. Failure to follow these  
instructions may increase the risk  
of personal injury in the event of a  
collision.  
WARNING: Do not lean your head on the door. The Safety  
Canopycould injure you as it deploys from the headliner.  
WARNING: Do not attempt to service, repair, or modify the  
Safety Canopysystem, its fuses, the A, B, or C pillar trim, or  
the headliner on a vehicle containing a Safety Canopy. Contact your  
authorized dealer as soon as possible.  
210  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
WARNING: All occupants of the vehicle including the driver  
should always wear their safety belts even when an airbag SRS  
and Safety Canopysystem is provided.  
WARNING: To reduce risk of injury, do not obstruct or place  
objects in the deployment path of the inflatable Safety Canopy.  
How does the Safety Canopysystem work?  
The design and development of the  
Safety Canopysystem included  
recommended testing procedures  
that were developed by a group of  
automotive safety experts known as  
the Side Airbag Technical Working  
Group. These recommended testing  
procedures help reduce the risk of  
injuries related to the deployment of  
side airbags (including the Safety  
Canopy).  
The Safety Canopysystem consists  
of the following:  
An inflatable nylon curtain with  
an inflator concealed behind the  
headliner and above the doors  
(one on each side of the vehicle).  
A headliner that will flex to open  
above the side doors to allow Safety Canopydeployment.  
The same warning light, electronic control and diagnostic unit as used  
for the front airbags.  
Two side crash sensors mounted at the front doors (one on each side  
of the vehicle).  
Two side crash sensors located at the c-pillar behind the rear doors  
(one on each side of the vehicle).  
Roll over sensor in the restraints control module (RCM).  
211  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
The Safety Canopysystem, in combination with safety belts, can help  
reduce the risk of severe injuries in the event of a significant side impact  
collision or rollover event.  
Children 12 years old and under should always be properly restrained in  
the second or third row seats (if equipped). The Safety Canopywill not  
interfere with children restrained using a properly installed child or  
booster seat because it is designed to inflate downward from the  
headliner above the doors along the side window openings.  
The Safety Canopysystem is designed to activate when the vehicle  
sustains lateral deceleration sufficient to cause the side crash sensor to  
close an electrical circuit that initiates Safety Canopyinflation or when  
a certain likelihood of a rollover event is detected by the rollover sensor.  
The Safety Canopyis mounted to the roof side-rail sheet metal, behind  
the headliner, above the first and second row seats. In certain lateral  
collisions or rollover events, the Safety Canopysystem will be activated,  
regardless of which seats are occupied. The Safety Canopyis designed  
to inflate between the side window area and occupants to further  
enhance protection provided in side impact collisions and rollover events.  
The fact that the Safety Canopysystem did not activate in a collision  
does not mean that something is wrong with the system. Rather, it  
means the forces were not of the type sufficient to cause activation. The  
Safety Canopyis designed to inflate in certain side impact collisions or  
rollover events, not in rear impact, frontal or near-frontal collisions,  
unless the collision causes sufficient lateral deceleration or rollover  
likelihood.  
WARNING: Several Safety Canopysystem components get hot  
after inflation. Do not touch them after inflation.  
212  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
WARNING: If the Safety Canopysystem has deployed, the  
Safety Canopywill not function again. The Safety  
Canopysystem (including the A, B and C pillar trim) must be  
inspected and serviced by an authorized dealer. If the Safety  
Canopyis not replaced, the unrepaired area will increase the risk of  
injury in a collision.  
Determining if the system is operational  
The SRS uses a readiness light in the instrument cluster or a tone to  
indicate the condition of the system. Refer to the Airbag readiness  
section in the Instrument Cluster chapter. Routine maintenance of the  
airbag is not required.  
Any difficulty with the system is indicated by one or more of the  
following:  
The readiness light (same light as for front airbag system) will either  
flash or stay lit.  
The readiness light will not illuminate immediately after ignition is  
turned on.  
A series of five beeps will be heard. The tone pattern will repeat  
periodically until the problem and light are repaired.  
If any of these things happen, even intermittently, contact your  
authorized dealer as soon as possible. Unless serviced, the system may  
not function properly in the event of a collision or rollover event.  
SOS Post-Crash Alert System™  
The SOS Post-Crash Alert automatically flashes the turn signal lamps and  
sounds the horn three times at four second intervals in the event of a  
serious impact that deploys an airbag (front, side, side curtain or Safety  
Canopy) or the safety belt pretensioners.  
The SOS Post-Crash Alert can be turned off when any one of the  
following actions are taken by the driver or any other person:  
pressing the hazard control button,  
or pressing the panic button on the remote entry transmitter.  
The feature will continue to operate until the vehicle runs out of power.  
Disposal of airbags and airbag equipped vehicles  
(including pretensioners)  
Contact your authorized dealer as soon as possible. Airbags MUST BE  
disposed of by qualified personnel.  
213  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
SAFETY RESTRAINTS FOR CHILDREN  
See the following sections for directions on how to properly use safety  
restraints for children. Also see Airbag supplemental restraint system  
(SRS) in this chapter for special instructions about using airbags.  
Important child restraint precautions  
WARNING: Always make sure your child is secured properly in  
a device that is appropriate for their height, age and weight.  
Child safety restraints must be purchased separately from the vehicle.  
Failure to follow these instructions and guidelines may result in an  
increased risk of serious injury or death to your child.  
WARNING: All children are shaped differently. The  
Recommendations for Safety Restraints are based on probable  
child height, age and weight thresholds from NHTSA and other safety  
organizations or are the minimum requirements of law. Ford  
recommends checking with a NHTSA Certified Child Passenger Safety  
Technician (CPST) and your pediatrician to make sure your child seat  
is appropriate for your child, and is compatible with and properly  
installed in the vehicle. To locate a child seat fitting station and CPST  
contact the NHTSA toll free at 1-888-327-4236 or on the internet at  
http://www.nhtsa.dot.gov. Failure to properly restrain children in safety  
seats made especially for their height, age, and weight may result in an  
increased risk of serious injury or death to your child.  
214  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Recommendations for Safety Restraints for Children  
Recommended  
Child size, height, weight, or age  
restraint type  
Infants or Children weighing 40 lb (18 kg) or less Use a child safety  
toddlers  
(generally age four or younger)  
seat (sometimes  
called an infant  
carrier,  
convertible seat,  
or toddler seat).  
Small  
children  
Children who have outgrown or no  
longer properly fit in a child safety  
seat (generally children who are less  
than 4 feet 9 inches (1.45 meters) tall,  
are greater than age four (4) and less  
than age twelve (12), and between  
40 lbs (18 kg) and 80 lbs (36 kg) and  
upward to 100 lbs (45 kg) if  
Use a  
belt-positioning  
booster seat.  
recommended by your child restraint  
manufacturer)  
Larger  
children  
Children who have outgrown or no  
Use a vehicle  
longer properly fit in a belt-positioning safety belt having  
booster seat (generally children who  
are at least 4 feet 9 inches  
(1.45 meters) tall or greater than 80 lb the hips, shoulder  
(36 kg) or 100 lb (45 kg) if  
recommended by child restraint  
manufacturer)  
the lap belt snug  
and low across  
belt centered  
across the  
shoulder and  
chest, and  
seatback upright.  
You are required by law to properly use safety seats for infants and  
toddlers in the U.S. and Canada.  
Many states and provinces require that small children use approved  
booster seats until they reach age eight, a height of 4 ft 9 in  
(1.45 meters) tall, or 80 lb (36 kg). Check your local and state or  
provincial laws for specific requirements regarding the safety of  
children in your vehicle.  
When possible, always properly restrain children twelve (12) years of  
age and under in a rear seating position of your vehicle. Accident  
statistics suggest that children are safer when properly restrained in  
the rear seating positions than in a front seating position.  
215  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Recommendations for attaching child safety restraints for children  
Use any attachment method as indicated  
below by “X”  
LATCH  
(lower  
anchors anchors  
LATCH  
(lower  
Safety  
belt and belt only  
top  
Safety  
Restraint  
Type  
Child  
Weight  
and top  
tether  
only)  
tether  
anchor  
anchor)  
Rear facing Up to  
child seat  
48 lb  
X
X
(21 kg)  
Forward  
Up to  
facing child 48 lb  
X
X
X
seat  
(21 kg)  
Forward  
Over 48 lb  
facing child (21 kg)  
seat  
WARNING: Air bags can kill or injure a child in a child seat.  
NEVER place a rear-facing child seat in front of an active air  
bag. If you must use a forward-facing child seat in the front seat, move  
the vehicle seat all the way back. When possible, all children age 12  
and under should be properly restrained in a rear seating position. If  
all children cannot be seated and restrained properly in a rear seating  
position, properly restrain the largest child in the front seat.  
WARNING: Always carefully follow the instructions and  
warnings provided by the manufacturer of any child restraint to  
determine if the restraint device is appropriate for your child’s size,  
height, weight, or age. Follow the child restraint manufacturer’s  
instructions and warnings provided for installation and use in  
conjunction with the instructions and warnings provided by the vehicle  
manufacturer. A safety seat that is improperly installed or utilized, is  
inappropriate for your child’s height, age, or weight or does not  
properly fit the child may increase the risk of serious injury or death.  
216  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
WARNING: Never let a passenger hold a child on his or her lap  
while the vehicle is moving. The passenger cannot protect the  
child from injury in a collision, which may result in serious injury or  
death.  
WARNING: Never use pillows, books, or towels to boost a child.  
They can slide around and increase the likelihood of injury or  
death in a collision.  
WARNING: Always restrain an unoccupied child seat or booster  
seat. These objects may become projectiles in a collision or  
sudden stop, which may increase the risk of serious injury.  
WARNING: Never place, or allow a child to place, the shoulder  
belt under a child’s arm or behind the back because it reduces  
the protection for the upper part of the body and may increase the risk  
of injury or death in a collision.  
WARNING: Do not leave children, unreliable adults, or pets  
unattended in your vehicle.  
Transporting children  
Always make sure your child is secured properly in a device that is  
appropriate for their age, height and weight. All children are shaped  
differently. The child height, age and weight thresholds provided are  
recommendations or the minimum requirements of law. The National  
Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA) provides education and  
training to ensure that all children ages 0 to 16 are properly restrained in  
the correct restraint system. Ford recommends checking with a NHTSA  
Certified Child Passenger Safety Technician (CPST) and your  
pediatrician to make sure your seat is appropriate for your child and  
properly installed in the vehicle. To locate a child seat fitting station and  
CPST contact the NHTSA toll free at 1-888-327-4236 or on the internet  
at http://www.nhtsa.dot.gov.  
Follow all the safety restraint and airbag precautions that apply to adult  
passengers in your vehicle.  
217  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
If the child is the proper height, age, and weight (as specified by your  
child safety seat or booster manufacturer), fits the restraint and can be  
restrained properly, then restrain the child in the child safety seat or  
with the belt-positioning booster. Remember that child seats and  
belt-positioning boosters vary and may be designed to fit children of  
different heights, ages and weights. Children who are too large for child  
safety seats or belt-positioning boosters (as specified by your child safety  
seat manufacturer) should always properly wear safety belts.  
SAFETY SEATS FOR CHILDREN  
Infant and/or toddler seats  
Use a safety seat that is recommended for the size and weight of the  
child.  
When installing a child safety seat:  
Review and follow the information  
presented in the Airbag  
supplemental restraint system  
(SRS) section in this chapter.  
Carefully follow all of the  
manufacturer’s instructions  
included with the safety seat you  
put in your vehicle. If you do not  
install and use the safety seat  
properly, the child may be injured  
in a sudden stop or collision.  
Airbags can kill or injure a child in a child seat. NEVER place a  
rear-facing child seat in front of an active airbag. If you must use a  
forward-facing child seat in the front seat, move the vehicle seat all the  
way back.  
Children 12 and under should be properly restrained in a rear seating  
position whenever possible. If all children cannot be seated and  
restrained properly in a rear seating position, properly restrain the  
largest child in the front seat.  
218  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Installing child safety seats with combination lap and shoulder  
belts  
If needed, when installing some high back child restraints, the head  
restraints of the second row seating positions can be removed. Insert a  
thin pointed object, such as a paper clip or pushpin, into the hole of  
each head restraint guide and while lifting up remove the head restraint.  
Store the head restraint in a secure location in the vehicle, such as on  
the floor against the rear of the front seats. To re-install the head  
restraint, line the posts up in the holes on the seat back with the head  
restraint strap facing the outside of the vehicle and push down until the  
head restraint locks into place. Lift gently to ensure it is locked into  
place.  
WARNING: If the head restraint has been removed from a  
seating position to accommodate a high back child restraint, the  
head restraint must be re-installed prior to use of the seat by any other  
occupant in order to reduce the risk of personal injury in the event of  
a collision.  
Check to make sure the child seat is properly secured before each use.  
Children 12 and under should be properly restrained in a rear seating  
position whenever possible. If all children cannot be seated and  
restrained properly in a rear seating position, properly restrain the  
largest child in the front seat.  
When installing a child safety seat with combination lap/shoulder belts:  
Use the correct safety belt buckle for that seating position.  
Insert the belt tongue into the proper buckle until you hear a snap  
and feel it latch. Make sure the tongue is securely fastened in the  
buckle.  
219  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Keep the buckle release button pointing up and away from the safety  
seat, with the tongue between the child seat and the release button,  
to help prevent accidental unbuckling.  
Place vehicle seat back in upright position.  
Put the safety belt in the automatic locking mode. Refer to step 5  
below. This vehicle does not require the use of a locking clip.  
WARNING: Depending on where you secure a child restraint,  
and depending on the child restraint design, you may block  
access to certain safety belt buckle assemblies and/or LATCH lower  
anchors, rendering those features potentially unusable. To avoid risk of  
injury, occupants should only use seating positions where they are able  
to be properly restrained.  
Perform the following steps when installing the child seat with  
combination lap/shoulder belts:  
Note: Although the child seat illustrated is a forward facing child seat,  
the steps are the same for installing a rear facing child seat.  
1. Position the child safety seat in a  
seat with a combination lap and  
shoulder belt.  
2. Pull down on the shoulder belt  
and then grasp the shoulder belt  
and lap belt together.  
220  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
3. While holding the shoulder and  
lap belt portions together, route the  
tongue through the child seat  
according to the child seat  
manufacturer’s instructions. Be sure  
the belt webbing is not twisted.  
4. Insert the belt tongue into the  
proper buckle (the buckle closest to  
the direction the tongue is coming  
from) for that seating position until  
you hear a snap and feel the latch  
engage. Make sure the tongue is  
latched securely by pulling on it.  
5. To put the retractor in the  
automatic locking mode, grasp the  
shoulder portion of the belt and pull  
downward until all of the belt is  
pulled out.  
6. Allow the belt to retract to remove slack. The belt will click as it  
retracts to indicate it is in the automatic locking mode.  
7. Try to pull the belt out of the retractor to make sure the retractor is  
in the automatic locking mode (you should not be able to pull more belt  
out). If the retractor is not locked, repeat Steps 5 and 6.  
221  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
8. Remove remaining slack from the  
belt. Force the seat down with extra  
weight, e.g., by pressing down or  
kneeling on the child restraint while  
pulling up on the shoulder belt in  
order to force slack from the belt.  
This is necessary to remove the  
remaining slack that will exist once  
the additional weight of the child is  
added to the child restraint. It also  
helps to achieve the proper  
snugness of the child seat to the vehicle. Sometimes, a slight lean  
towards the buckle will additionally help to remove remaining slack from  
the belt.  
9. Attach the tether strap (if the child seat is equipped). Refer to  
Attaching child safety seats with tether straps later in this chapter.  
10. Before placing the child in the  
seat, forcibly move the seat forward  
and back to make sure the seat is  
securely held in place. To check  
this, grab the seat at the belt path  
and attempt to move it side to side  
and forward and back. There should  
be no more than 1 inch (2.5 cm) of  
movement for proper installation.  
11. Ford recommends checking with a NHTSA Certified Child Passenger  
Safety Technician (CPST) to make certain the child restraint is properly  
installed.  
Attaching child safety seats with LATCH  
(Lower Anchors and Tethers for CHildren) attachments  
The LATCH system is composed of three vehicle anchor points: two (2)  
lower anchors located where the vehicle seat back and seat cushion meet  
(called the “seat bight”) and one (1) top tether anchor located behind  
that seating position.  
LATCH compatible child safety seats have two rigid or webbing mounted  
attachments that connect to the two lower anchors at the LATCH  
equipped seating positions in your vehicle. This type of attachment  
method eliminates the need to use safety belts to attach the child seat,  
222  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
however the safety belt can still be used to attach the child seat. For  
forward-facing child seats, the top tether strap must also be attached to  
the proper top tether anchor, if a top tether strap has been provided  
with your child seat.See Attaching child safety seats with tether straps  
and Recommendations for attaching safety restraints for children in  
this chapter for more information.  
Your vehicle has LATCH lower anchors for child seat installation at the  
following seating positions. In addition, six passenger and seven  
passenger LATCH lower anchor positions are marked with the child seat  
symbol.  
Second row bench seats (applicable to five and seven-passenger  
vehicles)  
Second row bucket seats (applicable to six-passenger vehicles)  
WARNING: Never attach two LATCH child safety seats to the  
same anchor. In a crash, one anchor may not be strong enough  
to hold two child safety seat attachments and may break, causing  
serious injury or death.  
223  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
The LATCH anchors for child seat  
installation are located at the rear  
section of the second row seat  
between the cushion and seatback.  
The LATCH anchors are below the  
locator symbols on the seat back on  
6 and 7 passenger vehicles. The 5  
passenger vehicle does not require  
the symbol, however, the anchor  
itself is located in the same area.  
Follow the child seat manufacturer’s  
instructions to properly install a  
child seat with LATCH attachments.  
Follow the instructions on attaching child safety seats with tether straps.  
Refer to Attaching child safety seats with tether straps later in this  
chapter.  
Attach LATCH lower attachments of the child seat only to the anchors  
shown.  
Plastic LATCH guides can be obtained from an authorized dealer. They  
snap onto the LATCH lower anchors in the seat to help attach a child  
seat with rigid attachments. The guides hold the seat trim away to  
expose the anchor and make it easier to attach some child seats.  
WARNING: Never attach two child safety seats to the same  
anchor. In a crash, one anchor may not be strong enough to hold  
two child safety seat attachments and may break, causing serious  
injury or death.  
224  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
WARNING: Depending on where you secure a child restraint,  
and depending on the child restraint design, you may block  
access to certain safety belt buckle assemblies and/or LATCH lower  
anchors, rendering those features potentially unusable. To avoid risk of  
injury, occupants should only use seating positions where they are able  
to be properly restrained.  
Use of inboard lower anchors from the outboard seating positions  
(center seating use)  
The lower anchors at the center of the second row rear seat are spaced  
592 mm (23 inches) apart. The standardized spacing for LATCH lower  
anchors is 280 mm (11 inches) center to center. A child seat with rigid  
LATCH attachments cannot be installed at the center seating position.  
LATCH compatible child seats (with attachments on belt webbing) can  
only be used at this seating position provided that the child seat  
manufacturer’s instructions permit use with the anchor spacing stated.  
Do not attach a child seat to any lower anchor if an adjacent child seat is  
attached to that anchor.  
WARNING: The standardized spacing for LATCH lower anchors  
is 280 mm (11 inches) center to center. Do not use LATCH  
lower anchors for the center seating position unless the child seat  
manufacturer’s instructions permit and specify using anchors spaced at  
least as far apart as those in this vehicle.  
If you install a child seat with rigid LATCH attachments, and have  
attached the top tether strap to the proper top tether anchor, do not  
tighten the tether strap enough to lift the child seat off the vehicle seat  
cushion when the child is seated in it. Keep the tether strap just snug  
without lifting the front of the child seat. Keeping the child seat just  
touching the vehicle seat gives the best protection in a severe crash.  
Each time you use the safety seat, check that the seat is properly  
attached to the lower anchors and tether anchor, if applicable. Tug the  
child seat from side to side and forward and back where it is secured to  
the vehicle. The seat should move less than one inch when you do this  
for a proper installation.  
If the safety seat is not anchored properly, the risk of a child being  
injured in a crash greatly increases.  
225  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Attaching child safety seats with tether straps  
Many forward-facing child safety seats include a tether strap which  
extends from the back of the child safety seat and hooks to an anchoring  
point called the top tether anchor. Tether straps are available as an  
accessory for many older safety seats. Contact the manufacturer of your  
child seat for information about ordering a tether strap, or to obtain a  
longer tether strap if the tether strap on your safety seat does not reach  
the appropriate top tether anchor in the vehicle.  
The rear seats of your vehicle are equipped with built-in tether strap  
anchors located behind the seats as described below.  
The tether strap anchors in your vehicle are in the following positions  
(shown from top view):  
5 passenger vehicle  
For the center seat, use either of  
the two tether anchors/cargo  
tie-downs in the scuff plate along  
the back edge of the floor.  
6 passenger vehicle  
7 passenger vehicle  
Attach the tether strap only to the appropriate tether anchor as shown.  
The tether strap may not work properly if attached somewhere other  
than the correct tether anchor.  
Once the child safety seat has been installed using either the safety belt  
or the lower anchors of the LATCH system, you can attach the top tether  
strap.  
226  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Perform the following steps to install a child safety seat with tether  
anchors:  
1. Route the tether strap under the head restraint and between the head  
restraint posts.  
For vehicles with adjustable head restraints, route the tether strap under  
the head restraint and between the head restraint posts, otherwise route  
the tether strap over the top of the seatback.  
2. Locate the correct anchor for the selected rear seating position.  
When placing a child safety seat in the 2nd row center seating position  
of the 5 passenger vehicle, the tether straps may be attached to either of  
the tether anchors located at the rear of the cargo area.  
Behind 2nd row seat  
At the rear of the cargo area  
227  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
3. Clip the tether strap to the  
anchor as shown.  
If the tether strap is clipped  
incorrectly, the child safety seat may  
not be retained properly in the  
event of a collision.  
4. Tighten the child safety seat tether strap according to the  
manufacturer’s instructions.  
If the safety seat is not anchored properly, the risk of a child being  
injured in a collision greatly increases.  
If your child restraint system is equipped with a tether strap, and the  
child restraint manufacturer recommends its use, Ford also recommends  
its use.  
Child booster seats  
The belt-positioning booster (booster seat) is used to improve the fit of  
the vehicle safety belt. Children outgrow a typical child seat (e.g.,  
convertible or toddler seat) when they weigh about 40 lb (18 kg) and are  
around four (4) years of age. Consult your child safety seat owner guide  
for the weight, height, and age limits specific to your child safety seat.  
Keep your child in the child safety seat if it properly fits the child,  
remains appropriate for their weight, height and age AND if properly  
secured to the vehicle.  
Although the lap/shoulder belt will provide some protection, children  
who have outgrown a typical child seat are still too small for lap/shoulder  
belts to fit properly, and wearing an improperly fitted vehicle safety belt  
could increase the risk of serious injury in a crash. To improve the fit of  
both the lap and shoulder belt on children who have outgrown child  
safety seats, Ford Motor Company recommends use of a belt-positioning  
booster.  
228  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Booster seats position a child so that vehicle lap/shoulder safety belts fit  
better. They lift the child up so that the lap belt rests low across the hips  
and the knees bend comfortably at the edge of the cushion, while  
minimizing slouching. Booster seats may also make the shoulder belt fit  
better and more comfortably. Try to keep the belt near the middle of the  
shoulder and across the center of the chest. Moving the child closer (a  
few centimeters or inches) to the center of the vehicle, but remaining in  
the same seating position, may help provide a good shoulder belt fit.  
When children should use booster seats  
Children need to use booster seats from the time they outgrow the  
toddler seat until they are big enough for the vehicle seat and  
lap/shoulder belt to fit properly. Generally this is when they reach a  
height of at least 4 feet 9 inches (1.45 meters) tall (around age eight to  
age twelve and between 40 lb (18 kg) and 80 lb (36 kg) or upward to  
100 lb (45 kg) if recommended by your child restraint manufacturer).  
Many state and provincial laws require that children use approved  
booster seats until they reach age eight, a height of 4 feet 9 inches  
(1.45 meters) tall, or 80 lb (36 kg).  
Booster seats should be used until you can answer YES to ALL of these  
questions when seated without a booster seat:  
Can the child sit all the way back  
against the vehicle seat back with  
knees bent comfortably at the  
edge of the seat cushion?  
Can the child sit without  
slouching?  
Does the lap belt rest low across the hips?  
Is the shoulder belt centered on the shoulder and chest?  
Can the child stay seated like this for the whole trip?  
229  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Types of booster seats  
There are generally two types of belt-positioning booster seats: backless  
and high back. Always use booster seats in conjunction with the vehicle  
lap/shoulder belt.  
Backless booster seats  
If your backless booster seat has a  
removable shield, remove the  
shield. If a vehicle seating position  
has a low seat back or no head  
restraint, a backless booster seat  
may place your child’s head (as  
measured at the tops of the ears)  
above the top of the seat. In this  
case, move the backless booster  
to another seating position with a  
higher seat back or head restraint and lap/shoulder belts, or consider  
using a high back booster seat.  
High back booster seats  
If, with a backless booster seat,  
you cannot find a seating position  
that adequately supports your  
child’s head, a high back booster  
seat would be a better choice.  
230  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Children and booster seats vary in size and shape. Choose a booster that  
keeps the lap belt low and snug across the hips, never up across the  
stomach, and lets you adjust the shoulder belt to cross the chest and  
rest snugly near the center of the shoulder. The drawings below compare  
the ideal fit (center) to a shoulder belt uncomfortably close to the neck  
and a shoulder belt that could slip off the shoulder. The drawings below  
also show how the lap belt should be low and snug across the child’s  
hips.  
If the booster seat slides on the vehicle seat, placing a rubberized mesh  
sold as shelf or carpet liner under the booster seat may improve this  
condition. Do not introduce any item thicker than this under the booster  
seat. Check with the booster seat manufacturer’s instructions.  
The importance of shoulder belts  
Using a booster without a shoulder belt increases the risk of a child’s  
head hitting a hard surface in a collision. For this reason, you should  
never use a booster seat with a lap belt only. It is generally best to use a  
booster seat with lap/shoulder belts in the back seat.  
Move a child to a different seating location if the shoulder belt does not  
stay positioned on the shoulder during use.  
231  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Seating and Safety Restraints  
Follow all instructions provided by the manufacturer of the booster seat.  
WARNING: Never place, or allow a child to place, the shoulder  
belt under a child’s arm or behind the back because it reduces  
the protection for the upper part of the body and may increase the risk  
of injury or death in a collision.  
Child restraint and safety belt maintenance  
Inspect the vehicle safety belts and child safety seat systems periodically  
to make sure they work properly and are not damaged. Inspect the  
vehicle and child seat safety belts to make sure there are no nicks, tears  
or cuts. Replace if necessary. All vehicle safety belt assemblies, including  
retractors, buckles, front safety belt buckle assemblies, buckle support  
assemblies (slide bar-if equipped), shoulder belt height adjusters (if  
equipped), shoulder belt guide on seatback (if equipped), child safety  
seat LATCH and tether anchors, and attaching hardware, should be  
inspected after a collision. Refer to the child restraint manufacturer’s  
instructions for additional inspection and maintenance information  
specific to the child restraint. Ford Motor Company recommends that all  
safety belt assemblies in use in vehicles involved in a collision be  
replaced. However, if the collision was minor and an authorized dealer  
finds that the belts do not show damage and continue to operate  
properly, they do not need to be replaced. Safety belt assemblies not in  
use during a collision should also be inspected and replaced if either  
damage or improper operation is noted.  
For proper care of soiled safety belts, refer to Interior in the Cleaning  
chapter.  
WARNING: Failure to inspect and if necessary replace the  
safety belt assembly or child restraint system under the above  
conditions could result in severe personal injuries in the event of a  
collision.  
232  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
NOTICE TO UTILITY VEHICLE AND TRUCK OWNERS  
Utility vehicles and trucks handle  
differently than passenger cars in  
the various driving conditions that  
are encountered on streets,  
highways and off-road. Utility  
vehicles and trucks are not designed  
for cornering at speeds as high as  
passenger cars any more than  
low-slung sports cars are designed  
to perform satisfactorily under  
off-road conditions.  
WARNING: Utility vehicles have a significantly higher rollover  
rate than other types of vehicles. To reduce the risk of serious  
injury or death from a rollover or other crash you must:  
Avoid sharp turns and abrupt maneuvers;  
Drive at safe speeds for the conditions;  
Keep tires properly inflated;  
Never overload or improperly load your vehicle; and  
Make sure every passenger is properly restrained.  
WARNING: In a rollover crash, an unbelted person is  
significantly more likely to die than a person wearing a seat belt.  
All occupants must wear seat belts and children/infants must use  
appropriate restraints to minimize the risk of injury or ejection.  
Study your owner’s guide and any supplements for specific information  
about equipment features, instructions for safe driving and additional  
precautions to reduce the risk of an accident or serious injury.  
VEHICLE CHARACTERISTICS  
4WD and AWD Systems (if equipped)  
A vehicle equipped with AWD or 4WD (when selected) has the ability to  
use all four wheels to power itself. This increases traction which may  
enable you to safely drive over terrain and road conditions that a  
conventional two-wheel drive vehicle cannot.  
233  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Power is supplied to all four wheels through a transfer case or power  
transfer unit. 4WD vehicles allow you to select different drive modes as  
necessary. Information on transfer case operation and shifting procedures  
can be found in the Driving chapter. Information on transfer case  
maintenance can be found in the Maintenance and Specifications  
chapter. You should become thoroughly familiar with this information  
before you operate your vehicle.  
On some 4WD models, the initial shift from two-wheel drive to 4WD  
while the vehicle is moving can cause a momentary clunk and ratcheting  
sound. These sounds are normal as the front drivetrain comes up to  
speed and is not cause for concern.  
WARNING: Do not become overconfident in the ability of 4WD  
and AWD vehicles. Although a 4WD or AWD vehicle may  
accelerate better than two-wheel drive vehicle in low traction  
situations, it won’t stop any faster than two-wheel drive vehicles.  
Always drive at a safe speed.  
How your vehicle differs from other vehicles  
SUV and trucks can differ from  
some other vehicles in a few  
noticeable ways. Your vehicle may  
be:  
Higher – to allow higher load  
carrying capacity and to allow it  
to travel over rough terrain  
without getting hung up or  
damaging underbody components.  
Shorter – to give it the capability  
to approach inclines and drive  
over the crest of a hill without  
getting hung up or damaging  
underbody components. All other  
things held equal, a shorter  
wheelbase may make your vehicle  
quicker to respond to steering inputs than a vehicle with a longer  
wheelbase.  
234  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Narrower — to provide greater  
maneuverability in tight spaces,  
particularly in off-road use.  
As a result of the above dimensional  
differences, SUV’s and trucks often  
will have a higher center of gravity  
and a greater difference in center of  
gravity between the loaded and  
unloaded condition.  
These differences that make your  
vehicle so versatile also make it  
handle differently than an ordinary  
passenger car.  
INFORMATION ABOUT UNIFORM TIRE QUALITY GRADING  
Tire Quality Grades apply to new  
pneumatic passenger car tires. The  
Quality grades can be found where  
applicable on the tire sidewall  
between tread shoulder and  
maximum section width. For  
example:  
Treadwear 200 Traction AA Temperature A  
These Tire Quality Grades are determined by standards that the United  
States Department of Transportation has set.  
Tire Quality Grades apply to new pneumatic passenger car tires. They do  
not apply to deep tread, winter-type snow tires, space-saver or  
temporary use spare tires, light truck or “LT” type tires, tires with  
nominal rim diameters of 10 to 12 inches or limited production tires as  
defined in Title 49 Code of Federal Regulations Part 575.104(c)(2).  
U.S. Department of Transportation-Tire quality grades: The U.S.  
Department of Transportation requires Ford Motor Company to give you  
the following information about tire grades exactly as the government  
has written it.  
235  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Treadwear  
The treadwear grade is a comparative rating based on the wear rate of  
the tire when tested under controlled conditions on a specified  
government test course. For example, a tire graded 150 would wear one  
and one-half (112) times as well on the government course as a tire  
graded 100. The relative performance of tires depends upon the actual  
conditions of their use, however, and may depart significantly from the  
norm due to variations in driving habits, service practices, and  
differences in road characteristics and climate.  
Traction AA A B C  
The traction grades, from highest to lowest are AA, A, B, and C. The  
grades represent the tire’s ability to stop on wet pavement as measured  
under controlled conditions on specified government test surfaces of  
asphalt and concrete. A tire marked C may have poor traction  
performance.  
WARNING: The traction grade assigned to this tire is based on  
straight-ahead braking traction tests, and does not include  
acceleration, cornering, hydroplaning or peak traction characteristics.  
Temperature A B C  
The temperature grades are A (the highest), B and C, representing the  
tire’s resistance to the generation of heat and its ability to dissipate heat  
when tested under controlled conditions on a specified indoor laboratory  
test wheel. Sustained high temperature can cause the material of the tire  
to degenerate and reduce tire life, and excessive temperature can lead to  
sudden tire failure. The grade C corresponds to a level of performance  
which all passenger car tires must meet under the Federal Motor Vehicle  
Safety Standard No. 139. Grades B and A represent higher levels of  
performance on the laboratory test wheel than the minimum required by  
law.  
WARNING: The temperature grade for this tire is established  
for a tire that is properly inflated and not overloaded. Excessive  
speed, underinflation, or excessive loading, either separately or in  
combination, can cause heat buildup and possible tire failure.  
236  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
TIRES  
Tires are designed to give many thousands of miles of service, but they  
must be maintained in order to get the maximum benefit from them.  
Glossary of tire terminology  
Tire label: A label showing the OE (Original Equipment) tire sizes,  
recommended inflation pressure and the maximum weight the vehicle  
can carry.  
Tire Identification Number (TIN): A number on the sidewall of  
each tire providing information about the tire brand and  
manufacturing plant, tire size and date of manufacture. Also referred  
to as DOT code.  
Inflation pressure: A measure of the amount of air in a tire.  
Standard load: A class of P-metric or Metric tires designed to carry a  
maximum load at 35 psi [37 psi (2.5 bar) for Metric tires]. Increasing  
the inflation pressure beyond this pressure will not increase the tire’s  
load carrying capability.  
Extra load: A class of P-metric or Metric tires designed to carry a  
heavier maximum load at 41 psi [43 psi (2.9 bar) for Metric tires].  
Increasing the inflation pressure beyond this pressure will not increase  
the tire’s load carrying capability.  
kPa: Kilopascal, a metric unit of air pressure.  
PSI: Pounds per square inch, a standard unit of air pressure.  
Cold inflation pressure: The tire pressure when the vehicle has  
been stationary and out of direct sunlight for an hour or more and  
prior to the vehicle being driven for 1 mile (1.6 km).  
Recommended inflation pressure: The cold inflation pressure found  
on the Safety Compliance Certification Label or Tire Label located on  
the B-Pillar or the edge of the driver’s door.  
B-pillar: The structural member at the side of the vehicle behind the  
front door.  
Bead area of the tire: Area of the tire next to the rim.  
Sidewall of the tire: Area between the bead area and the tread.  
Tread area of the tire: Area of the perimeter of the tire that  
contacts the road when mounted on the vehicle.  
Rim: The metal support (wheel) for a tire or a tire and tube assembly  
upon which the tire beads are seated.  
237  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
INFLATING YOUR TIRES  
Safe operation of your vehicle requires that your tires are properly  
inflated. Remember that a tire can lose up to half of its air pressure  
without appearing flat.  
Every day before you drive, check your tires. If one looks lower than the  
others, use a tire gauge to check pressure of all tires and adjust if  
required.  
At least once a month and before long trips, inspect each tire and check  
the tire pressure with a tire gauge (including spare, if equipped). Inflate  
all tires to the inflation pressure recommended by Ford Motor Company.  
You are strongly urged to buy a reliable tire pressure gauge, as automatic  
service station gauges may be inaccurate. Ford recommends the use of a  
digital or dial-type tire pressure gauge rather than a stick-type tire  
pressure gauge.  
Use the recommended cold inflation pressure for optimum tire  
performance and wear. Under-inflation or over-inflation may cause  
uneven treadwear patterns.  
WARNING: Under-inflation is the most common cause of tire  
failures and may result in severe tire cracking, tread separation  
or ЉblowoutЉ, with unexpected loss of vehicle control and increased risk  
of injury. Under-inflation increases sidewall flexing and rolling  
resistance, resulting in heat buildup and internal damage to the tire. It  
also may result in unnecessary tire stress, irregular wear, loss of  
vehicle control and accidents. A tire can lose up to half of its air  
pressure and not appear to be flat!  
Always inflate your tires to the Ford recommended inflation pressure  
even if it is less than the maximum inflation pressure information found  
on the tire. The Ford recommended tire inflation pressure is found on  
the Safety Compliance Certification Label or Tire Label which is located  
on the B-Pillar or the edge of the driver’s door. Failure to follow the tire  
pressure recommendations can cause uneven treadwear patterns and  
adversely affect the way your vehicle handles.  
Maximum Permissible Inflation Pressure is the tire manufacturer’s  
maximum permissible pressure and/or the pressure at which the  
maximum load can be carried by the tire. This pressure is normally  
higher than the manufacturer’s recommended cold inflation pressure  
which can be found on the Safety Compliance Certification Label or Tire  
Label which is located on the B-Pillar or the edge of the driver’s door.  
238  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
The cold inflation pressure should never be set lower than the  
recommended pressure on the Safety Compliance Certification Label or  
Tire Label.  
When weather temperature changes occur, tire inflation pressures also  
change. A 10°F (6°C) temperature drop can cause a corresponding drop  
of 1 psi (7 kPa) in inflation pressure. Check your tire pressures  
frequently and adjust them to the proper pressure which can be found  
on the Safety Compliance Certification Label or Tire Label.  
To check the pressure in your tire(s):  
1. Make sure the tires are cool, meaning they are not hot from driving  
even a mile.  
If you are checking tire pressure when the tire is hot, (i.e. driven more  
than 1 mile [1.6 km]), never “bleed” or reduce air pressure. The tires are  
hot from driving and it is normal for pressures to increase above  
recommended cold pressures. A hot tire at or below recommended cold  
inflation pressure could be significantly under-inflated.  
Note: If you have to drive a distance to get air for your tire(s), check  
and record the tire pressure first and add the appropriate air pressure  
when you get to the pump. It is normal for tires to heat up and the air  
pressure inside to go up as you drive.  
2. Remove the cap from the valve on one tire, then firmly press the tire  
gauge onto the valve and measure the pressure.  
3. Add enough air to reach the recommended air pressure.  
Note: If you overfill the tire, release air by pushing on the metal stem in  
the center of the valve. Then recheck the pressure with your tire gauge.  
4. Replace the valve cap.  
5. Repeat this procedure for each tire, including the spare.  
Note: Some spare tires operate at a higher inflation pressure than the  
other tires. For T-type/mini-spare tires (see the Dissimilar spare  
tire/wheel information section for description): Store and maintain at  
60 psi (4.15 bar). For Full Size and Dissimilar spare tires (see the  
Dissimilar spare tire/wheel information section for description): Store  
and maintain at the higher of the front and rear inflation pressure as  
shown on the Tire Label.  
6. Visually inspect the tires to make sure there are no nails or other  
objects embedded that could poke a hole in the tire and cause an air  
leak.  
7. Check the sidewalls to make sure there are no gouges, cuts or bulges.  
239  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
TIRE CARE  
Inspecting your tires and wheel valve stems  
Periodically inspect the tire treads for uneven or excessive wear and  
remove objects such as stones, nails or glass that may be wedged in the  
tread grooves. Check the tire and valve stems for holes, cracks, or cuts  
that may permit air leakage and repair or replace the tire and replace  
the valve stem. Inspect the tire sidewalls for cracking, cuts, bruises and  
other signs of damage or excessive wear. If internal damage to the tire is  
suspected, have the tire demounted and inspected in case it needs to be  
repaired or replaced. For your safety, tires that are damaged or show  
signs of excessive wear should not be used because they are more likely  
to blow out or fail.  
Improper or inadequate vehicle maintenance can cause tires to wear  
abnormally. Inspect all your tires, including the spare, frequently, and  
replace them if one or more of the following conditions exist:  
Tire wear  
When the tread is worn down to  
1/16th of an inch (2 mm), tires must  
be replaced to help prevent your  
vehicle from skidding and  
hydroplaning. Built-in treadwear  
indicators, or “wear bars”, which  
look like narrow strips of smooth  
rubber across the tread will appear  
on the tire when the tread is worn  
down to 1/16th of an inch (2 mm).  
When the tire tread wears down to  
the same height as these “wear bars”, the tire is worn out and must be  
replaced.  
Damage  
Periodically inspect the tire treads and sidewalls for damage (such as  
bulges in the tread or sidewalls, cracks in the tread groove and  
separation in the tread or sidewall). If damage is observed or suspected  
have the tire inspected by a tire professional. Tires can be damaged  
during off-road use, so inspection after off-road use is also  
recommended.  
240  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
WARNING: Age  
Tires degrade over time depending on many factors such as  
weather, storage conditions, and conditions of use (load, speed,  
inflation pressure, etc.) the tires experience throughout their lives.  
In general, tires should be replaced after six years regardless of tread  
wear. However, heat caused by hot climates or frequent high loading  
conditions can accelerate the aging process and may require tires to be  
replaced more frequently.  
You should replace your spare tire when you replace the road tires or  
after six years due to aging even if it has not been used.  
U.S. DOT Tire Identification Number (TIN)  
Both U.S. and Canada Federal regulations require tire manufacturers to  
place standardized information on the sidewall of all tires. This  
information identifies and describes the fundamental characteristics of  
the tire and also provides a U.S. DOT Tire Identification Number for  
safety standard certification and in case of a recall.  
This begins with the letters “DOT” and indicates that the tire meets all  
federal standards. The next two numbers or letters are the plant code  
designating where it was manufactured, the next two are the tire size  
code and the last four numbers represent the week and year the tire was  
built. For example, the numbers 317 mean the 31st week of 1997. After  
2000 the numbers go to four digits. For example, 2501 means the 25th  
week of 2001. The numbers in between are identification codes used for  
traceability. This information is used to contact customers if a tire defect  
requires a recall.  
Tire replacement requirements  
Your vehicle is equipped with tires designed to provide a safe ride and  
handling capability.  
241  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
WARNING: Only use replacement tires and wheels that are the  
same size, load index, speed rating and type (such as P-metric  
versus LT-metric or all-season versus all-terrain) as those originally  
provided by Ford. The recommended tire and wheel size may be found  
on either the Safety Compliance Certification Label or the Tire Label  
which is located on the B-Pillar or edge of the driver’s door. If this  
information is not found on these labels then you should contact your  
authorized dealer as soon as possible. Use of any tire or wheel not  
recommended by Ford can affect the safety and performance of your  
vehicle, which could result in an increased risk of loss of vehicle  
control, vehicle rollover, personal injury and death. Additionally the use  
of non-recommended tires and wheels could cause steering,  
suspension, axle or transfer case/power transfer unit failure. If you  
have questions regarding tire replacement, contact your authorized  
dealer as soon as possible.  
WARNING: When mounting replacement tires and wheels, you  
should not exceed the maximum pressure indicated on the  
sidewall of the tire to set the beads without additional precautions  
listed below. If the beads do not seat at the maximum pressure  
indicated, re-lubricate and try again.  
When inflating the tire for mounting pressures up to 20 psi (1.38 bar)  
greater than the maximum pressure on the tire sidewall, the following  
precautions must be taken to protect the person mounting the tire:  
1. Make sure that you have the correct tire and wheel size.  
2. Lubricate the tire bead and wheel bead seat area again.  
3. Stand at a minimum of 12 ft. (3.66 m) away from the tire wheel  
assembly.  
4. Use both eye and ear protection.  
For a mounting pressure more than 20 psi (1.38 bar) greater than the  
maximum pressure, a Ford Dealer or other tire service professional  
should do the mounting.  
Always inflate steel carcass tires with a remote air fill with the person  
inflating standing at a minimum of 12 ft. (3.66 m) away from the tire  
wheel assembly.  
Important: Remember to replace the wheel valve stems when the road  
tires are replaced on your vehicle.  
242  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
It is recommended that the two front tires or two rear tires generally be  
replaced as a pair.  
The tire pressure sensors mounted in the wheels (originally installed on  
your vehicle) are not designed to be used in aftermarket wheels.  
The use of wheels or tires not recommended by Ford Motor Company  
may affect the operation of your Tire Pressure Monitoring System.  
If the TPMS indicator is flashing, your TPMS is malfunctioning. Your  
replacement tire might be incompatible with your TPMS, or some  
component of the TPMS may be damaged.  
Safety practices  
Driving habits have a great deal to do with your tire mileage and safety.  
Observe posted speed limits  
Avoid fast starts, stops and turns  
Avoid potholes and objects on the road  
Do not run over curbs or hit the tire against a curb when parking  
WARNING: If your vehicle is stuck in snow, mud, sand, etc., do  
not rapidly spin the tires; spinning the tires can tear the tire and  
cause an explosion. A tire can explode in as little as three to five  
seconds.  
WARNING: Do not spin the wheels at over 35 mph (56 km/h).  
The tires may fail and injure a passenger or bystander.  
Highway hazards  
No matter how carefully you drive there’s always the possibility that you  
may eventually have a flat tire on the highway. Drive slowly to the  
closest safe area out of traffic. This may further damage the flat tire, but  
your safety is more important.  
If you feel a sudden vibration or ride disturbance while driving, or you  
suspect your tire or vehicle has been damaged, immediately reduce your  
speed. Drive with caution until you can safely pull off the road. Stop and  
inspect the tires for damage. If a tire is under-inflated or damaged,  
deflate it, remove wheel and replace it with your spare tire and wheel. If  
you cannot detect a cause, have the vehicle towed to the nearest repair  
facility or tire dealer to have the vehicle inspected.  
243  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Tire and wheel alignment  
A bad jolt from hitting a curb or pothole can cause the front end of your  
vehicle to become misaligned or cause damage to your tires. If your  
vehicle seems to pull to one side when you’re driving, the wheels may be  
out of alignment. Have an authorized dealer check the wheel alignment  
periodically.  
Wheel misalignment in the front or the rear can cause uneven and rapid  
treadwear of your tires and should be corrected by an authorized dealer.  
Front wheel drive (FWD) vehicles and those with an independent rear  
suspension (if equipped) may require alignment of all four wheels.  
The tires should also be balanced periodically. An unbalanced tire and  
wheel assembly may result in irregular tire wear.  
Tire rotation  
Rotating your tires at the recommended interval (as indicated in the  
scheduled maintenance information that comes with your vehicle) will  
help your tires wear more evenly, providing better tire performance and  
longer tire life.  
Rear Wheel Drive (RWD)  
vehicles/Four Wheel Drive  
(4WD)/All Wheel Drive (AWD)  
vehicles (front tires at top of  
diagram)  
Sometimes irregular tire wear can be corrected by rotating the tires.  
244  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Note: If your tires show uneven wear ask an authorized dealer to check  
for and correct any wheel misalignment, tire imbalance or mechanical  
problem involved before tire rotation.  
Note: Your vehicle may be equipped with a dissimilar spare tire/wheel. A  
dissimilar spare tire/wheel is defined as a spare tire and/or wheel that is  
different in brand, size or appearance from the road tires and wheels. If  
you have a dissimilar spare tire/wheel it is intended for temporary use  
only and should not be used in a tire rotation.  
Note: After having your tires rotated, inflation pressure must be checked  
and adjusted to the vehicle requirements.  
INFORMATION CONTAINED ON THE TIRE SIDEWALL  
Both U.S. and Canada Federal regulations require tire manufacturers to  
place standardized information on the sidewall of all tires. This  
information identifies and describes the fundamental characteristics of  
the tire and also provides a U.S. DOT Tire Identification Number for  
safety standard certification and in case of a recall.  
Information on “P” type tires  
P215/65R15 95H is an example of a  
tire size, load index and speed  
rating. The definitions of these  
items are listed below. (Note that  
the tire size, load index and speed  
rating for your vehicle may be  
different from this example.)  
1. P: Indicates a tire, designated by  
the Tire and Rim Association  
(T&RA), that may be used for  
service on cars, SUVs, minivans and  
light trucks.  
Note: If your tire size does not  
begin with a letter this may mean it  
is designated by either ETRTO  
(European Tire and Rim Technical Organization) or JATMA (Japan Tire  
Manufacturing Association).  
2. 215: Indicates the nominal width of the tire in millimeters from  
sidewall edge to sidewall edge. In general, the larger the number, the  
wider the tire.  
3. 65: Indicates the aspect ratio which gives the tire’s ratio of height to  
width.  
245  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
4. R: Indicates a “radial” type tire.  
5. 15: Indicates the wheel or rim diameter in inches. If you change your  
wheel size, you will have to purchase new tires to match the new wheel  
diameter.  
6. 95: Indicates the tire’s load index. It is an index that relates to how  
much weight a tire can carry. You may find this information in your  
Owner’s Guide. If not, contact a local tire dealer.  
Note: You may not find this information on all tires because it is not  
required by federal law.  
7. H: Indicates the tire’s speed rating. The speed rating denotes the  
speed at which a tire is designed to be driven for extended periods of  
time under a standard condition of load and inflation pressure. The tires  
on your vehicle may operate at different conditions for load and inflation  
pressure. These speed ratings may need to be adjusted for the difference  
in conditions. The ratings range from 81 mph (130 km/h) to 186 mph  
(299 km/h). These ratings are listed in the following chart.  
Note: You may not find this information on all tires because it is not  
required by federal law.  
Letter rating  
Speed rating - mph (km/h)  
81 mph (130 km/h)  
87 mph (140 km/h)  
99 mph (159 km/h)  
106 mph (171 km/h)  
112 mph (180 km/h)  
118 mph (190 km/h)  
124 mph (200 km/h)  
130 mph (210 km/h)  
149 mph (240 km/h)  
168 mph (270 km/h)  
186 mph (299 km/h)  
M
N
Q
R
S
T
U
H
V
W
Y
Note: For tires with a maximum speed capability over 149 mph  
(240 km/h), tire manufacturers sometimes use the letters ZR. For  
those with a maximum speed capability over 186 mph (299 km/h), tire  
manufacturers always use the letters ZR.  
246  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
8. U.S. DOT Tire Identification Number (TIN): This begins with the  
letters “DOT” and indicates that the tire meets all federal standards. The  
next two numbers or letters are the plant code designating where it was  
manufactured, the next two are the tire size code and the last four  
numbers represent the week and year the tire was built. For example,  
the numbers 317 mean the 31st week of 1997. After 2000 the numbers  
go to four digits. For example, 2501 means the 25th week of 2001. The  
numbers in between are identification codes used for traceability. This  
information is used to contact customers if a tire defect requires a recall.  
9. M+S or M/S: Mud and Snow, or  
AT: All Terrain, or  
AS: All Season.  
10. Tire Ply Composition and Material Used: Indicates the number of  
plies or the number of layers of rubber-coated fabric in the tire tread and  
sidewall. Tire manufacturers also must indicate the ply materials in the  
tire and the sidewall, which include steel, nylon, polyester, and others.  
11. Maximum Load: Indicates the maximum load in kilograms and  
pounds that can be carried by the tire. Refer to the Safety Compliance  
Certification Label, which is located on the B-Pillar or the edge of the  
driver’s door, for the correct tire pressure for your vehicle.  
12. Treadwear, Traction and Temperature Grades  
Treadwear: The treadwear grade is a comparative rating based on the  
wear rate of the tire when tested under controlled conditions on a  
specified government test course. For example, a tire graded 150  
would wear one and one-half (112) times as well on the government  
course as a tire graded 100.  
Traction: The traction grades, from highest to lowest are AA, A, B,  
and C. The grades represent the tire’s ability to stop on wet pavement  
as measured under controlled conditions on specified government test  
surfaces of asphalt and concrete. A tire marked C may have poor  
traction performance.  
Temperature: The temperature grades are A (the highest), B and C,  
representing the tire’s resistance to the generation of heat and its  
ability to dissipate heat when tested under controlled conditions on a  
specified indoor laboratory test wheel.  
247  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
13. Maximum Permissible Inflation Pressure: Indicates the tire  
manufacturers’ maximum permissible pressure and/or the pressure at  
which the maximum load can be carried by the tire. This pressure is  
normally higher than the manufacturer’s recommended cold inflation  
pressure which can be found on the Safety Compliance Certification  
Label or Tire Label which is located on the B-Pillar or the edge of the  
driver’s door. The cold inflation pressure should never be set lower than  
the recommended pressure on the vehicle label.  
The tire suppliers may have additional markings, notes or warnings such  
as standard load, radial tubeless, etc.  
Additional information contained on the tire sidewall for “LT” type  
tires  
“LT” type tires have some additional  
information beyond those of “P”  
type tires; these differences are  
described below.  
Note: Tire Quality Grades do not  
apply to this type of tire.  
1. LT: Indicates a tire, designated by  
the Tire and Rim Association  
(T&RA), that is intended for service  
on light trucks.  
2. Load Range/Load Inflation  
Limits: Indicates the tire’s  
load-carrying capabilities and its  
inflation limits.  
3. Maximum Load Dual lb. (kg) at psi (kPa) cold: Indicates the  
maximum load and tire pressure when the tire is used as a dual; defined  
as four tires on the rear axle (a total of six or more tires on the vehicle).  
4. Maximum Load Single lb. (kg) at psi (kPa) cold: Indicates the  
maximum load and tire pressure when the tire is used as a single;  
defined as two tires (total) on the rear axle.  
248  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Information on “T” type tires  
“T” type tires have some additional  
information beyond those of “P”  
type tires; these differences are  
described below:  
T145/80D16 is an example of a tire  
size.  
Note: The temporary tire size for  
your vehicle may be different from  
this example. Tire Quality Grades do  
not apply to this type of tire.  
1. T: Indicates a type of tire,  
designated by the Tire and Rim  
Association (T&RA), that is  
intended for temporary service on  
cars, SUVs, minivans and light  
trucks.  
2. 145: Indicates the nominal width  
of the tire in millimeters from sidewall edge to sidewall edge. In general,  
the larger the number, the wider the tire.  
3. 80: Indicates the aspect ratio which gives the tire’s ratio of height to  
width. Numbers of 70 or lower indicate a short sidewall.  
4. D: Indicates a “diagonal” type tire.  
R: Indicates a “radial” type tire.  
5. 16: Indicates the wheel or rim diameter in inches. If you change your  
wheel size, you will have to purchase new tires to match the new wheel  
diameter.  
Location of the tire label  
You will find a Tire Label containing tire inflation pressure by tire size  
and other important information located on the B-Pillar or the edge of  
the driver’s door. Refer to the payload description and graphic in the  
Vehicle loading — with and without a trailer section.  
249  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
TIRE PRESSURE MONITORING SYSTEM (TPMS)  
Each tire, including the spare (if  
provided), should be checked  
monthly when cold and inflated to  
the inflation pressure recommended  
by the vehicle manufacturer on the  
vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label. (If your vehicle has tires  
of a different size than the size indicated on the vehicle placard or tire  
inflation pressure label, you should determine the proper tire inflation  
pressure for those tires.)  
As an added safety feature, your vehicle has been equipped with a tire  
pressure monitoring system (TPMS) that illuminates a low tire pressure  
telltale when one or more of your tires is significantly under-inflated.  
Accordingly, when the low tire pressure telltale illuminates, you should  
stop and check your tires as soon as possible, and inflate them to the  
proper pressure. Driving on a significantly under-inflated tire causes the  
tire to overheat and can lead to tire failure. Under-inflation also reduces  
fuel efficiency and tire tread life, and may affect the vehicle’s handling  
and stopping ability.  
Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute for proper tire  
maintenance, and it is the driver’s responsibility to maintain correct tire  
pressure, even if under-inflation has not reached the level to trigger  
illumination of the TPMS low tire pressure telltale.  
Your vehicle has also been equipped with a TPMS malfunction indicator  
to indicate when the system is not operating properly. The TPMS  
malfunction indicator is combined with the low tire pressure telltale.  
When the system detects a malfunction, the telltale will flash for  
approximately one minute and then remain continuously illuminated.  
This sequence will continue upon subsequent vehicle start-ups as long as  
the malfunction exists.  
When the malfunction indicator is illuminated, the system may not be  
able to detect or signal low tire pressure as intended. TPMS malfunctions  
may occur for a variety of reasons, including the installation of  
replacement or alternate tires or wheels on the vehicle that prevent the  
TPMS from functioning properly. Always check the TPMS malfunction  
telltale after replacing one or more tires or wheels on your vehicle to  
ensure that the replacement or alternate tires and wheels allow the  
TPMS to continue to function properly.  
250  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
The Tire Pressure Monitoring System complies with part 15 of the FCC  
rules and with RSS-210 of Industry Canada. Operation is subject to the  
following two conditions: (1) This device may not cause harmful  
interference, and (2) This device must accept any interference received,  
including interference that may cause undesired operation.  
WARNING: The Tire Pressure Monitoring System is NOT a  
substitute for manually checking tire pressure. The tire pressure  
should be checked periodically (at least monthly) using a tire gauge,  
see Inflating your tires in this chapter. Failure to properly maintain  
your tire pressure could increase the risk of tire failure, loss of control,  
vehicle rollover and personal injury.  
Changing tires with TPMS  
Each road tire is equipped with  
a tire pressure sensor fastened  
to the inside rim of the wheel.  
The pressure sensor is covered  
by the tire and is not visible  
unless the tire is removed. The  
pressure sensor is located  
opposite (180 degrees) from the  
valve stem. Care must be taken  
when changing the tire to avoid  
damaging the sensor. It is  
recommended that you always have  
your tires serviced by an authorized  
dealer.  
The tire pressure should be checked  
periodically (at least monthly) using  
an accurate tire gauge, refer to  
Inflating your tires in this chapter.  
251  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Understanding your Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)  
The Tire Pressure Monitoring System measures pressure in your four  
road tires and sends the tire pressure readings to your vehicle. The Low  
Tire Pressure Warning Lamp will turn ON if the tire pressure is  
significantly low. Once the light is illuminated, your tires are under  
inflated and need to be inflated to the manufacturer’s recommended tire  
pressure. Even if the light turns ON and a short time later turns OFF,  
your tire pressure still needs to be checked. Visit www.checkmytires.org  
for additional information.  
When your temporary spare tire is installed  
When one of your road tires needs to be replaced with the temporary  
spare, the TPMS system will continue to identify an issue to remind you  
that the damaged road wheel/tire needs to be repaired and put back on  
your vehicle.  
To restore the full functionality of the Tire Pressure Monitoring System,  
have the damaged road wheel/tire repaired and remounted on your  
vehicle. For additional information, refer to Changing tires with TPMS  
in this section.  
252  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
When you believe your system is not operating properly  
The main function of the Tire Pressure Monitoring System is to warn you  
when your tires need air. It can also warn you in the event the system is  
no longer capable of functioning as intended. Please refer to the  
following chart for information concerning your Tire Pressure Monitoring  
System:  
Low Tire Pressure Possible cause Customer Action Required  
Warning Light  
Solid Warning Light Tire(s)  
under-inflated  
1. Check your tire pressure to  
ensure tires are properly  
inflated; refer to Inflating  
your tires in this chapter.  
2. After inflating your tires to  
the manufacturer’s  
recommended inflation  
pressure as shown on the Tire  
Label (located on the edge of  
driver’s door or the B-Pillar),  
the vehicle must be driven for  
at least two minutes over  
20 mph (32 km/h) before the  
light will turn OFF.  
Spare tire in use Your temporary spare tire is in  
use. Repair the damaged road  
wheel/tire and reinstall it on  
the vehicle to restore system  
functionality. For a description  
on how the system functions,  
refer to When your temporary  
spare tire is installed in this  
section.  
TPMS  
malfunction  
If your tires are properly  
inflated and your spare tire is  
not in use and the light  
remains ON, contact your  
authorized dealer as soon as  
possible.  
253  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Low Tire Pressure Possible cause Customer Action Required  
Warning Light  
Flashing Warning  
Light  
Spare tire in use Your temporary spare tire is in  
use. Repair the damaged road  
wheel and re-mount it on the  
vehicle to restore system  
functionality. For a description  
of how the system functions  
under these conditions, refer to  
When your temporary spare  
tire is installed in this section.  
TPMS  
malfunction  
If your tires are properly  
inflated and your spare tire is  
not in use and the TPMS  
warning light still flashes,  
contact your authorized dealer  
as soon as possible.  
When inflating your tires  
When putting air into your tires (such as at a gas station or in your  
garage), the Tire Pressure Monitoring System may not respond  
immediately to the air added to your tires.  
It may take up to two minutes of driving over 20 mph (32 km/h) for the  
light to turn OFF after you have filled your tires to the recommended  
inflation pressure.  
How temperature affects your tire pressure  
The Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) monitors tire pressure in  
each pneumatic tire. While driving in a normal manner, a typical  
passenger tire inflation pressure may increase approximately 2 to 4 psi  
(14 to 28 kPa) from a cold start situation. If the vehicle is stationary  
over night with the outside temperature significantly lower than the  
daytime temperature, the tire pressure may decrease approximately 3 psi  
(21 kPa) for a drop of 30°F (17°C) in ambient temperature. This lower  
pressure value may be detected by the TPMS as being significantly lower  
than the recommended inflation pressure and activate the TPMS warning  
for low tire pressure. If the low tire pressure warning light is ON, visually  
check each tire to verify that no tire is flat. (If one or more tires are flat,  
repair as necessary.) Check air pressure in the road tires. If any tire is  
under-inflated, carefully drive the vehicle to the nearest location where  
air can be added to the tires. Inflate all the tires to the recommended  
inflation pressure.  
254  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
SNOW TIRES AND CABLES  
WARNING: Snow tires must be the same size, load index, speed  
rating as those originally provided by Ford. The use of  
non-recommended tires and wheels could cause steering, suspension,  
axle or transfer case/power transfer unit failure. Using any tire or  
wheel not recommended by Ford may increase the risk of loss of  
vehicle control or vehicle rollover, which could result in personal injury  
or death.  
The tires on your vehicle have all-weather treads to provide traction in  
rain and snow. However, in some climates, using snow tires or traction  
devices may be necessary. Ford offers tire cables as a Ford approved  
accessory and recommends use of these or SAE class “S” tire cables. See  
your authorized dealer for more information on tire cables for your  
vehicle.  
Follow these guidelines when using snow tires and traction devices:  
Use only SAE Class S cables.  
Cables should only be used on the rear wheels.  
Do not use tire cables or optional traction devices on 17, 18 or 20 inch  
wheels and tires.  
Install cables securely, verifying that the cables do not touch any  
wiring, brake lines or fuel lines.  
Drive cautiously. If you hear the cables rub or bang against the  
vehicle, stop and retighten them. If this does not work, remove the  
cables to prevent vehicle damage.  
Avoid overloading your vehicle.  
Remove the cables when they are no longer needed.  
Do not use cables on dry roads.  
Do not exceed 30 mph (48 km/h) with tire cables on your vehicle.  
Consult your authorized dealer for information on other Ford Motor  
Company approved methods of traction control.  
VEHICLE LOADING – WITH AND WITHOUT A TRAILER  
This section will guide you in the proper loading of your vehicle and/or  
trailer, to keep your loaded vehicle weight within its design rating  
capability, with or without a trailer. Properly loading your vehicle will  
provide maximum return of vehicle design performance. Before loading  
255  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
your vehicle, familiarize yourself with the following terms for determining  
your vehicle’s weight ratings, with or without a trailer, from the vehicle’s  
Tire Label or Safety Compliance Certification Label:  
Base Curb Weight – is the weight of the vehicle including a full tank of  
fuel and all standard equipment. It does not include passengers, cargo, or  
optional equipment.  
Vehicle Curb Weight – is the weight of your new vehicle when you  
picked it up from your authorized dealer plus any aftermarket  
equipment.  
Payload – is the combined weight of cargo and passengers that the  
vehicle is carrying. The maximum payload for your vehicle can be found  
on the Tire Label on the B-Pillar or the edge of the driver’s door  
(vehicles exported outside the US and Canada may not have a Tire  
Label). Look for “THE COMBINED WEIGHT OF OCCUPANTS AND  
CARGO SHOULD NEVER EXCEED XXX kg OR XXX lb.” for  
maximum payload. The payload listed on the Tire Label is the maximum  
payload for the vehicle as built by the assembly plant. If any aftermarket  
or authorized-dealer installed equipment has been installed on the  
vehicle, the weight of the equipment must be subtracted from the  
payload listed on the Tire Label in order to determine the new payload.  
WARNING: The appropriate loading capacity of your vehicle can  
be limited either by volume capacity (how much space is  
available) or by payload capacity (how much weight the vehicle should  
carry). Once you have reached the maximum payload of your vehicle,  
do not add more cargo, even if there is space available. Overloading or  
improperly loading your vehicle can contribute to loss of vehicle  
control and vehicle rollover.  
256  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Example only:  
Cargo Weight – includes all weight added to the Base Curb Weight,  
including cargo and optional equipment. When towing, trailer tongue load  
or king pin weight is also part of cargo weight.  
257  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
GAW (Gross Axle Weight) – is the total weight placed on each axle  
(front and rear) – including vehicle curb weight and all payload.  
GAWR (Gross Axle Weight Rating) – is the maximum allowable  
weight that can be carried by a single axle (front or rear). These  
numbers are shown on the Safety Compliance Certification Label  
located on the B-Pillar or the edge of the driver’s door. The total  
load on each axle must never exceed its GAWR.  
Note: For trailer towing information refer to Trailer towing found in  
this chapter or the RV and Trailer Towing Guide provided by your  
authorized dealer.  
GVW (Gross Vehicle Weight) – is the Vehicle Curb Weight + cargo +  
passengers.  
GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight Rating) – is the maximum allowable  
weight of the fully loaded vehicle (including all options, equipment,  
passengers and cargo). The GVWR is shown on the Safety  
Compliance Certification Label located on the B-Pillar or the  
edge of the driver’s door. The GVW must never exceed the GVWR.  
258  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Example only:  
WARNING: Exceeding the Safety Compliance Certification Label  
vehicle weight rating limits could result in substandard vehicle  
handling or performance, engine, transmission and/or structural  
damage, serious damage to the vehicle, loss of control and personal  
injury.  
259  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
GCW (Gross Combined Weight) – is the weight of the loaded vehicle  
(GVW) plus the weight of the fully loaded trailer.  
GCWR (Gross Combined Weight Rating) – is the maximum allowable  
weight of the vehicle and the loaded trailer – including all cargo and  
passengers – that the vehicle can handle without risking damage.  
(Important: The towing vehicle’s braking system is rated for operation at  
GVWR, not at GCWR.) Separate functional brakes should be used for  
safe control of towed vehicles and for trailers where the GCW of the  
towing vehicle plus the trailer exceed the GVWR of the towing vehicle.  
The GCW must never exceed the GCWR.  
Maximum Loaded Trailer Weight – is the highest possible weight of a  
fully loaded trailer the vehicle can tow. It assumes a vehicle with only  
mandatory options, no cargo (internal or external), a tongue load of  
10–15% (conventional trailer) or king pin weight of 15–25% (fifth wheel  
trailer), and driver only (150 lb. [68 kg]). Consult your authorized  
dealer (or the RV and Trailer Towing Guide provided by your  
authorized dealer) for more detailed information.  
Tongue Load or Fifth Wheel King Pin Weight – refers to the amount  
of the weight that a trailer pushes down on a trailer hitch.  
Examples: For a 5,000 lb. (2,268 kg) conventional trailer, multiply 5,000  
by 0.10 and 0.15 to obtain a proper tongue load range of 500 to 750 lb.  
(227 to 340 kg). For an 11,500 lb. (5,216 kg) fifth wheel trailer, multiply  
by 0.15 and 0.25 to obtain a proper king pin load range of 1,725 to  
2,875 lb. (782 to 1,304 kg)  
WARNING: Do not exceed the GVWR or the GAWR specified on  
the Safety Compliance Certification Label.  
WARNING: Do not use replacement tires with lower load  
carrying capacities than the original tires because they may  
lower the vehicle’s GVWR and GAWR limitations. Replacement tires  
with a higher limit than the original tires do not increase the GVWR  
and GAWR limitations.  
260  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
WARNING: Exceeding any vehicle weight rating limitation could  
result in serious damage to the vehicle and/or personal injury.  
Steps for determining the correct load limit:  
1. Locate the statement “The combined weight of occupants and cargo  
should never exceed XXX kg or XXX lb.” on your vehicle’s placard.  
2. Determine the combined weight of the driver and passengers that will  
be riding in your vehicle.  
3. Subtract the combined weight of the driver and passengers from XXX  
kg or XXX lb.  
4. The resulting figure equals the available amount of cargo and luggage  
load capacity. For example, if the “XXX” amount equals 1,400 lb. and  
there will be five 150 lb. passengers in your vehicle, the amount of  
available cargo and luggage load capacity is 650 lb. (1400-750 (5 x 150)  
= 650 lb.). In metric units (635-340 (5 x 68) = 295 kg.)  
5. Determine the combined weight of luggage and cargo being loaded on  
the vehicle. That weight may not safely exceed the available cargo and  
luggage load capacity calculated in Step 4.  
6. If your vehicle will be towing a trailer, load from your trailer will be  
transferred to your vehicle. Consult this manual to determine how this  
reduces the available cargo and luggage load capacity of your vehicle.  
The following gives you a few examples on how to calculate the available  
amount of cargo and luggage load capacity:  
Another example for your vehicle with 1,400 lb. (635 kg) of cargo and  
luggage capacity. You decide to go golfing. Is there enough load  
capacity to carry you, 4 of your friends and all the golf bags? You and  
four friends average 220 lb. (99 kg) each and the golf bags weigh  
approximately 30 lb. (13.5 kg) each. The calculation would be: 1400 -  
(5 x 220) - (5 x 30) = 1400 - 1100 - 150 = 150 lb. Yes, you have  
enough load capacity in your vehicle to transport four friends and  
your golf bags. In metric units, the calculation would be: 635 kg - (5 x  
99 kg) - (5 x 13.5 kg) = 635 - 495 - 67.5 = 72.5 kg.  
A final example for your vehicle with 1,400 lb. (635 kg) of cargo and  
luggage capacity. You and one of your friends decide to pick up  
cement from the local home improvement store to finish that patio  
you have been planning for the past 2 years. Measuring the inside of  
the vehicle with the rear seat folded down, you have room for  
12-100 lb. (45 kg) bags of cement. Do you have enough load capacity  
261  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
to transport the cement to your home? If you and your friend each  
weigh 220 lb. (99 kg), the calculation would be: 1400 - (2 x 220) - (12  
x 100) = 1400 - 440 - 1200 = - 240 lb. No, you do not have enough  
cargo capacity to carry that much weight. In metric units, the  
calculation would be: 635 kg - (2 x 99 kg) - (12 x 45 kg) = 635 - 198 -  
540 = -103 kg. You will need to reduce the load weight by at least  
240 lb. (104 kg). If you remove 3-100 lb. (45 kg) cement bags, then  
the load calculation would be:  
1400 - (2 x 220) - (9 x 100) = 1400 - 440 - 900 = 60 lb. Now you have  
the load capacity to transport the cement and your friend home. In  
metric units, the calculation would be: 635 kg - (2 x 99 kg) - (9 x  
45 kg) = 635 - 198 - 405 = 32 kg.  
The above calculations also assume that the loads are positioned in your  
vehicle in a manner that does not overload the Front or the Rear Gross  
Axle Weight Rating specified for your vehicle on the Safety Compliance  
Certification Label found on the edge of the driver’s door.  
Special loading instructions for owners of pickup trucks and  
utility-type vehicles  
WARNING: For important information regarding safe operation  
of this type of vehicle, see the Preparing to drive your vehicle  
section in the Driving chapter of this owner’s guide.  
WARNING: Loaded vehicles may handle differently than  
unloaded vehicles. Extra precautions, such as slower speeds and  
increased stopping distance, should be taken when driving a heavily  
loaded vehicle.  
Your vehicle can haul more cargo and people than most passenger cars.  
Depending upon the type and placement of the load, hauling cargo and  
people may raise the center of gravity of the vehicle.  
Calculating the load your vehicle can carry/tow  
1. Use the appropriate maximum GCWR chart (in the Trailer towing  
section in this chapter) for your type of engine and rear axle ratio.  
2. Weigh your vehicle without cargo. To obtain correct weights, take your  
vehicle to a shipping company or an inspection station for trucks.  
3. Subtract your loaded weight from the maximum GCWR in the chart.  
This is the maximum trailer weight your vehicle can tow. It must be  
below the maximum trailer weight shown in the chart.  
262  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
TRAILER TOWING  
Trailer towing with your vehicle may require the use of a trailer tow  
option package.  
Trailer towing puts additional loads on your vehicle’s engine,  
transmission, axle, brakes, tires, and suspension. For your safety and to  
maximize vehicle performance, be sure to use the proper equipment  
while towing.  
Follow these guidelines to ensure safe towing procedure:  
Do not tow a trailer until your vehicle has been driven at least  
1,000 miles (1600 km).  
Stay within your vehicle’s load limits.  
Thoroughly prepare your vehicle for towing. Refer to Preparing to  
tow in this chapter.  
Use extra caution when driving while trailer towing. Refer to Driving  
while you tow in this chapter.  
Service your vehicle more frequently if you tow a trailer. Refer to the  
severe duty schedule in the scheduled maintenance information.  
Refer to the instructions included with towing accessories for the  
proper installation and adjustment specifications.  
Do not exceed the maximum loads listed on the Safety Compliance  
Certification label. For load specification terms found on the label, refer  
to Vehicle loading in this chapter when figuring the total weight of your  
vehicle.  
Your vehicle is equipped with a standard Class II integrated hitch and  
requires only a draw bar and ball with a 19 mm (3/4 inch) shank  
diameter. An optional Class III/Class IV hitch is also available.  
Note: Do not exceed the GVWR or the GAWR specified on the  
certification label.  
WARNING: Towing trailers beyond the maximum recommended  
gross trailer weight exceeds the limit of the vehicle and could  
result in engine damage, transmission damage, structural damage, loss  
of vehicle control, vehicle rollover and personal injury.  
263  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
4x2  
GCWR (Gross Combined Weight Rating)/Trailer Weight  
Engine  
Rear axle ratio  
Maximum  
Trailer weight  
GCWR-lb. (kg) range-lb. (kg)  
(0-Maximum)  
4.0L SOHC Class  
II towing  
4.6L* Class II  
towing  
4.0L SOHC Class  
III/IV towing  
4.6L* Class III/IV  
towing  
3.55  
3.55  
3.73  
3.55  
8500 (3856)  
0–3500 (0–1588)  
8500 (3856)  
0–3500 (0–1588)  
10000 (4536) 0–5375 (0–2438)  
12000 (5443) 0–7285 (0–3304)  
Notes: - For high altitude operation, reduce GCW by 2% per 1,000 ft.  
(300 meters) elevation. For definitions of terms used in this table and  
instructions on how to calculate your vehicle load, refer to Vehicle  
loading in this chapter. Maximum trailer weights shown. The combined  
weight of the completed towing vehicle and the loaded trailer must not  
exceed the GCWR.  
* -When towing maximum loads under high outside temperatures and  
on steep grades, the A/C system may cycle on and off to protect the  
engine from overheating. This may result in a temporary increase of  
interior temperatures.  
4X4 and AWD  
GCWR (Gross Combined Weight Rating)/Trailer Weight  
Engine  
Rear axle ratio  
Maximum  
Trailer weight  
GCWR-lb. (kg) range-lb. (kg)  
(0-Maximum)  
4.0L SOHC Class  
II towing  
4.6L* Class II  
towing  
4.0L SOHC Class  
III/IV towing  
3.55  
3.55  
3.73  
8500 (3856)  
0–3500 (0–1588)  
8500 (3856)  
0–3500 (0–1588)  
10000 (4536) 0–5205 (0–2361)  
264  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
4X4 and AWD  
GCWR (Gross Combined Weight Rating)/Trailer Weight  
Engine  
Rear axle ratio  
Maximum  
Trailer weight  
GCWR-lb. (kg) range-lb. (kg)  
(0-Maximum)  
4.6L* Class III/IV  
towing  
3.55  
12000 (5443) 0–7115 (0–3227)  
Notes: - For high altitude operation, reduce GCW by 2% per 1,000 ft.  
(300 meters) elevation. For definitions of terms used in this table and  
instructions on how to calculate your vehicle load, refer to Vehicle  
loading in this chapter. Maximum trailer weights shown. The combined  
weight of the completed towing vehicle and the loaded trailer must not  
exceed the GCWR  
* -When towing maximum loads under high outside temperatures  
and/or on steep grades, the A/C system may cycle on and off to protect  
the engine from overheating. This may result in a temporary increase  
of interior temperatures.  
Preparing to tow  
Use the proper equipment for towing a trailer and make sure it is  
properly attached to your vehicle. Contact your authorized dealer or a  
reliable trailer dealer as soon as possible if you require assistance.  
Hitches  
Do not use hitches that clamp onto the vehicle bumper. Use a load  
carrying hitch. You must distribute the load in your trailer so that  
10–15% of the total weight of the trailer is on the tongue, not to exceed  
the maximum tongue loads as stated:  
Class II receiver: 350 lb. (159 kg)  
Class III/IV receiver: 500 lb. (227 kg) (weight carrying); 740 lb.  
(336 kg) (weight distributing)  
Safety chains  
Always connect the trailer’s safety chains to the frame or hook retainers  
of the vehicle hitch. To connect the trailer’s safety chains, cross the  
chains under the trailer tongue and allow slack for turning corners.  
If you use a rental trailer, follow the instructions that the rental agency  
gives to you.  
265  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Class III Trailer Hitch Safety Chain  
Loops can be used as recovery  
hooks.  
Do not attach safety chains to the bumper.  
Trailer brakes  
Electric brakes and manual, automatic or surge-type trailer brakes are  
safe if installed properly and adjusted to the manufacturer’s  
specifications. The trailer brakes must meet local and Federal  
regulations.  
WARNING: Do not connect a trailer’s hydraulic brake system  
directly to your vehicle’s brake system. Your vehicle may not  
have enough braking power and your chances of having a collision  
greatly increase.  
The braking system of the tow vehicle is rated for operation at the  
GVWR not GCWR.  
Trailer lamps  
Trailer lamps are required on most towed vehicles. Make sure all running  
lights, brake lights, turn signals and hazard lights are working. Contact  
your authorized dealer or trailer rental agency for proper instructions  
and equipment for hooking up trailer lamps.  
WARNING: Never connect any trailer lighting to the vehicle’s  
taillamp circuits, because it may damage the electrical system  
resulting in fire. Contact your authorized dealer as soon as possible for  
assistance in proper trailer tow wiring installation. Additional electrical  
equipment may be required.  
266  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Driving while you tow  
When towing a trailer:  
To ensure proper “break-in” of powertrain components, do not trailer  
tow during the first 1,000 miles (1,600 km) of a new vehicle.  
To ensure proper “break-in” of powertrain components during the first  
500 miles (800 km) of trailer towing, drive no faster than 70 mph  
(113 km/h) with no full throttle starts.  
Turn off the speed control. The speed control may shut off  
automatically when you are towing on long, steep grades.  
Consult your local motor vehicle speed regulations for towing a trailer.  
To eliminate excessive shifting, use a lower gear. This will also assist  
in transmission cooling. For additional information, refer to Automatic  
transmission operation in the Driving chapter.  
Under extreme conditions with large frontal trailers, high outside  
temperatures and highway speeds, the coolant gauge may indicate  
higher than normal coolant temperatures. If this occurs, reduce speed  
until the coolant temperature returns to the normal range. Refer to  
Engine coolant temperature gauge in the Instrument Cluster  
chapter.  
Anticipate stops and brake gradually.  
Do not exceed the GCWR rating or transmission damage may occur.  
Servicing after towing  
If you tow a trailer for long distances, your vehicle will require more  
frequent service intervals. Refer to your scheduled maintenance  
information for more information.  
Trailer towing tips  
Practice turning, stopping and backing up before starting on a trip to  
get the feel of the vehicle trailer combination. When turning, make  
wider turns so the trailer wheels will clear curbs and other obstacles.  
Allow more distance for stopping with a trailer attached.  
If you are driving down a long or steep hill, shift to a lower gear. Do  
not apply the brakes continuously, as they may overheat and become  
less effective.  
The trailer tongue weight should be 10–15% of the loaded trailer  
weight.  
267  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
If you will be towing a trailer frequently in hot weather, hilly  
conditions, at GCWR, or any combination of these factors, consider  
refilling your rear axle with synthetic gear lube if not already so  
equipped. Refer to the Maintenance and Specifications chapter for  
the lubricant specification. Remember that regardless of the rear axle  
lube used, do not tow a trailer for the first 1,000 miles (1,600 km) of a  
new vehicle, and that the first 500 miles (800 km) of towing be done  
at no faster than 70 mph (113 km/h) with no full throttle starts.  
After you have traveled 50 miles (80 km), thoroughly check your  
hitch, electrical connections and trailer wheel lug nuts.  
To aid in engine/transmission cooling and A/C efficiency during hot  
weather while stopped in traffic, place the gearshift lever in P (Park).  
Vehicles with trailers should not be parked on a grade. If you must  
park on a grade, place wheel chocks under the trailer’s wheels.  
Launching or retrieving a boat  
Disconnect the wiring to the trailer before backing the trailer  
into the water. Reconnect the wiring to the trailer after the  
trailer is removed from the water.  
When backing down a ramp during boat launching or retrieval:  
do not allow the static water level to rise above the bottom edge of  
the rear bumper.  
do not allow waves to break higher than 6 inches (15 cm) above the  
bottom edge of the rear bumper.  
Exceeding these limits may allow water to enter vehicle components:  
causing internal damage to the components.  
affecting driveability, emissions and reliability.  
Replace the rear axle lubricant any time the axle has been submerged in  
water. Rear axle lubricant quantities are not to be checked or changed  
unless a leak is suspected or repair required.  
RECREATIONAL TOWING  
Follow these guidelines if you have a need for recreational (RV) towing.  
An example of recreational towing would be towing your vehicle behind  
a motorhome. These guidelines are designed to ensure that your  
transmission is not damaged.  
268  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Tires, Wheels and Loading  
Note: Put your climate control system in recirculated air mode to  
prevent exhaust fumes from entering the vehicle. Refer to the Climate  
controls chapter for more information.  
2WD vehicles: Do not tow your vehicle with any wheels on the ground,  
as vehicle or transmission damage may occur. It is recommended to tow  
your vehicle with all four (4) wheels off the ground such as when using a  
car-hauling trailer. Otherwise, no recreational towing is permitted.  
In case of a roadside emergency with a disabled vehicle, see Wrecker  
towing in the Roadside Emergencies chapter.  
4WD vehicles with electronic shift transfer case (Neutral tow kit  
accessory):  
An accessory is available that allows you to tow your vehicle, behind  
another vehicle, with all the wheels on the ground. Contact your  
authorized dealer for more details. Do not tow your vehicle with all  
wheels on the ground unless you install the neutral tow kit as vehicle  
damage may occur.  
In case of a roadside emergency with a disabled vehicle, see Wrecker  
towing in the Roadside Emergencies chapter.  
AWD vehicles: Do not tow your vehicle with any wheels on the ground,  
as vehicle or transmission damage may occur. It is recommended to tow  
your vehicle with all four (4) wheels off the ground such as when using a  
car-hauling trailer. Otherwise, no recreational towing is permitted.  
In case of a roadside emergency with a disabled vehicle, see Wrecker  
towing in the Roadside Emergencies chapter.  
269  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
STARTING  
Positions of the ignition  
1. Off— locks the gearshift lever  
and allows key removal. This  
position also shuts the engine and  
all electrical accessories off.  
2. Accessory— allows the electrical  
accessories such as the radio to  
operate while the engine is not  
running.  
3. On— all electrical circuits  
operational. Warning lights  
illuminated. Key position when driving.  
4. Start— cranks the engine. Release the key as soon as the engine  
starts.  
Preparing to start your vehicle  
Engine starting is controlled by the powertrain control system.  
This system meets all Canadian interference-causing equipment standard  
requirements regulating the impulse electrical field strength of radio  
noise.  
When starting a fuel-injected engine, don’t press the accelerator before  
or during starting. Only use the accelerator when you have difficulty  
starting the engine. For more information on starting the vehicle, refer to  
Starting the engine in this chapter.  
WARNING: Extended idling at high engine speeds can produce  
very high temperatures in the engine and exhaust system,  
creating the risk of fire or other damage.  
WARNING: Do not park, idle, or drive your vehicle in dry grass  
or other dry ground cover. The emission system heats up the  
engine compartment and exhaust system, which can start a fire.  
WARNING: Do not start your vehicle in a closed garage or in  
other enclosed areas. Exhaust fumes can be toxic. Always open  
the garage door before you start the engine. See Guarding against  
exhaust fumes in this chapter for more instructions.  
270  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
WARNING: If you smell exhaust fumes inside your vehicle, have  
your dealer inspect your vehicle immediately. Do not drive if you  
smell exhaust fumes.  
Important safety precautions  
When the engine starts, the idle RPM runs faster to warm the engine. If  
the engine idle speed does not slow down automatically, have the vehicle  
checked.  
If the vehicle is operated in a heavy snow storm or blowing snow  
conditions, the engine air induction may become partially clogged with  
snow and/or ice. If this occurs the engine may experience a significant  
reduction in power output. At the earliest opportunity, clear all snow  
and/or ice away for the air induction inlet.  
Before starting the vehicle:  
1. Make sure all occupants buckle their safety belts. For more  
information on safety belts and their proper usage, refer to the Seating  
and Safety Restraints chapter.  
2. Make sure the headlamps and electrical accessories are off.  
Make sure the parking brake is  
set.  
271  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
Make sure the gearshift is in P  
(Park).  
O
/D  
P
R
N
D
3
2
1
3. Turn the key to 3 (on) without  
turning the key to 4 (start).  
Some warning lights will briefly illuminate. See Warning lights and  
chimes in the Instrument Cluster chapter for more information  
regarding the warning lights.  
272  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
Starting the engine  
1. Turn the key to 3 (on) without  
turning the key to 4 (start). If there  
is difficulty in turning the key,  
rotate the steering wheel until the  
key turns freely. This condition may  
occur when:  
the front wheels are turned  
a front wheel is against the curb  
2. Turn the key to 4 (start), then  
release the key as soon as the  
engine begins cranking. Your vehicle has a computer assisted cranking  
system that assists in starting the engine. After releasing the key from  
the 4 (start) position, the engine may continue cranking for up to  
10 seconds or until the vehicle starts.  
Note: Cranking may be stopped at any time by turning the key to the off  
position.  
3. After idling for a few seconds, release the parking brake, apply the  
brake, shift into gear and drive.  
Note: If the engine does not start on the first try, turn the key to the off  
position, wait 10 seconds and try Step 2 again. If the engine still fails to  
start, press the accelerator to the floor and try Step 2 again, keeping the  
accelerator on the floor until the engine begins to accelerate above  
cranking speeds; this will allow the engine to crank with the fuel shut off  
in case the engine is flooded with fuel.  
Guarding against exhaust fumes  
Carbon monoxide is present in exhaust fumes. Take precautions to avoid  
its dangerous effects.  
WARNING: If you smell exhaust fumes inside your vehicle, have  
your dealer inspect your vehicle immediately. Do not drive if you  
smell exhaust fumes.  
Important ventilating information  
If the engine is idling while the vehicle is stopped for a long period of  
time, open the windows at least one inch (2.5 cm) or adjust the heating  
or air conditioning to bring in fresh air.  
273  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
ENGINE BLOCK HEATER (IF EQUIPPED)  
An engine block heater warms the engine coolant which aids in starting  
and allows the heater/defroster system to respond quickly. If your vehicle  
is equipped with this system, your equipment includes a heater element  
which is installed in your engine block and a wire harness which allows  
the user to connect the system to a grounded 120 volt A/C electrical  
source. The block heater system is most effective when outdoor  
temperatures reach below 0°F (-18°C).  
WARNING: Failure to follow engine block heater instructions  
could result in property damage or physical injury.  
WARNING: To reduce the risk of electrical shock, do not use  
your heater with ungrounded electrical systems or two-pronged  
(cheater) adapters.  
Prior to using the engine block heater, follow these recommendations for  
proper and safe operation:  
For your safety, use an outdoor extension cord that is product  
certified by Underwriter’s Laboratory (UL) or Canadian Standards  
Association (CSA). Use only an extension cord that can be used  
outdoors, in cold temperatures, and is clearly marked ЉSuitable for Use  
with Outdoor Appliances.Љ Never use an indoor extension cord  
outdoors; it could result in an electric shock or fire hazard.  
Use a 16 gauge outdoor extension cord, minimum.  
Use as short an extension cord as possible.  
Do not use multiple extension cords. Instead, use one extension cord  
which is long enough to reach from the engine block heater cord to  
the outlet without stretching.  
Make certain that the extension cord is in excellent condition (not  
patched or spliced). Store your extension cord indoors at  
temperatures above 32°F (0°C). Outdoor conditions can deteriorate  
extension cords over a period of time.  
To reduce the risk of electrical shock, do not use your heater with  
ungrounded electrical systems or two pronged (cheater) adapters.  
Also ensure that the block heater, especially the cord, is in good  
condition before use.  
Make sure that when in operation, the extension cord plug /engine  
block heater cord plug connection is free and clear of water in order  
to prevent possible shock or fire.  
274  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
Be sure that areas where the vehicle is parked are clean and clear of  
all combustibles such as petroleum products, dust, rags, paper and  
similar items.  
Be sure that the engine block heater, heater cord and extension cord  
are solidly connected. A poor connection can cause the cord to  
become very hot and may result in an electrical shock or fire. Be sure  
to check for heat anywhere in the electrical hookup once the system  
has been operating for approximately a half hour.  
Finally, have the engine block heater system checked during your fall  
tune-up to be sure it’s in good working order.  
How to use the engine block heater  
Ensure the receptacle terminals are clean and dry prior to use. To clean  
them, use a dry cloth.  
Depending on the type of factory installed equipment, your engine block  
heater will use .4 to 1.0 kilowatt-hours of energy per hour of use. Your  
factory installed block heater system does not have a thermostat;  
however, maximum temperature is attained after approximately three  
hours of operation. Block heater operation longer than three hours will  
not improve system performance and will unnecessarily use additional  
electricity.  
Make sure system is unplugged and properly stowed before driving the  
vehicle. While not in use, make sure the protective cover seals the  
prongs of the engine block heater cord plug.  
BRAKES  
Occasional brake noise is normal. If a metal-to-metal, continuous grinding  
or continuous squeal sound is present, the brake linings may be worn-out  
and should be inspected by an authorized dealer. If the vehicle has  
continuous vibration or shudder in the steering wheel while braking, the  
vehicle should be inspected by an authorized dealer.  
Refer to Brake system warning  
!
P
light in the Instrument Cluster  
chapter for information on the brake  
system warning light.  
BRAKE  
275  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
Four-wheel anti-lock brake system (ABS)  
Your vehicle is equipped with an Anti-lock Braking System (ABS). This  
system helps you maintain steering control during emergency stops by  
keeping the brakes from locking. Noise from the ABS pump motor and  
brake pedal pulsation may be observed during ABS braking and the  
brake pedal may suddenly travel a little farther as soon as ABS braking is  
done and normal brake operation resumes. These are normal  
characteristics of the ABS and should be no reason for concern.  
Using ABS  
When hard braking is required, apply continuous force on the brake  
pedal; do not pump the brake pedal since this will reduce the  
effectiveness of the ABS and will increase your vehicle’s stopping  
distance. The ABS will be activated immediately, allowing you to retain  
steering control during hard braking and on slippery surfaces. However,  
the ABS does not decrease stopping distance.  
ABS warning lamp  
The ABS lamp in the instrument  
cluster momentarily illuminates  
ABS  
when the ignition is turned on. If  
the light does not illuminate during  
start up, remains on or flashes, the  
ABS may be disabled and may need to be serviced.  
Even when the ABS is disabled,  
normal braking is still effective. If  
your BRAKE warning lamp  
illuminates with the parking brake  
released, have your brake system  
serviced immediately.  
!
P
BRAKE  
276  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
Parking brake  
Apply the parking brake whenever  
the vehicle is parked. To set the  
parking brake, press the parking  
brake pedal down until the pedal  
stops.  
The BRAKE warning lamp in the  
instrument cluster illuminates and  
remains illuminated (when the  
ignition is turned on) until the  
parking brake is released.  
!
P
BRAKE  
WARNING: Always set the parking brake fully and make sure  
that the gearshift is securely latched in P (Park).  
WARNING: If the parking brake is fully released, but the brake  
warning lamp remains illuminated, the brakes may not be  
working properly. See your authorized dealer.  
The parking brake is not recommended to stop a moving vehicle.  
However, if the normal brakes fail, the parking brake can be used to stop  
your vehicle in an emergency. Since the parking brake applies only the  
rear brakes, the vehicle’s stopping distance will increase greatly and the  
handling of your vehicle will be adversely affected.  
277  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
Pull the release lever to release the  
brake. Driving with the parking  
brake on will cause the brakes to  
wear out quickly and reduce fuel  
economy.  
ADVANCETRACWITH ROLL STABILITY CONTROL™ (RSC)  
STABILITY ENHANCEMENT SYSTEM  
WARNING: Vehicle modifications involving braking system,  
aftermarket roof racks, suspension, steering system, tire  
construction and/or wheel/tire size may change the handling  
characteristics of the vehicle and may adversely affect the performance  
of the AdvanceTracwith RSCsystem. In addition, installing any  
stereo loudspeakers may interfere with and adversely affect the  
AdvanceTracwith RSCsystem. Install any aftermarket stereo  
loudspeaker as far as possible from the front center console, the  
tunnel, and the front seats in order to minimize the risk of interfering  
with the AdvanceTracwith RSCsensors. Reducing the effectiveness  
of the AdvanceTracwith RSCsystem could lead to an increased risk  
of loss of vehicle control, vehicle rollover, personal injury and death.  
WARNING: Remember that even advanced technology cannot  
defy the laws of physics. It’s always possible to lose control of a  
vehicle due to inappropriate driver input for the conditions. Aggressive  
driving on any road condition can cause you to lose control of your  
vehicle increasing the risk of personal injury or property damage.  
Activation of the AdvanceTracwith RSCsystem is an indication that  
at least some of the tires have exceeded their ability to grip the road;  
this could reduce the operator’s ability to control the vehicle,  
potentially resulting in a loss of vehicle control, vehicle rollover,  
personal injury and death. If your AdvanceTracwith RSCsystem  
activates, SLOW DOWN.  
278  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
WARNING: If a failure has been detected within the  
AdvanceTracwith RSCsystem, the Љsliding carЉ icon  
will  
illuminate steadily. Verify that the AdvanceTracwith RSCsystem is  
not manually disabled (push the AdvanceTracwith RSC“Off “  
button located on the center of the instrument panel). If the Љsliding  
carЉ icon  
still illuminates steadily, have the system serviced by an  
authorized dealer immediately. Operating your vehicle with  
AdvanceTracwith RSCdisabled could lead to an increased risk of  
loss of vehicle control, vehicle rollover, personal injury and death.  
The AdvanceTracwith RSCsystem provides the following stability  
enhancement features for certain driving situations:  
Traction Control (TCS), which functions to help avoid drive-wheel  
spin and loss of traction.  
Electronic Stability Control (ESC), which functions to help avoid skids  
or lateral slides  
Roll Stability Control™ (RSC), which functions to help avoid a  
vehicle roll-over.  
The AdvanceTracwith RSCsystem automatically enables each time  
the engine is started. All features of the AdvanceTracwith RSCsystem  
(TCS, ESC, and RSC) are active and monitor the vehicle from start-up.  
However, the system will only intervene if the driving situation requires  
it.  
The AdvanceTracwith RSC௡  
system includes an AdvanceTrac௡  
with RSC௡ ЉOffЉ button on the  
center of the instrument panel, and  
a “sliding car” icon  
instrument cluster. The “sliding car”  
icon in the instrument cluster will illuminate temporarily during  
in the  
start-up as part of a normal system self-check, or during driving if a  
driving situation causes the AdvanceTracwith RSCsystem to operate.  
If the “sliding car” icon  
illuminates steadily, verify that the  
AdvanceTracwith RSCsystem is not manually disabled by pressing  
the AdvanceTracwith RSC௡ ЉOffЉ button located on the center stack of  
the instrument panel. If the “sliding car” icon  
remains steadily  
illuminated, or if the message center (if equipped) displays SERVICE  
RSC NOW, have the system serviced by an authorized dealer  
immediately.  
279  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
When AdvanceTracwith RSCperforms a normal system self-check,  
some drivers may notice a slight movement of the brake, and/or a  
rumble, grunting, or grinding noise after startup and when driving off.  
When an event occurs that activates AdvanceTracwith RSCyou may  
experience the following:  
A slight deceleration of the vehicle  
The “sliding car”  
indicator light will flash.  
A vibration in the pedal when your foot is on the brake pedal  
If the driving condition is severe and your foot is not on the brake, the  
brake pedal may move as the systems applies higher brake forces. You  
may also hear a whoosh of air from under the instrument panel during  
this severe condition.  
The brake pedal may feel stiffer than usual.  
Traction Control (TCS)  
Traction Control is a driver aid feature that helps your vehicle maintain  
traction of the wheels, typically when driving on slippery and/or hilly  
road surfaces, by detecting and controlling wheel spin.  
Excessive wheel spin is controlled in two ways, which may work  
separately or in tandem: Engine Traction Control and Brake Traction  
Control. Engine Traction Control works to limit drive-wheel spin by  
momentarily reducing engine power. Brake Traction Control works to  
limit wheel spin by momentarily applying the brakes to the wheel that is  
slipping. Traction Control is most active at low speeds.  
During Traction Control events the “sliding car” icon  
instrument cluster will flash.  
in the  
If the Traction Control system is activated excessively in a short period  
of time, the braking portion of the system may become temporarily  
disabled to allow the brakes to cool down. In this situation, Traction  
Control will use only engine power reduction or transfer to help control  
the wheels from over-spinning. When the brakes have cooled down, the  
system will regain all features. Anti-lock braking, RSC, and ESC are not  
affected by this condition and will continue to function during the  
cool-down period.  
The Engine Traction Control and Brake Traction Control system may be  
deactivated in certain situations. See the Switching Off AdvanceTrac௡  
with RSCsection following.  
280  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
Electronic Stability Control (ESC)  
Electronic Stability Control (ESC) may enhance your vehicle’s directional  
stability during adverse maneuvers, for example when cornering severely  
or avoiding objects in the roadway. ESC operates by applying brakes to  
one or more of the wheels individually and, if necessary, reducing engine  
power if the system detects that the vehicle is about to skid or slide  
laterally.  
During Electronic Stability Control events the “sliding car” icon  
instrument cluster will flash.  
in the  
Certain adverse driving maneuvers may activate the Electronic Stability  
Control system, which include but are not limited to:  
Taking a turn too fast  
Maneuvering quickly to avoid an accident, pedestrian or obstacle  
Driving over a patch of ice or other slippery surfaces  
Changing lanes on a snow-rutted road  
Entering a snow-free road from a snow-covered side street, or vice  
versa  
Entering a paved road from a gravel road, or vice versa  
Cornering while towing a heavily loaded trailer (refer to Trailer  
towing in the Tires, Wheels and Loading chapter).  
The Electronic Stability Control system may be deactivated in certain  
situations. See the Switching Off AdvanceTracwith RSCsection  
following.  
Roll Stability Control™ (RSC)  
Roll Stability Control™ (RSC) may help to maintain roll stability of the  
vehicle during adverse maneuvers. RSCoperates by detecting the  
vehicle’s roll motion and the rate at which it changes and by applying the  
brakes to one or more wheels individually.  
During an event that activates the Roll Stability Control™ (RSC) the  
“sliding car” icon  
in the instrument cluster will flash.  
Certain adverse driving maneuvers may activate the Roll Stability  
Control™ system, which include:  
Emergency lane-change  
Taking a turn too fast  
Quick maneuvering to avoid an accident, pedestrian or obstacle  
281  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
The Roll Stability Control™ system may be deactivated in certain  
situations. See the Switching Off AdvanceTracwith RSCsection  
following.  
Switching Off AdvanceTracwith RSC௡  
If the vehicle is stuck in snow, mud or sand, and seems to lose engine  
power, switching off certain features of the AdvanceTracwith RSC௡  
system may be beneficial because the wheels are allowed to spin. This  
will restore full engine power and will enhance momentum through the  
obstacle. To switch off the AdvanceTracwith RSCsystem press the  
AdvanceTracwith RSC௡ ЉOffЉ button. Full features of the AdvanceTrac௡  
with RSCsystem can be restored by pressing the AdvanceTracwith  
RSC௡ ЉOffЉ button again or by turning off and restarting the engine.  
If you switch off the AdvanceTracwith RSCsystem, the sliding carЉ  
icon  
will illuminate steadily. Pressing the AdvanceTracwith RSC௡  
ЉOffЉ button again will turn off the Љsliding carЉ icon  
.
In R (Reverse), ABS and the Engine and Brake Traction Control features  
will continue to function; however, ESC and RSCare disabled.  
AdvanceTracwith RSCFeatures  
“Sliding  
car”  
icon  
Engine  
Traction Traction  
Control Control  
Brake  
Button  
functions  
RSC௡  
ESC  
Default at  
start-up  
Off  
Enabled Enabled Enabled  
Disabled Disabled Disabled  
Enabled  
Button  
pressed  
momentarily  
Illuminated  
solid  
below  
below  
below  
Enabled  
25 mph  
25 mph  
25 mph  
(40 km/h) (40 km/h) (40 km/h)  
Button  
Flashes  
then  
illuminated 25 mph  
solid  
Disabled Disabled Disabled Disabled  
pressed and  
held more  
than five  
seconds  
below  
below  
below  
below  
25 mph  
25 mph  
25 mph  
(40 km/h) (40 km/h) (40 km/h) (40 km/h)  
Trailer Sway Control  
When properly equipped, trailer sway control will use the vehicle’s  
AdvanceTracwith RSCsystem to detect and help reduce trailer sway  
by applying brake force at individual wheels and, if necessary, by  
reducing engine power. Trailer sway control is only enabled above  
40 mph (64 km/h).  
282  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
WARNING: Trailer sway control does not prevent a trailer from  
swaying, it mitigates the sway from increasing once it has  
occurred. If you are experiencing trailer sway it is likely that the trailer  
is improperly loaded for the correct tongue weight or the speed of the  
vehicle and trailer is too high. Pull the vehicle-trailer over to a safe  
location to check the trailer weight distribution and tongue load and  
reduce speed to a safe level while towing. If trailer sway is  
experienced, SLOW DOWN.  
During Trailer Sway Control events, the  
icon in the instrument  
cluster will flash momentarily. The message center will also display  
TRAILER SWAY REDUCE SPEED. In some cases when trailer sway is  
detected, the vehicle speed is too high and may be at or above a speed  
at which trailer sway will grow continuously. This may cause the system  
to activate multiple times, and you may experience a slight deceleration  
of the vehicle.  
Disabling Trailer Sway Control  
Trailer sway control can be disabled during any key cycle. See Trailer  
Sway Control under Refer to Message center in the Instrument Cluster  
chapter for more information. Note that even if it was disabled before  
turning off the vehicle, Trailer Sway Control will be re-enabled at each  
new key cycle.  
WARNING: Turning off Trailer Sway Control increases the risk  
of loss of vehicle control, serious injury, or death. Ford does not  
recommend disabling this feature except in situations where speed  
reduction may be detrimental (e.g., hill climbing), the driver has  
significant trailer towing experience, and can control trailer sway and  
maintain safe operation.  
STEERING  
To help prevent damage to the power steering system:  
Never hold the steering wheel at its furthest turning points (until it  
stops) for more than a few seconds when the engine is running  
Do not operate the vehicle with a low power steering pump fluid level  
(below the MIN mark on the reservoir).  
Some noise is normal during operation. If the noise is excessive, check  
for low power steering pump fluid level before seeking service by your  
authorized dealer.  
283  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
Heavy or uneven steering efforts may be caused by low power steering  
pump fluid level. Check for low power steering pump fluid level before  
seeking service by your authorized dealer.  
Do not fill the power steering pump reservoir above the MAX mark on  
the reservoir, as this may result in leaks from the reservoir.  
If the power steering system breaks down (or if the engine is turned  
off), you can steer the vehicle manually, but it takes more effort. If the  
steering wanders or pulls, check for:  
an improperly inflated tire  
uneven tire wear  
loose or worn suspension components  
loose or worn steering components  
improper steering alignment  
A high crown in the road or high crosswinds may also make the steering  
seem to wander/pull.  
PREPARING TO DRIVE  
WARNING: Utility vehicles have a significantly higher rollover  
rate than other types of vehicles.  
WARNING: In a rollover crash, an unbelted person is  
significantly more likely to die than a person wearing a seat belt.  
Utility vehicles and trucks have larger tires and increased ground  
clearance, giving the vehicle a higher center of gravity than a passenger  
car.  
WARNING: Vehicles with a higher center of gravity such as  
utility vehicles and trucks handle differently than vehicles with a  
lower center of gravity. Utility vehicles and trucks are not designed for  
cornering at speeds as high as passenger cars any more than low-slung  
sports cars are designed to perform satisfactorily under off-road  
conditions. Avoid sharp turns, excessive speed or abrupt maneuvers in  
these vehicles. Failure to drive cautiously could result in an increased  
risk of loss of vehicle control, vehicle rollover, personal injury and  
death.  
284  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
WARNING: Loaded vehicles, with a higher center of gravity,  
may handle differently than unloaded vehicles. Do not overload  
your vehicle and use extra precautions, such as driving at slower  
speeds, avoiding abrupt steering changes and allowing for increased  
stopping distance, when driving a heavily loaded vehicle. Over-loading  
or loading the vehicle improperly can deteriorate handling capability  
and contribute to loss of vehicle control and vehicle rollover.  
BRAKE-SHIFT INTERLOCK  
This vehicle is equipped with a brake-shift interlock feature that prevents  
the gearshift lever from being moved from P (Park) when the ignition is  
in the on position unless brake pedal is pressed.  
If you cannot move the gearshift lever out of P (Park) with ignition in  
the on position and the brake pedal pressed:  
1. Apply the parking brake, turn ignition key to off, then remove the key.  
2. Remove the rubber pad at the  
bottom of the cup holder to locate  
the access cap of the floor shifter  
assembly.  
3. Using a screwdriver (or  
equivalent), remove the access  
panel and depress the shifter lever  
on the shift mechanism.  
4. Apply the brake and shift into N  
(Neutral).  
5. Return the cover plug to the console access hole. Start the vehicle.  
If it is necessary to use the above procedure to move the gearshift lever,  
it is possible that a fuse has blown or the vehicle’s brakelamps are not  
operating properly. Refer to Fuses and relays in the Roadside  
Emergencies chapter.  
WARNING: Do not drive your vehicle until you verify that the  
brakelamps are working.  
WARNING: Always set the parking brake fully and make sure  
the gearshift is latched in P (Park). Turn the ignition to the off  
position and remove the key whenever you leave your vehicle.  
285  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
WARNING: If the parking brake is fully released, but the brake  
warning lamp remains illuminated, the brakes may not be  
working properly. See your authorized dealer.  
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION OPERATION  
Driving with a 5–speed automatic transmission (if equipped)  
This vehicle is equipped with an Adaptive Transmission Control Strategy.  
This Adaptive Transmission Control Strategy offers the optimal  
transmission operation and shift quality. When the vehicle’s battery has  
been disconnected for any type of service or repair, the transmission will  
need to relearn the normal shift strategy parameters, much like having to  
reset your radio stations when your vehicle battery has been  
disconnected. The Adaptive Transmission Control Strategy allows the  
transmission to relearn these operating parameters. This learning process  
could take several transmission upshifts and downshifts; during this  
learning process, slightly firmer shifts may occur. After this learning  
process, normal shift feel and shift scheduling will resume.  
P (Park)  
This position locks the transmission  
and prevents the rear wheels from  
turning.  
To put your vehicle in gear:  
Start the engine  
Press the brake pedal  
Press the gearshift release button  
on the front of the lever and  
move the gearshift lever into the  
desired gear  
To put your vehicle in P (Park):  
Come to a complete stop  
Move the gearshift lever and  
securely latch it in P (Park)  
WARNING: Always set the parking brake fully and make sure  
the gearshift is latched in P (Park). Turn the ignition to the  
LOCK position and remove the key whenever you leave your vehicle.  
286  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
R (Reverse)  
With the gearshift lever in R (Reverse), the vehicle will move backward.  
Always come to a complete stop before shifting into and out of R  
(Reverse).  
N (Neutral)  
With the gearshift lever in N (Neutral), the vehicle can be started and is  
free to roll. Hold the brake pedal down while in this position.  
D (Drive) with Overdrive  
The normal driving position for the best fuel economy. Transmission  
operates in gears one through five.  
D (Drive) without Overdrive  
Overdrive can be deactivated by  
pressing the transmission control  
switch on the side of the gearshift  
lever.  
This position allows for all  
forward gears (1-4) except  
overdrive.  
Provides engine braking.  
Use when driving conditions  
cause excessive shifting from O/D  
to other gears. Examples: heavy  
city traffic where continuous  
shifting in and out of overdrive  
occurs, hilly terrain, heavy loads,  
trailer towing and when engine  
braking is required.  
O/D OFF lamp is illuminated.  
O/D  
OFF  
To return to O/D (overdrive  
mode), press the transmission  
control switch. The O/D OFF  
lamp will not be illuminated.  
O/D (Overdrive) is automatically returned each time the key is turned  
off.  
287  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
3 (Third)  
Transmission operates in third gear only.  
Used for improved traction on slippery roads. Selecting 3 (Third)  
provides engine braking.  
2 (Second)  
Use 2 (Second) to start-up on slippery roads or to provide additional  
engine braking on downgrades.  
1 (First)  
Provides maximum engine braking.  
Allows upshifts by moving gearshift lever.  
Will not downshift into 1 (First) at high speeds; allows for 1 (First)  
when vehicle reaches slower speeds.  
Forced downshifts  
Allowed in D (Overdrive) or Drive.  
Press the accelerator to the floor.  
Allows transmission to select an appropriate gear.  
Driving with a 6–speed automatic transmission (if equipped)  
This vehicle is equipped with an Adaptive Transmission Shift Strategy.  
Adaptive Transmission Shift Strategy offers the optimal transmission  
operation and shift quality. The adaptive information will be stored  
automatically in the Powertrain Control Module (PCM) and Transmission  
Control Module (TCM). When the vehicle’s battery has been  
disconnected for any type of service or repair, the transmission will need  
to relearn the normal shift strategy parameters, much like having to reset  
your radio stations when your vehicle battery has been disconnected.  
The Adaptive Transmission Shift Strategy allows the transmission to  
relearn these operating parameters. This learning process could take  
several transmission upshifts and downshifts; during this learning  
process, slightly firmer shifts may occur. After this learning process,  
normal shift feel and shift scheduling will resume.  
288  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
P (Park)  
This position locks the transmission  
and prevents the rear wheels from  
turning.  
To put your vehicle in gear:  
Press the brake pedal  
Start the engine  
Press the gearshift lever release  
button (on the front of the lever)  
and shift into the desired gear  
To put your vehicle in P (Park):  
Come to a complete stop  
Move the gearshift lever and  
securely latch it in P (Park)  
WARNING: Always set the parking brake fully and make sure  
the gearshift is latched in P (Park). Turn the ignition to the off  
position and remove the key whenever you leave your vehicle.  
R (Reverse)  
With the gearshift lever in R (Reverse), the vehicle will move backward.  
Always come to a complete stop before shifting into and out of R  
(Reverse).  
N (Neutral)  
With the gearshift lever in N (Neutral), the vehicle can be started and is  
free to roll. Hold the brake pedal down while in this position.  
D (Drive) with Overdrive  
The normal driving position for the best fuel economy. Transmission  
operates in gears one through six.  
289  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
D (Drive) without Overdrive  
Overdrive can be deactivated by  
pressing the transmission control  
switch on the side of the shift lever.  
This position allows for all  
forward gears (1-5) except  
overdrive.  
Provides engine braking.  
Use when driving conditions  
cause excessive shifting from O/D  
to other gears. Examples: heavy  
city traffic where continuous  
shifting in and out of overdrive  
occurs, hilly terrain, heavy loads,  
trailer towing and when engine  
braking is required.  
O/D OFF lamp is illuminated.  
O/D  
OFF  
To return to O/D (overdrive  
mode), press the transmission  
control switch. The O/D OFF  
lamp will not be illuminated.  
O/D (Overdrive) is automatically returned each time the key is turned  
off.  
3 (Third)  
Transmission operates in third gear only.  
Used for improved traction on slippery roads. Selecting 3 (Third)  
provides engine braking.  
2 (Second)  
Transmission operates in 2nd gear only.  
Use 2 (Second) to start-up on slippery roads or to provide additional  
engine braking on downgrades.  
1 (First)  
Transmission operates in 1st gear only.  
Provides maximum engine braking.  
290  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
Allows upshifts by moving gearshift lever.  
Will not downshift into 1 (First) at high speeds; allows for 1 (First)  
when vehicle reaches slower speeds.  
Forced downshifts  
Allowed in D (Drive) only.  
Press the accelerator to the floor.  
Allows transmission to select an appropriate gear.  
If your vehicle gets stuck in mud or snow  
If your vehicle gets stuck in mud or snow, it may be rocked out by  
shifting between forward and reverse gears, stopping between shifts in a  
steady pattern. Press lightly on the accelerator in each gear.  
Do not rock the vehicle if the engine is not at normal operating  
temperature or damage to the transmission may occur.  
Do not rock the vehicle for more than a minute or damage to the  
transmission and tires may occur, or the engine may overheat.  
REVERSE SENSING SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)  
The reverse sensing system sounds a tone to warn the driver of obstacles  
near the rear bumper when the R (Reverse) gear is selected.  
WARNING: To help avoid personal injury, please read and  
understand the limitations of the reverse sensing system as  
contained in this section. The park assist is only an aid for some  
(generally large and fixed) objects when moving in reverse on a flat  
surface at “parking speeds”. Inclement weather may also affect the  
function of the RSS; this may include reduced performance or a false  
activation.  
WARNING: To help avoid personal injury, always use caution  
when in R (Reverse) and when using the reverse sensing system.  
WARNING: This system is not designed to prevent contact with  
small or moving objects. The system is designed to provide a  
warning to assist the driver in detecting objects to avoid damaging the  
vehicle. The system may not detect smaller objects, particularly those  
close to the ground.  
291  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
WARNING: Certain add-on devices such as large trailer hitches,  
bike or surfboard racks and any device that may block the  
normal detection zone of the reverse sensing system may create false  
beeps.  
The system will assist the driver in detecting certain objects while the  
vehicle moves in reverse at speeds less than 6 mph (10 km/h). The  
system is not effective at speeds greater than 6 mph (10 km/h) and may  
not detect certain angular or moving objects.  
The system detects obstacles within approximately 16 feet (five meters),  
at speeds above 2.5 mph (4 km/h) behind the rear bumper with a  
decreased coverage area at the outer corners of the bumper. If vehicle  
speed is below 2.5 mph (4 km/h), the system detects obstacles within  
approximately 9 feet (2.6 meters) behind the rear bumper with a  
decreased coverage area at the outer corners of the bumper. As you  
move closer to the obstacle, the rate of the tone increases. When the  
distance to the obstacle is approximately less than 18 inches (45.0 cm),  
the tone will sound continuously. If the system detects an object that is  
approaching the vehicle at such a rate that rapid braking is required, a  
very high rate tone will sound. If this tone is heard while reversing, the  
driver is advised to slow down immediately until the tone either changes  
to a slower rate or stops.  
While receiving a warning the radio volume will be reduced to a  
predetermined level. After the warning goes away, the radio will return  
to the previous value.  
292  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
Audible Warnings  
Distance to Object  
Speed above 2.5 mph (4 km/h)  
Warning  
up to 1.6 feet (.5 meters)  
Solid  
1.6 feet (.5 meters) to 3.1 feet Fast beep  
(1 meter)  
3.1 feet (1 meter) to 5.7 feet  
(1.8 meters)  
Medium/fast beep  
5.7 feet (1.8 meters) to 9 feet Medium beep  
(2.8 meters)  
9 feet (2.8 meters) to 13 feet  
(4 meters)  
Medium/slow beep  
13 feet (4 meters) to 19.6 feet Slow beep  
(6 meters)  
Speed below 2.5 mph (4 km/h)  
up to 1.4 feet (.4 meters) Solid  
1.4 feet (.4 meters) to 3 feet  
(.9 meters)  
Fast beep  
3 feet (.9 meters) to 4.5 feet  
(1.4 meters)  
Medium beep  
Medium/slow beep  
Slow beep  
4.5 feet (1.4 meters) to  
6.3 feet (1.9 meters)  
6.3 feet (1.9 meters) to  
8.7 feet (2.6 meters)  
8.7 feet (2.6 meters) to  
16.4 feet (5 meters)  
No sound  
The reverse sensing system is automatically enabled when the gearshift  
lever is placed in R (Reverse) and the ignition is on. A control in the  
message center allows the driver to disable the system, refer to Message  
center in the Instrument Cluster chapter for more information.  
The message center will indicate the system is off and will not allow the  
driver to switch the system on to indicate a failure of the reverse sensing  
system.  
The radar sensor is located behind the rear bumper/fascia. Always  
keep the rear bumper/fascia free from snow, ice and large  
accumulations of dirt. These elements may cause the system to  
operate inaccurately.  
293  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
If the vehicle sustains damage to the rear bumper/fascia, leaving  
it misaligned or bent, the sensing zone may be altered causing  
inaccurate measurement of obstacles or false alarms.  
FOUR-WHEEL DRIVE (4WD) OPERATION (IF EQUIPPED)  
WARNING: For important information regarding safe operation  
of this type of vehicle, see Preparing to drive your vehicle in  
this chapter.  
Four–wheel drive (4WD) supplies power to all four wheels. Do not use  
4X4 High or 4X4 Low on dry, hard surfaced roads. Doing so will produce  
excessive noise, increase tire wear and may damage drive components.  
4X4 High and 4X4 Low are only intended for consistently slippery or  
loose surfaces. The use of 4X4 High or 4X4 Low on these surfaces may  
produce some noise, such as occasional clunks, but will not damage the  
drive system.  
If equipped with the Electronic Shift 4WD System, and 4WD Low  
is selected while the vehicle is moving above 3 mph (5 km/h), the  
4WD system will not engage. This is normal and should be no  
reason for concern. Refer to Shifting to/from 4WD Low for proper  
operation.  
System indicator lights  
4X4 - momentarily illuminates  
4x4  
when the vehicle is started.  
Illuminates when 4X4 HIGH  
(4WD High) is selected.  
4X4 LOW – momentarily  
4x4  
LOW  
illuminates when the vehicle is  
started. Illuminates when 4X4  
LOW (4WD Low) is selected.  
Using the Control Trac 4WD system  
4X4 AUTO - Provides  
electronically-controlled four-wheel  
drive with power delivered to all  
four wheels as required for traction.  
This mode is acceptable for all  
on-road driving but recommended  
when wet pavement, snow, or loose gravel conditions are expected.  
294  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
4X4 HIGH (4WD High) - Provides locked four-wheel drive power to all  
four wheels. This mode is not intended for use on dry pavement. This  
mode is appropriate for severe winter and off-road conditions, such as  
deep snow, ice or shallow sand.  
4X4 LOW (4WD Low) - Provides locked four-wheel drive power when  
extra power at reduced speeds is required. This mode is not  
recommended for use on dry pavement. Use this mode for off-road,  
low-speed operation or when extra power is required, such as climbing  
steep grades, going through deep sand, or pulling a boat out of the  
water.  
Shifting between 4X4 AUTO (4WD Auto) and 4X4 HIGH (4WD High)  
Select 4X4 AUTO (4WD Auto) or 4X4 HIGH (4WD High) at any  
forward speed.  
Note: Do not perform this operation if the rear wheels are slipping.  
Shifting to/from 4X4 LOW (4WD Low)  
1. Bring the vehicle to a complete stop  
2. Place the transmission in N (Neutral).  
3. Press the desired 4WD position.  
If shifting into 4x4 LOW (4WD Low), wait for the 4X4 LOW light in  
the instrument cluster to turn on indicating the shift is complete.  
If shifting out of 4X4 LOW (4WD Low), wait for the 4X4 LOW light in  
the instrument cluster to turn off indicating the shift is complete.  
If any of the above shift conditions are not met, the shift will not occur  
and the message center will display the appropriate information.  
ALL WHEEL DRIVE (AWD) SYSTEM (IF EQUIPPED)  
For the lubricant specification and refill capacity of the AWD transfer  
case refer to Maintenance and Specifications chapter.  
WARNING: If your vehicle is equipped with AWD, a spare tire of  
a different size than the road tires should never be used. Such a  
tire could make the vehicle difficult to control as well as result in  
damage to driveline components.  
WARNING: Utility and four-wheel drive vehicles are not  
designed for cornering at speeds as high as passenger cars any  
more than low-slung sports cars are designed to perform satisfactorily  
under off-road conditions. Avoid sharp turns or abrupt maneuvers in  
these vehicles.  
295  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
Normal operation (4.0L engine vehicles only)  
The AWD system is always active and requires no driver input. It is  
capable of handling all road conditions, including street and highway  
driving as well as off-road conditions such as deep snow, ice or shallow  
sand.  
Normal operation (4.6L engine vehicles only)  
During normal operation the AWD system is in AWD AUTO mode (AWD  
LOCKED will illuminate in the message center for four seconds when  
you first start your vehicle). The 4X4 indicator in the instrument cluster  
will briefly illuminate when you first start your vehicle.  
For instructions on selecting the AWD LOCKED mode, refer to Message  
center in the Instrument Cluster chapter. This mode is not intended for  
use on dry pavement. This mode is appropriate for severe winter or  
off-road conditions such as deep snow, ice or shallow sand. The use of  
AWD LOCKED on dry or hard surfaces may produce some noise, such as  
occasional clunks, but will not damage the drive system.  
Autolock operation (4.6L engine vehicles only)  
If the AWD system begins to overheat, the system will place itself in the  
Autolock mode:  
AWD LOCKED will be displayed in the message center for four  
seconds and the 4x4 indicator light will illuminate in the instrument  
cluster. A warning chime will also sound. This condition may clear  
without any action being taken by the driver once the AWD system  
has reached a safe operating temperature.  
The 4X4 indicator light in the instrument cluster will turn off when  
the AWD system reaches a safe operating temperature and normal  
AWD operation is restored.  
Driving off-road with truck and utility vehicles  
AWD and 4WD vehicles are specially equipped for driving on sand, snow,  
mud and rough terrain and have operating characteristics that are  
somewhat different from conventional vehicles, both on and off the road.  
How your vehicle differs from other vehicles  
Truck and utility vehicles can differ from some other vehicles. Your  
vehicle may be higher to allow it to travel over rough terrain without  
getting hung up or damaging underbody components.  
The differences that make your vehicle so versatile also make it handle  
differently than an ordinary passenger car.  
296  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
Maintain steering wheel control at all times, especially in rough terrain.  
Since sudden changes in terrain can result in abrupt steering wheel  
motion, make sure you grip the steering wheel from the outside. Do not  
grip the spokes.  
Drive cautiously to avoid vehicle damage from concealed objects such as  
rocks and stumps.  
You should either know the terrain or examine maps of the area before  
driving. Map out your route before driving in the area. To maintain  
steering and braking control of your vehicle, you must have all four  
wheels on the ground and they must be rolling, not sliding or spinning.  
Basic operating principles  
Do not use 4WD High or 4WD Low on dry, hard surfaced roads. Doing  
so will produce excessive noise, increase tire wear, reduce fuel  
economy and may damage drive components. 4WD modes are only  
intended for consistently slippery or loose surfaces.  
Drive slower in strong crosswinds which can affect the normal steering  
characteristics of your vehicle.  
Be extremely careful when driving on pavement made slippery by  
loose sand, water, gravel, snow or ice.  
If your vehicle goes off the edge of the pavement  
If your vehicle goes off the edge of the pavement, slow down, but  
avoid severe brake application, ease the vehicle back onto the  
pavement only after reducing your speed. Do not turn the steering  
wheel too sharply while returning to the road surface.  
It may be safer to stay on the apron or shoulder of the road and slow  
down gradually before returning to the pavement. You may lose  
control if you do not slow down or if you turn the steering wheel too  
sharply or abruptly.  
It often may be less risky to strike small objects, such as highway  
reflectors, with minor damage to your vehicle rather than attempt a  
sudden return to the pavement which could cause the vehicle to slide  
sideways out of control or roll over. Remember, your safety and the  
safety of others should be your primary concern.  
297  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
WARNING: Vehicles with a higher center of gravity such as  
utility and four-wheel drive vehicles handle differently than  
vehicles with a lower center of gravity. Utility and four-wheel drive  
vehicles are not designed for cornering at speeds as high as passenger  
cars any more than low-slung sports cars are designed to perform  
satisfactorily under off-road conditions. Avoid sharp turns, excessive  
speed and abrupt maneuvers in these vehicles. Failure to drive  
cautiously could result in an increased risk of loss of vehicle control,  
vehicle rollover, personal injury and death.  
If your vehicle gets stuck  
If your vehicle gets stuck in mud or snow it may be rocked out by  
shifting between forward and reverse gears, stopping between shifts, in a  
steady pattern. Press lightly on the accelerator in each gear.  
Do not rock the vehicle if the engine is not at normal operating  
temperature or damage to the transmission may occur.  
Do not rock the vehicle for more than a few minutes or damage  
to the transmission and tires may occur or the engine may  
overheat.  
WARNING: Always set the parking brake fully and make sure  
the gearshift is latched in P (Park). Turn the ignition to the  
LOCK position and remove the key whenever you leave your vehicle.  
WARNING: If the parking brake is fully released, but the brake  
warning lamp remains illuminated, the brakes may not be  
working properly. See your authorized dealer.  
WARNING: Do not spin the wheels at over 35 mph (56 km/h).  
The tires may fail and injure a passenger or bystander.  
298  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
Emergency maneuvers  
In an unavoidable emergency situation where a sudden sharp turn  
must be made, remember to avoid “over-driving” your vehicle, i.e.,  
turn the steering wheel only as rapidly and as far as required to avoid  
the emergency. Excessive steering will result in less vehicle control,  
not more. Additionally, smooth variations of the accelerator and/or  
brake pedal pressure should be utilized if changes in vehicle speed are  
called for. Avoid abrupt steering, acceleration or braking which could  
result in an increased risk of loss of vehicle control, vehicle rollover  
and/or personal injury. Use all available road surface to return the  
vehicle to a safe direction of travel.  
In the event of an emergency stop, avoid skidding the tires and do not  
attempt any sharp steering wheel movements.  
WARNING: Vehicles with a higher center of gravity such as  
utility and four-wheel drive vehicles handle differently than  
vehicles with a lower center of gravity. Utility and four-wheel drive  
vehicles are not designed for cornering at speeds as high as passenger  
cars any more than low-slung sports cars are designed to perform  
satisfactorily under off-road conditions. Avoid sharp turns, excessive  
speed and abrupt maneuvers in these vehicles. Failure to drive  
cautiously could result in an increased risk of loss of vehicle control,  
vehicle rollover, personal injury and death.  
If the vehicle goes from one type of surface to another (i.e., from  
concrete to gravel) there will be a change in the way the vehicle  
responds to a maneuver (steering, acceleration or braking). Again,  
avoid these abrupt inputs.  
4WD Systems  
4WD uses all four wheels to power the vehicle. This increases traction,  
enabling you to drive over terrain and road conditions that a  
conventional two-wheel drive vehicle cannot.  
Power is supplied to all four wheels through a transfer case. On 4WD  
vehicles, the transfer case allows you to select 4WD when necessary.  
Information on transfer case operation and shifting procedures can be  
found in this chapter. Information on transfer case maintenance can be  
found in the Maintenance and Specifications chapter. You should  
become thoroughly familiar with this information before you operate  
your vehicle.  
299  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Driving  
Parking  
On some 4WD vehicles, when the transfer case is in the N (Neutral)  
position, the engine and transmission are disconnected from the rest of  
the driveline. Therefore, the vehicle is free to roll even if the automatic  
transmission is in P (Park) or the manual transmission is in gear. Do not  
leave the vehicle unattended with the transfer case in the N (Neutral)  
position. Always set the parking brake fully and turn off the ignition  
when leaving the vehicle.  
WARNING: Always set the parking brake fully and make sure  
the gearshift is latched in P (Park). Turn the ignition to the  
LOCK position and remove the key whenever you leave your vehicle.  
WARNING: If the parking brake is fully released, but the brake  
warning lamp remains illuminated, the brakes may not be  
working properly. See your authorized dealer.  
AWD Systems (if equipped)  
AWD uses all four wheels to power the vehicle. This increases traction,  
enabling you to drive over terrain and road conditions that a  
conventional two-wheel drive vehicle cannot.  
Sand  
When driving over sand, try to keep all four wheels on the most solid  
area of the trail. Avoid reducing the tire pressures but shift to a lower  
gear and drive steadily through the terrain. Apply the accelerator slowly  
and avoid spinning the wheels.  
Note: The Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) indicator light may  
illuminate depending on how much air is released from your tires and/or  
how long you drive the vehicle under these conditions.  
Avoid excessive speed because vehicle momentum can work against you  
and cause the vehicle to become stuck to the point that assistance may  
be required from another vehicle. Remember, you may be able to back  
out the way you came if you proceed with caution.  
300  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
Mud and water  
If you must drive through high  
water, drive slowly. Traction or  
brake capability may be limited.  
When driving through water,  
determine the depth; avoid water  
higher than the bottom of the hubs  
(if possible) and proceed slowly. If  
the ignition system gets wet, the vehicle may stall.  
Once through water, always try the brakes. Wet brakes do not stop the  
vehicle as effectively as dry brakes. Drying can be improved by moving  
your vehicle slowly while applying light pressure on the brake pedal.  
Be cautious of sudden changes in vehicle speed or direction when you  
are driving in mud. Even AWD and 4WD vehicles can lose traction in  
slick mud. As when you are driving over sand, apply the accelerator  
slowly and avoid spinning your wheels. If the vehicle does slide, steer in  
the direction of the slide until you regain control of the vehicle.  
If the transmission, transfer case or front axle are submerged in water,  
their fluids should be checked and changed, if necessary.  
Driving through deep water may damage the transmission.  
If the front or rear axle is submerged in water, the axle lubricant should  
be replaced.  
After driving through mud, clean off residue stuck to rotating driveshafts  
and tires. Excess mud stuck on tires and rotating driveshafts causes an  
imbalance that could damage drive components.  
“Tread Lightly” is an educational  
program designed to increase public  
awareness of land-use regulations  
and responsibilities in our nations  
wilderness areas. Ford Motor  
Company joins the U.S. Forest Service and the Bureau of Land  
Management in encouraging you to help preserve our national forest and  
other public and private lands by “treading lightly.”  
301  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
Driving on hilly or sloping terrain  
Although natural obstacles may make it necessary to travel diagonally up  
or down a hill or steep incline, you should always try to drive straight up  
or straight down. Avoid driving crosswise or turning on steep  
slopes or hills. A danger lies in losing traction, slipping sideways and  
possibly rolling over. Whenever driving on a hill, determine beforehand  
the route you will use. Do not drive over the crest of a hill without  
seeing what conditions are on the other side. Do not drive in reverse  
over a hill without the aid of an observer.  
When climbing a steep slope or hill,  
start in a lower gear rather than  
downshifting to a lower gear from a  
higher gear once the ascent has  
started. This reduces strain on the  
engine and the possibility of stalling.  
If you do stall out, do not try to  
turn around because you might roll  
over. It is better to back down to a  
safe location.  
Apply just enough power to the wheels to climb the hill. Too much  
power will cause the tires to slip, spin or lose traction, resulting in loss of  
vehicle control.  
Descend a hill in the same gear you  
would use to climb up the hill to  
avoid excessive brake application  
and brake overheating. Do not  
descend in neutral; instead,  
disengage overdrive or manually  
shift to a lower gear. When  
descending a steep hill, avoid  
sudden hard braking as you could  
lose control. When you brake hard,  
the front wheels can’t turn and if  
they aren’t turning, you won’t be  
able to steer. The front wheels have to be turning in order to steer the  
vehicle. Rapid pumping of the brake pedal will help you slow the vehicle  
and still maintain steering control.  
If your vehicle has anti-lock brakes, apply the brakes steadily. Do not  
“pump” the brakes.  
302  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
Driving on snow and ice  
AWD and 4WD vehicles have advantages over 2WD vehicles in snow and  
ice but can skid like any other vehicle.  
Should you start to slide while driving on snowy or icy roads, turn the  
steering wheel in the direction of the slide until you regain control.  
Avoid sudden applications of power and quick changes of direction on  
snow and ice. Apply the accelerator slowly and steadily when starting  
from a full stop.  
Avoid sudden braking as well. Although an AWD or a 4WD vehicle may  
accelerate better than a two-wheel drive vehicle in snow and ice, it won’t  
stop any faster, because as in other vehicles, braking occurs at all four  
wheels. Do not become overconfident as to road conditions.  
Make sure you allow sufficient distance between you and other vehicles  
for stopping. Drive slower than usual and consider using one of the lower  
gears. In emergency stopping situations, avoid locking of the wheels. Use  
a “squeeze” technique, push on the brake pedal with a steadily increasing  
force which allows the wheels to brake yet continue to roll so that you  
may steer in the direction you want to travel. If you lock the wheels,  
release the brake pedal and repeat the squeeze technique. If your vehicle  
is equipped with a Four Wheel Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS), apply the  
brake steadily. Do not “pump” the brakes. Refer to the Brakes section of  
this chapter for additional information on the operation of the anti-lock  
brake system.  
WARNING: If you are driving in slippery conditions that require  
tire cables, then it is critical that you drive cautiously. Keep  
speeds down, allow for longer stopping distances and avoid aggressive  
steering to reduce the chances of a loss of vehicle control which can  
lead to serious injury or death. If the rear end of the vehicle slides  
while cornering, steer in the direction of the slide until you regain  
control of the vehicle.  
Maintenance and Modifications  
The suspension and steering systems on your vehicle have been designed  
and tested to provide predictable performance whether loaded or empty  
and durable load carrying capability. For this reason, Ford Motor  
Company strongly recommends that you do not make modifications such  
as adding or removing parts (such as lift kits or stabilizer bars) or by  
using replacement parts not equivalent to the original factory equipment.  
303  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Driving  
Any modifications to a vehicle that raise the center of gravity can make  
it more likely the vehicle will roll over as a result of a loss of control.  
Ford Motor Company recommends that caution be used with any vehicle  
equipped with a high load or device (such as ladder racks or pickup box  
cover).  
Failure to maintain your vehicle properly may void the warranty, increase  
your repair cost, reduce vehicle performance and operational capabilities  
and adversely affect driver and passenger safety. Frequent inspection of  
vehicle chassis components is recommended if the vehicle is subjected to  
heavy off-road usage.  
DRIVING THROUGH WATER  
If driving through deep or standing  
water is unavoidable, proceed very  
slowly especially when the depth is  
not known. Never drive through  
water that is higher than the bottom  
of the wheel rims (for cars) or the  
bottom of the hubs (for trucks).  
When driving through water, traction or brake capability may be limited.  
Also, water may enter your engine’s air intake and severely damage your  
engine or your vehicle may stall. Driving through deep water where  
the transmission vent tube is submerged may allow water into the  
transmission and cause internal transmission damage.  
Once through the water, always dry the brakes by moving your  
vehicle slowly while applying light pressure on the brake pedal.  
Wet brakes do not stop the vehicle as quickly as dry brakes.  
304  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
ROADSIDE ASSISTANCE  
Getting roadside assistance  
To fully assist you should you have a vehicle concern, Ford Motor  
Company offers a complimentary roadside assistance program. This  
program is separate from the New Vehicle Limited Warranty. The service  
is available:  
24–hours, seven days a week  
for the coverage period listed on the Roadside Assistance Card  
included in your Owner Guide portfolio.  
Roadside assistance will cover:  
a flat tire change with a good spare (except vehicles that have been  
supplied with a tire inflation kit)  
battery jump start  
lock-out assistance (key replacement cost is the customer’s  
responsibility)  
fuel delivery – Independent Service Contractors, if not prohibited by  
state, local or municipal law shall deliver up to 2.0 gallons (7.5L) of  
gasoline or 5 gallons (18.9L) of diesel fuel to a disabled vehicle. Fuel  
delivery service is limited to two no-charge occurrences within a  
12-month period.  
winch out – available within 100 feet (30.5 meters) of a paved or  
county maintained road, no recoveries.  
towing – Ford/Mercury/Lincoln eligible vehicle towed to an authorized  
dealer within 35 miles (56.3 km) of the disablement location or to the  
nearest authorized dealer. If a member requests to be towed to an  
authorized dealer more than 35 miles (56.3 km) from the disablement  
location, the member shall be responsible for any mileage costs in  
excess of 35 miles (56.3 km).  
Trailers shall be covered up to $200 if the disabled eligible vehicle  
requires service at the nearest authorized dealer. If the trailer is disabled,  
but the towing vehicle is operational, the trailer does not qualify for any  
roadside services.  
Canadian customers refer to your Customer Information Guide  
for information on:  
coverage period  
exact fuel amounts  
305  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
towing of your disabled vehicle  
emergency travel expense reimbursement  
travel planning benefits  
In Canada, for uninterrupted Roadside Assistance coverage, you may  
purchase extended coverage prior to your Basic Warranty’s Roadside  
Assistance expiring. For more information and enrollment, contact  
1–877–294–2582 or visit our website at www.ford.ca.  
Using roadside assistance  
Complete the roadside assistance identification card and place it in your  
wallet for quick reference. In the United States, this card is found in the  
Owner Guide portfolio in the glove compartment. In Canada, the card is  
found in the Customer Information Guide in the glove compartment.  
U.S. Ford, Mercury and Lincoln vehicle customers who require Roadside  
Assistance, call 1-800-241-3673.  
Canadian customers who require roadside assistance, call  
1-800-665-2006.  
If you need to arrange roadside assistance for yourself, Ford Motor  
Company will reimburse a reasonable amount for towing to the nearest  
dealership within 35 miles. To obtain reimbursement information, U.S.  
Ford, Mercury and Lincoln vehicle customers call 1-800-241-3673.  
Customers will be asked to submit their original receipts.  
Canadian customers who need to obtain reimbursement information, call  
1–800–665–2006.  
HAZARD FLASHER CONTROL  
The hazard flasher is located on the  
steering column, just behind the  
steering wheel. The hazard flashers  
will operate when the ignition is in  
any position or if the key is not in  
the ignition.  
Press in the flasher control and all  
front and rear direction signals will  
flash. Press the flasher control again  
to turn them off. Use it when your  
vehicle is disabled and is creating a  
safety hazard for other motorists.  
Note: With extended use, the flasher may run down your battery.  
306  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
FUEL  
RESET  
FUEL PUMP SHUT-OFF SWITCH  
The fuel pump shut-off switch is a device intended to stop the electric  
fuel pump when your vehicle has been involved in a substantial jolt.  
After a collision, if the engine cranks but does not start, the fuel pump  
shut-off switch may have been activated.  
The fuel pump shut-off switch is  
located in the passenger’s foot well,  
by the kick panel.  
Use the following procedure to reset the fuel pump shut-off switch.  
1. Turn the ignition to the off position.  
2. Check the fuel system for leaks.  
3. If no fuel leak is apparent, reset the fuel pump shut-off switch by  
pressing in on the reset button.  
4. Turn the ignition to the on position. Pause for a few seconds and  
return the key to the off position.  
5. Make a further check for leaks in the fuel system.  
307  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
FUSES AND RELAYS  
Fuses  
If electrical components in the  
vehicle are not working, a fuse may  
have blown. Blown fuses are  
identified by a broken wire within  
the fuse. Check the appropriate  
fuses before replacing any electrical  
components.  
15  
Note: Always replace a fuse with one that has the specified amperage  
rating. Using a fuse with a higher amperage rating can cause severe wire  
damage and could start a fire.  
Standard fuse amperage rating and color  
COLOR  
Fuse  
rating  
2A  
3A  
4A  
Standard  
fuses  
Grey  
Violet  
Pink  
Tan  
Cartridge  
maxi fuses  
Mini fuses  
Maxi fuses  
Grey  
Violet  
Pink  
Tan  
5A  
7.5A  
10A  
15A  
20A  
25A  
30A  
40A  
50A  
60A  
70A  
80A  
Brown  
Red  
Brown  
Red  
Yellow  
Green  
Orange  
Red  
Blue  
Tan  
Natural  
Blue  
Pink  
Green  
Red  
Yellow  
Blue  
Yellow  
Natural  
Green  
Blue  
Yellow  
Natural  
Green  
308  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
Passenger compartment fuse panel  
The fuse panel is located below the  
instrument panel on the driver’s  
side.  
To remove a fuse use the fuse puller tool provided on the fuse panel box.  
4
3
8
7
12  
11  
16  
15  
20  
19  
24  
23  
28  
27  
CB1  
2
1
6
5
10  
9
14  
13  
18  
17  
22  
21  
26  
25  
The fuses are coded as follows:  
Fuse/Relay  
Location  
1
Fuse Amp  
Rating  
20A  
Protected Circuits  
Moon roof, Adjustable pedals,  
Memory seats, Lumbar motor  
Microcontroller power  
Radio, Navigation amplifier, GPS  
module  
2
3
5A  
20A  
4
10A  
On-board diagnostic (OBD II)  
connector  
309  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
Fuse/Relay  
Location  
5
Fuse Amp  
Rating  
5A  
Protected Circuits  
Moon roof, Door lock switch  
illumination, Auto dimming rear  
view mirror  
6
20A  
Liftglass release motor, Door  
unlock/lock  
7
8
15A  
15A  
Trailer stop/turn  
Ignition switch power, Passive  
anti-theft system (PATS), Cluster  
6R Transmission control  
module/Powertrain control  
module (Ignition RUN/START),  
Fuel pump relay  
9
2A  
10  
5A  
Front wiper RUN/ACC relay in  
power distribution box (PDB)  
Radio start  
Rear wiper motor RUN/ACC,  
Trailer battery charge relay in  
PDB, Radio  
11  
12  
5A  
5A  
13  
15A  
Heated mirror, Manual climate  
rear defrost indicator  
Horn  
14  
15  
16  
17  
20A  
10A  
10A  
10A  
Reverse lamps  
Trailer reverse lamps  
Restraints control module,  
Passenger occupancy  
Reverse park aid, Roll Stability  
Control™ (RSC) switch, RSC,  
4x4 module, 4x4 switch, Heated  
seat switches, Auxiliary climate  
control  
18  
10A  
19  
20  
10A  
Not used  
Climate control system, Brake  
shift  
310  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
Fuse/Relay  
Location  
Fuse Amp  
Rating  
Protected Circuits  
21  
22  
Not used  
15A  
Brake switch, Bi-color stop lamps,  
High-mount brake lamp, All turn  
lamps  
23  
15A  
Interior lamps, Puddle lamps,  
Battery saver, Instrument  
illumination, Homelink  
Cluster, Theft indicator light  
Trailer tow park lamps  
License plate/rear park lamp,  
Front park lamps, Manual climate  
Tri-color stop lamps  
24  
25  
26  
10A  
15A  
15A  
27  
28  
CB1  
15A  
10A  
25A  
Climate controls  
Windows  
The following relays are located on either side of the passenger  
compartment fuse panel. See your authorized dealer for service of these  
relays.  
Fuse/Relay Location  
Description  
Relay 1  
Delayed accessory relay  
Power distribution box  
The power distribution box is located in the engine compartment. The  
power distribution box contains high-current fuses that protect your  
vehicle’s main electrical systems from overloads.  
WARNING: Always disconnect the battery before servicing high  
current fuses.  
WARNING: To reduce risk of electrical shock, always replace  
the cover to the Power Distribution Box before reconnecting the  
battery or refilling fluid reservoirs.  
If the battery has been disconnected and reconnected, refer to the  
Battery section of the Maintenance and Specifications chapter.  
311  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
The high-current fuses are coded as follows:  
Fuse/Relay  
Location  
1
Fuse Amp  
Rating  
Protected Circuits  
50A**  
Battery feed 2 (passenger  
compartment fuse panel)  
Battery feed 3 (passenger  
compartment fuse panel)  
Battery feed 1 (passenger  
compartment fuse panel)  
Fuel pump, Injectors  
Third row seat (left)  
Anti-lock brake system (ABS) pump  
Powertrain control module (PCM)  
Not used  
2
3
50A**  
50A**  
4
5
6
7
8
30A**  
30A**  
40A**  
40A**  
9
Not used  
10  
11  
12  
30A**  
30A**  
30A**  
Power seat (right)  
Starter  
Third row seat (right)  
312  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
Fuse/Relay  
Location  
Fuse Amp  
Rating  
30A**  
30A**  
40A**  
40A**  
40A**  
30A**  
30A**  
30A**  
30A**  
20A*  
Protected Circuits  
13  
14  
Trailer tow battery charger  
Memory seats  
Non-memory seats  
Rear defrost, Heated mirrors  
Front blower motor  
Trailer electronic brakes  
Auxiliary blower motor  
Running boards  
Front wiper motor  
Rear power point  
Subwoofer  
15  
16  
17  
18  
19  
20  
21  
22  
23  
24  
20A*  
20A*  
10A*  
4x4  
PCM – keep alive power, Canister  
vent  
25  
26  
27  
20A*  
20A*  
20A*  
Front power point/Cigar lighter  
4x4 module (4.6L engine only)  
6R Transmission module (4.6L engine  
only)  
28  
29  
30  
31  
32  
33  
34  
35  
36  
37  
38  
39  
20A*  
15A*  
25A*  
15A*  
5A*  
30A*  
15A*  
10A*  
20A*  
30A*  
15A*  
15A*  
Heated seats  
Headlamps (right)  
Rear wiper  
Fog lamps  
Power mirrors  
ABS valve  
Headlamps (left)  
A/C clutch  
Console bin power point  
Driver window motor  
5R Transmission (4.0L engine only)  
PCM power  
313  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
Fuse/Relay  
Location  
40  
Fuse Amp  
Rating  
15A*  
Protected Circuits  
Fan clutch, Positive crackcase  
ventilation (PCV) valve, A/C clutch  
relay  
41  
42  
15A*  
15A*  
Satellite radio module, DVD, SYNC௡  
Redundant brake switch, Electronic  
vapor management valve, Mass air  
flow sensor, Heated exhaust gas  
oxygen (HEGO) sensor, EVR, Variable  
cam timing (VCT)1 (4.6L engine  
only), VCT2 (4.6L engine only),  
CMCV (4.6L engine only), Catalyst  
monitor sensor  
43  
15A*  
Coil on plug (4.6L engine only), Coil  
tower (4.0L engine only)  
Injectors  
Not used  
Not used  
Not used  
Not used  
Fuel pump relay  
44  
45B  
45A  
46B  
46A  
49  
15A*  
50B  
50A  
51  
A/C clutch relay  
Fog lamps relay  
Not used  
52  
Not used  
53  
One touch integrated start (OTIS)  
(diode)  
54  
Trailer battery charger relay  
Front wiper relay  
PCM relay  
Starter relay  
Blower relay  
55B  
55A  
56B  
56A  
* Mini Fuses ** Cartridge Fuses  
314  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
CHANGING THE TIRES  
If you get a flat tire while driving:  
do not brake heavily.  
gradually decrease the vehicle’s speed.  
hold the steering wheel firmly.  
slowly move to a safe place on the side of the road.  
Note: The tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) indicator light will  
illuminate when the spare is in use. To restore the full functionality of  
the monitoring system, all road wheels equipped with tire pressure  
monitoring sensors must be mounted on the vehicle.  
Have a flat serviced by an authorized dealer in order to prevent damage  
to the TPMS sensor, refer to Changing tires with TPMS in the Tires,  
Wheels and Loading chapter. Replace the spare tire with a road tire as  
soon as possible.  
WARNING: The use of tire sealants may damage your Tire  
Pressure Monitoring System and should not be used.  
WARNING: Refer to Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)  
in the Tires, Wheels and Loading chapter for important  
information. If the tire pressure monitor sensor becomes damaged, it  
will no longer function.  
Dissimilar spare tire/wheel information  
WARNING: Failure to follow these guidelines could result in an  
increased risk of loss of vehicle control, injury or death.  
Note: Turn off the power running boards (if equipped) before driving  
with a dissimilar spare tire/wheel. Refer to Running boards in the  
Driver Controls chapter.  
If you have a dissimilar spare tire/wheel, then it is intended for  
temporary use only. This means that if you need to use it, you should  
replace it as soon as possible with a road tire/wheel that is the same size  
and type as the road tires and wheels that were originally provided by  
Ford. If the dissimilar spare tire or wheel is damaged, it should be  
replaced rather than repaired.  
315  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
A dissimilar spare tire/wheel is defined as a spare tire and/or wheel that  
is different in brand, size or appearance from the road tires and wheels  
and can be one of three types:  
1. T-type mini-spare: This spare tire begins with the letter “T” for tire  
size and may have “Temporary Use Only” molded in the sidewall  
2. Full-size dissimilar spare with label on wheel: This spare tire has  
a label on the wheel that states: “THIS TIRE AND WHEEL FOR  
TEMPORARY USE ONLY”  
When driving with one of the dissimilar spare tires listed above, do not:  
Exceed 50 mph (80 km/h)  
Load the vehicle beyond maximum vehicle load rating listed on the  
Safety Compliance Label  
Tow a trailer  
Use snow chains on the end of the vehicle with the dissimilar spare  
tire  
Use more than one dissimilar spare tire at a time  
Use commercial car washing equipment  
Try to repair the dissimilar spare tire  
Use of one of the dissimilar spare tires listed above at any one wheel  
location can lead to impairment of the following:  
Handling, stability and braking performance  
Comfort and noise  
Ground clearance and parking at curbs  
Winter weather driving capability  
Wet weather driving capability  
3. Full-size dissimilar spare without label on wheel  
When driving with the full-size dissimilar spare tire/wheel, do not:  
Exceed 70 mph (113 km/h)  
Use more than one dissimilar spare tire/wheel at a time  
Use commercial car washing equipment  
Use snow chains on the end of the vehicle with the dissimilar spare  
tire/wheel  
316  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
The usage of a full-size dissimilar spare tire/wheel can lead to  
impairment of the following:  
Handling, stability and braking performance  
Comfort and noise  
Ground clearance and parking at curbs  
Winter weather driving capability  
Wet weather driving capability  
All-Wheel driving capability (if applicable)  
Load leveling adjustment (if applicable)  
When driving with the full-size dissimilar spare tire/wheel additional  
caution should be given to:  
Towing a trailer  
Driving vehicles equipped with a camper body  
Driving vehicles with a load on the cargo rack  
Drive cautiously when using a full-size dissimilar spare tire/wheel and  
seek service as soon as possible.  
Stopping and securing the vehicle  
1. Park on a level surface, activate  
the hazard flashers and set the  
parking brake.  
2. Place gearshift lever in P (Park)  
and turn engine off.  
3. Turn off the power running boards (if equipped). Refer to Running  
boards in the Driver Controls chapter.  
Note: Passengers should not remain in the vehicle when the vehicle is  
being jacked.  
317  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
Location of the spare tire and tools  
The spare tire and tools for your vehicle are stowed in the following  
locations:  
Tool  
Location  
Spare tire  
Under the vehicle, just in front of  
the rear bumper. The spare tire  
winch drive nut is located at the  
rear center of the cargo area  
under a lid.  
Jack, lug nut wrench, jack handle, Behind the rear seat under the  
wheel chock  
carpeted floor lid in the cargo  
floor. The tools are located in a  
bag attached to the jack.  
Removing the jack and tools  
1. Open liftgate and remove the  
carpeted floor lid.  
2. Turn jack screw eyelet (1)  
counterclockwise to release  
pressure.  
3. Rotate the locking pin (2)  
clockwise until loose then pull out  
until it stops and remove the jack  
and tool bag from the bracket.  
4. Remove the chock and jack tools  
from the provided bag rotate the  
wrench socket out from the handle.  
318  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
Removing the spare tire  
Do not use an impact wrench on the winch drive nut. This will  
damage the spare tire winch.  
1. Open the cover from the carpeting on cargo floor to expose the winch  
drive nut.  
2. Insert the lug wrench on the  
winch drive nut.  
The wrench will stop moving and  
forward resistance to turning will be  
felt when properly engaged.  
319  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
3. Turn the wrench  
counterclockwise until the tire is  
lowered to the ground and the cable  
has slack. When turning the wrench,  
make sure that it does not scuff the  
kick plate.  
4. Slide the tire rearward, lift one  
side and remove the retainer from  
the spare tire.  
Changing the spare tire  
WARNING: When one of the rear wheels is off the ground, the  
transmission alone will not prevent the vehicle from moving or  
slipping off the jack, even if the transmission is in P (Park).  
WARNING: To help prevent the vehicle from moving when you  
change a tire, be sure the parking brake is set, then block the  
wheel that is diagonally opposite (other end of the vehicle) to the tire  
being changed.  
WARNING: If the vehicle slips off the jack, you or someone else  
could be seriously injured.  
WARNING: Do not attempt to change a tire on the side of the  
vehicle close to moving traffic. Pull far enough off the road to  
avoid the danger of being hit when operating the jack or changing the  
wheel.  
WARNING: Turn off the running boards (if equipped) before  
working under the vehicle, jacking, or placing any object under  
the vehicle. Never place your hand in the hinge assemblies. A moving  
running board may cause injury.  
320  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
Note: Passengers should not remain in the vehicle when the vehicle is  
being jacked.  
1. Block the wheel that is diagonally  
opposite of the flat tire using the  
wheel chock provided with your  
vehicle.  
2. Use the tip of the lug wrench to  
remove the beauty cap by twisting  
the tip under the cap. On  
5–passenger vehicles, the carpeted  
floor lid can be used as a kneeling  
pad.  
3. Loosen each wheel lug nut by half  
a turn, but do not remove them  
until the wheel is raised off the  
ground.  
4. Assemble the jack handle  
extension on the lug nut wrench by  
sliding the square end of the jack  
handle through the plastic grommet  
on the lug nut wrench and into the  
square hole on the other side.  
321  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
5. Position the jack according to the  
illustrated guides and turn the jack  
handle clockwise until the tire is a  
maximum of 1 inch (25 mm) off the  
ground.  
Note: Do not use the running  
boards, front and rear hinge  
assemblies, running board motors,  
or the running board underbody  
mounts to lift the vehicle with the  
jack.  
WARNING: To lessen the  
risk of personal injury, do  
not put any part of your body  
under the vehicle while changing a  
tire. Do not start the engine when  
your vehicle is on the jack. The  
jack is only meant for changing  
the tire.  
Never use the front or rear differential as a jacking point.  
6. Remove the lug nuts with the lug wrench.  
7. Replace the flat tire with the spare tire, making sure the valve stem is  
facing outward. Reinstall the lug nuts, cone side in, until the wheel is  
snug against the hub. Do not fully tighten the lug nuts until the wheel  
has been lowered.  
8. Lower the wheel by turning the jack handle counterclockwise.  
322  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
9. Remove the jack and fully tighten  
the lug nuts in the order shown.  
Refer to Wheel lug nut torque  
specifications later in this chapter  
for the proper lug nut torque  
specification.  
1
3
4
5
2
Stowing the flat/spare tire  
Note: Failure to follow spare tire stowage instructions may result in  
failure of cable or loss of spare tire.  
1. Lay the tire on the ground with the valve stem facing up, toward the  
vehicle.  
2. Slide the wheel partially under the vehicle and install the retainer  
through the wheel center. Pull on the cable to align the components at  
the end of the cable.  
3. Turn the lug wrench clockwise until the tire is raised to its stowed  
position underneath the vehicle. The effort to turn the jack handle  
increases significantly and the spare tire carrier ratchets or slips when  
the tire is raised to the maximum tightness. Tighten to the best of your  
ability, to the point where the ratchet/slip occurs, if possible. The spare  
tire carrier will not allow you to overtighten. If the spare tire carrier  
ratchets or slips with little effort, take the vehicle to your authorized  
dealer for assistance at your earliest convenience.  
4. Check that the tire lies flat against the frame and is properly  
tightened. Try to push or pull, then turn the tire to be sure it will not  
move. Loosen and retighten, if necessary. Failure to properly stow the  
spare tire may result in failure of the winch cable and loss of the tire.  
5. If your vehicle is equipped with a spare tire lock and key, be sure to  
install the spare tire lock into the bumper drive tube with the spare tire  
lock key and jack handle.  
6. Repeat this tightness check procedure when servicing the spare tire  
pressure (every six months, per scheduled maintenance information),  
or at any time that the spare tire is disturbed through service of other  
components.  
323  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
Re-stowing the jack and tools  
1. Unblock the wheels.  
2. Stow the wheel ornament (if removed) in a safe location in the vehicle  
(such as the glove box or jack stowage compartment) so it will not  
become damaged. Re-install the wheel ornament onto the wheel once the  
tire is repaired or replaced.  
3. Stow the jack and tools in their respective locations, making sure they  
are fully secured so they do not rattle when you drive.  
WHEEL LUG NUT TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS  
Retighten the lug nuts to the specified torque within 100 miles (160 km)  
after any wheel disturbance (rotation, flat tire, wheel removal, etc.).  
Lug nut socket  
size/Bolt size  
Wheel lug nut torque*  
lb.ft.  
100  
Nm  
3
Lug nut socket size: 4  
inch (19 mm) hex  
135  
1
Bolt size: 2 x 20  
* Torque specifications are for nut and bolt threads free of dirt and  
rust. Use only Ford recommended replacement fasteners.  
WARNING: When a wheel is installed, always remove any  
corrosion, dirt or foreign materials present on the mounting  
surfaces of the wheel or the surface of the wheel hub, brake drum or  
brake disc that contacts the wheel. Ensure that any fasteners that  
attach the rotor to the hub are secured so they do not interfere with  
the mounting surfaces of the wheel. Installing wheels without correct  
metal-to-metal contact at the wheel mounting surfaces can cause the  
wheel nuts to loosen and the wheel to come off while the vehicle is in  
motion, resulting in loss of control.  
324  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
Note: Inspect the wheel pilot hole  
prior to installation. If there is  
visible corrosion in wheel pilot hole,  
remove loose particles by wiping  
with clean rag and apply grease.  
Apply grease only to the wheel pilot  
hole surface by smearing a “dime”  
(1 square cm) sized glob of grease  
around the wheel pilot surface (1)  
with end of finger. DO NOT apply  
grease to lugnut/stud holes or  
wheel-to-brake surfaces.  
RUNNING OUT OF FUEL  
If you have run out of fuel and need to refill the vehicle with a portable  
fuel container, see Running out of fuel in the Maintenance and  
Specifications chapter for proper fuel filling method using a portable  
fuel container and the included fuel filler funnel. Do not insert the  
nozzle of portable fuel containers or any type of aftermarket funnels into  
the Easy Fuel™ “no cap” fuel system as it can be damaged. You must  
use the included funnel in such circumstances.  
WARNING: Do not insert the nozzle of portable fuel containers  
or aftermarket funnels into the Easy Fuel™ system. This could  
damage the fuel system and its seal, and may cause fuel to run onto  
the ground instead of filling the tank, all of which could result in  
serious personal injury.  
JUMP STARTING  
WARNING: The gases around the battery can explode if  
exposed to flames, sparks, or lit cigarettes. An explosion could  
result in injury or vehicle damage.  
WARNING: Batteries contain sulfuric acid which can burn skin,  
eyes and clothing, if contacted.  
Do not attempt to push-start your automatic transmission  
vehicle. Automatic transmissions do not have push-start  
capability. Attempting to push-start a vehicle with an automatic  
transmission may cause transmission damage.  
325  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
Preparing your vehicle  
When the battery is disconnected or a new battery is installed, the  
automatic transmission must relearn its shift strategy. As a result, the  
transmission may have firm and/or soft shifts. This operation is  
considered normal and will not affect function or durability of the  
transmission. Over time, the adaptive learning process will fully update  
transmission operation.  
1. Use only a 12–volt supply to start your vehicle.  
2. Do not disconnect the battery of the disabled vehicle as this could  
damage the vehicle’s electrical system.  
3. Park the booster vehicle close to the hood of the disabled vehicle  
making sure the two vehicles do not touch. Set the parking brake on  
both vehicles and stay clear of the engine cooling fan and other moving  
parts.  
4. Check all battery terminals and remove any excessive corrosion before  
you attach the battery cables. Ensure that vent caps are tight and level.  
5. Turn the heater fan on in both vehicles to protect from any electrical  
surges. Turn all other accessories off.  
Connecting the jumper cables  
1. Connect the positive (+) jumper cable to the positive (+) terminal of  
the discharged battery.  
Note: In the illustrations, lightning bolts are used to designate the  
assisting (boosting) battery.  
326  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
2. Connect the other end of the positive (+) cable to the positive (+)  
terminal of the assisting battery.  
3. Connect the negative (-) cable to the negative (-) terminal of the  
assisting battery.  
327  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
-
-
4. Make the final connection of the negative (-) cable to the ground stud  
located toward the front of the vehicle (forward of the battery) on the  
radiator support. Keep the negative (-) cable away from the battery and  
the carburetor/fuel injection system.  
Note: Do not attach the negative (-) cable fuel lines, engine rocker  
covers, the intake manifold or electrical components as grounding  
points.  
WARNING: Do not connect the end of the second cable to the  
negative (-) terminal of the battery to be jumped. A spark may  
cause an explosion of the gases that surround the battery.  
5. Ensure that the cables are clear of fan blades, belts, moving parts of  
both engines, or any fuel delivery system parts.  
328  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
Jump starting  
1. Start the engine of the booster vehicle and run the engine at  
moderately increased speed.  
2. Start the engine of the disabled vehicle.  
3. Once the disabled vehicle has been started, run both engines for an  
additional three minutes before disconnecting the jumper cables.  
Removing the jumper cables  
Remove the jumper cables in the reverse order that they were  
connected.  
1. Remove the jumper cable from the ground metal surface.  
2. Remove the jumper cable on the negative (-) connection of the  
booster vehicle’s battery.  
3. Remove the jumper cable from the positive (+) terminal of the booster  
vehicle’s battery.  
329  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
4. Remove the jumper cable from the positive (+) terminal of the  
disabled vehicle’s battery.  
After the disabled vehicle has been started and the jumper cables  
removed, allow it to idle for several minutes so the engine computer can  
relearn its idle conditions.  
330  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Roadside Emergencies  
WRECKER TOWING  
Note: Turn off the power running boards (if equipped) prior to  
preparing the vehicle for towing. Refer to Power deployable running  
boards in the Driver Controls chapter.  
If you need to have your vehicle towed, contact a professional towing  
service or, if you are a member of a roadside assistance program, your  
roadside assistance service provider.  
It is recommended that your vehicle be towed with a wheel lift or flatbed  
equipment. Do not tow with a slingbelt. Ford Motor Company has not  
approved a slingbelt towing procedure.  
If the vehicle’s battery is discharged, refer to Automatic transmission  
operation in the Driving chapter for directions on how to move the  
gearshift lever out of the P (Park) position, for proper towing.  
On 4x2 vehicles, it is acceptable to tow the vehicle with the front wheels  
on the ground (without dollies) and the rear wheels off the ground.  
331  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Roadside Emergencies  
On 4x4/AWD vehicles, it is required that your vehicle be towed with a  
wheel lift and dollies or flatbed equipment with all the wheels off the  
ground.  
If the vehicle is towed by other means or incorrectly, vehicle  
damage may occur.  
Ford Motor Company produces a towing manual for all authorized tow  
truck operators. Have your tow truck operator refer to this manual for  
proper hook-up and towing procedures for your vehicle.  
Emergency towing  
In case of a roadside emergency with a disabled vehicle (without access  
to wheel dollies, car hauling trailer, or flatbed transport vehicle) your  
vehicle (regardless of transmission powertrain configuration) can be flat  
towed (all wheels on the ground) under the following conditions:  
Vehicle is facing forward so that it is being towed in a forward  
direction.  
Place the transmission in N (Neutral). Refer to Brake shift interlock  
in the Driving chapter for specific instructions if you cannot move the  
gear shift lever into N (Neutral).  
Maximum speed is not to exceed 35 mph (56 km/h).  
Maximum distance is 50 miles (80 km).  
332  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Customer Assistance  
GETTING THE SERVICES YOU NEED  
Warranty repairs to your vehicle must be performed by an authorized  
Ford, Lincoln, or Mercury dealer. While any authorized dealer handling  
your vehicle line will provide warranty service, we recommend you  
return to your selling authorized dealer who wants to ensure your  
continued satisfaction.  
Please note that certain warranty repairs require special training and/or  
equipment, so not all authorized dealers are authorized to perform all  
warranty repairs. This means that, depending on the warranty repair  
needed, you may have to take your vehicle to another authorized dealer.  
A reasonable time must be allowed to perform a repair after taking your  
vehicle to the authorized dealer. Repairs will be made using Ford or  
Motorcraft parts, or remanufactured or other parts that are authorized by  
Ford.  
Away from home  
If you are away from home when your vehicle needs service, contact the  
Ford Customer Relationship Center or use the online resources listed  
below to find the nearest authorized dealer.  
In the United States:  
Mailing address  
Ford Motor Company  
Customer Relationship Center  
P.O. Box 6248  
Dearborn, MI 48121  
Telephone  
1-800-392-3673 (FORD)  
(TDD for the hearing impaired: 1-800-232-5952)  
Online  
Additional information and resources are available online at  
www.genuineservice.com.  
U.S. dealer locator by Dealer Name, City/State, or Zip Code  
Owner Guides  
Maintenance Schedules  
Recalls  
Ford Extended Service Plans  
Ford Genuine Accessories  
Service specials and promotions.  
333  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Customer Assistance  
In Canada:  
Mailing address (Ford vehicles)  
Customer Relationship Centre  
Ford Motor Company of Canada, Limited  
P.O. Box 2000  
Oakville, Ontario L6J 5E4  
Telephone  
1-800-565-3673 (FORD)  
Online  
www.ford.ca  
Mailing address (Lincoln vehicles)  
Lincoln Centre  
Ford Motor Company of Canada, Limited  
P.O. Box 2000  
Oakville, Ontario L6J 5E4  
Telephone  
1-800-387-9333  
Online  
www.lincolncanada.com  
Additional assistance  
If you have questions or concerns, or are unsatisfied with the service you  
are receiving, follow these steps:  
1. Contact your Sales Representative or Service Advisor at your  
selling/servicing authorized dealer.  
2. If your inquiry or concern remains unresolved, contact the Sales  
Manager, Service Manager or Customer Relations Manager.  
3. If you require assistance or clarification on Ford Motor Company  
policies, please contact the Ford Customer Relationship Center  
In order to help you serve you better, please have the following  
information available when contacting a Customer Relationship Center:  
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN)  
Your telephone number (home and business)  
The name of the authorized dealer and city where located  
The vehicle’s current odometer reading  
In some states, you must directly notify Ford in writing before pursuing  
remedies under your state’s warranty laws. Ford is also allowed a final  
repair attempt in some states.  
334  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Customer Assistance  
In the United States, a warranty dispute must be submitted to the BBB  
AUTO LINE before taking action under the Magnuson-Moss Warranty  
Act, or to the extent allowed by state law, before pursuing replacement  
or repurchase remedies provided by certain state laws. This dispute  
handling procedure is not required prior to enforcing state created rights  
or other rights which are independent of the Magnuson-Moss Warranty  
Act or state replacement or repurchase laws.  
IN CALIFORNIA (U.S. ONLY)  
California Civil Code Section 1793.2(d) requires that, if a manufacturer  
or its representative is unable to repair a motor vehicle to conform to the  
vehicle’s applicable express warranty after a reasonable number of  
attempts, the manufacturer shall be required to either replace the  
vehicle with one substantially identical or repurchase the vehicle and  
reimburse the buyer in an amount equal to the actual price paid or  
payable by the consumer (less a reasonable allowance for consumer  
use). The consumer has the right to choose whether to receive a refund  
or replacement vehicle.  
California Civil Code Section 1793.22(b) presumes that the manufacturer  
has had a reasonable number of attempts to conform the vehicle to its  
applicable express warranties if, within the first 18 months of ownership  
of a new vehicle or the first 18,000 miles (29,000 km), whichever occurs  
first:  
1. Two or more repair attempts are made on the same non-conformity  
likely to cause death or serious bodily injury OR  
2. Four or more repair attempts are made on the same nonconformity (a  
defect or condition that substantially impairs the use, value or safety of  
the vehicle) OR  
3. The vehicle is out of service for repair of nonconformities for a total of  
more than 30 calendar days (not necessarily all at one time)  
In the case of 1 or 2 above, the consumer must also notify the  
manufacturer of the need for the repair of the nonconformity at the  
following address:  
Ford Motor Company  
16800 Executive Plaza Drive  
Mail Drop 3NE-B  
Dearborn, MI 48126  
335  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Customer Assistance  
THE BETTER BUSINESS BUREAU (BBB) AUTO LINE PROGRAM  
(U.S. ONLY)  
Your satisfaction is important to Ford Motor Company and to your dealer.  
If a warranty concern has not been resolved using the three-step  
procedure outlined on the first page of the Customer Assistance section,  
you may be eligible to participate in the BBB AUTO LINE program.  
The BBB AUTO LINE program consists of two parts – mediation and  
arbitration. During mediation, a representative of the BBB will contact  
both you and Ford Motor Company to explore options for settlement of  
the claim. If an agreement is not reached during mediation and your  
claim is eligible, you may participate in the arbitration process. An  
arbitration hearing will be scheduled so that you can present your case  
in an informal setting before an impartial person. The arbitrator will  
consider the testimony provided and make a decision after the hearing.  
You are not bound by the decision, but should you choose to accept the  
BBB AUTO LINE decision, Ford must abide by the accepted decision as  
well. Disputes submitted to the BBB AUTO LINE program are usually  
decided within forty days after you file your claim with the BBB.  
BBB AUTO LINE Application: Using the information provided below,  
please call or write to request a program application. You will be asked  
for your name and address, general information about your new vehicle,  
information about your warranty concerns, and any steps you have  
already taken to try to resolve them. A Customer Claim Form will be  
mailed that will need to be completed, signed and returned to the BBB  
along with proof of ownership. Upon receipt, the BBB will review the  
claim for eligibility under the Program Summary Guidelines.  
You can get more information by calling BBB AUTO LINE at  
1-800-955-5100, or writing to:  
BBB AUTO LINE  
4200 Wilson Boulevard, Suite 800  
Arlington, Virginia 22203–1833  
BBB AUTO LINE applications can also be requested by calling the Ford  
Motor Company Customer Relationship Center at 1-800-392-3673.  
Note: Ford Motor Company reserves the right to change eligibility  
limitations, modify procedures, or to discontinue this process at any time  
without notice and without obligation.  
336  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Customer Assistance  
UTILIZING THE MEDIATION/ARBITRATION PROGRAM  
(CANADA ONLY)  
For vehicles delivered to authorized Canadian dealers. In those cases  
where you continue to feel that the efforts by Ford of Canada and the  
authorized dealer to resolve a factory-related vehicle service concern  
have been unsatisfactory, Ford of Canada participates in an impartial  
third party mediation/arbitration program administered by the Canadian  
Motor Vehicle Arbitration Plan (CAMVAP).  
The CAMVAP program is a straight-forward and relatively speedy  
alternative to resolve a disagreement when all other efforts to produce a  
settlement have failed. This procedure is without cost to you and is  
designed to eliminate the need for lengthy and expensive legal  
proceedings.  
In the CAMVAP program, impartial third-party arbitrators conduct  
hearings at mutually convenient times and places in an informal  
environment. These impartial arbitrators review the positions of the  
parties, make decisions and, when appropriate, render awards to resolve  
disputes. CAMVAP decisions are fast, fair, and final as the arbitrator’s  
award is binding both to you and Ford of Canada.  
CAMVAP services are available in all territories and provinces. For more  
information, without charge or obligation, call your CAMVAP Provincial  
Administrator directly at 1-800-207-0685.  
GETTING ASSISTANCE OUTSIDE THE U.S. AND CANADA  
Before exporting your vehicle to a foreign country, contact the  
appropriate foreign embassy or consulate. These officials can inform you  
of local vehicle registration regulations and where to find unleaded fuel.  
If you cannot find unleaded fuel or can only get fuel with an anti-knock  
index lower than is recommended for your vehicle, contact a regional  
office or owner relations/customer relationship office.  
The use of leaded fuel in your vehicle without proper conversion may  
damage the effectiveness of your emission control system and may cause  
engine knocking or serious engine damage. Ford Motor Company/Ford of  
Canada is not responsible for any damage caused by use of improper  
fuel. Using leaded fuel may also result in difficulty importing your vehicle  
back into the U.S.  
337  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Customer Assistance  
If your vehicle must be serviced while you are traveling or living in  
Central America, the Caribbean, or the Middle East, contact the nearest  
authorized dealer. If the authorized dealer cannot help you, contact:  
FORD MOTOR COMPANY  
FORD EXPORT OPERATIONS  
1555 Fairlane Drive  
Fairlane Business Park #3  
Allen Park, Michigan 48101  
U.S.A.  
Telephone: (313) 594-4857  
FAX: (313) 390-0804  
If you are in another foreign country, contact the nearest authorized  
dealer. If the authorized dealer employees cannot help you, they can  
direct you to the nearest Ford affiliate office.  
If you buy your vehicle in North America and then relocate outside of  
the U.S. or Canada, register your vehicle identification number (VIN) and  
new address with Ford Motor Company Export Operations.  
Customers in the U.S. should call 1-800-392-3673.  
ORDERING ADDITIONAL OWNER’S LITERATURE  
To order the publications in this portfolio, contact Helm, Incorporated at:  
HELM, INCORPORATED  
P.O. Box 07150  
Detroit, Michigan 48207  
Or to order a free publication catalog, call toll free: 1-800-782-4356  
Monday-Friday 8:00 a.m. - 6:00 p.m. EST  
Helm, Incorporated can also be reached by their website:  
www.helminc.com.  
(Items in this catalog may be purchased by credit card, check or  
money order.)  
Obtaining a French Owner’s Guide  
French Owner’s Guides can be obtained from your authorized dealer or  
by writing to:  
Ford Motor Company of Canada, Limited  
Service Publications CHQ202  
The Canadian Road  
P.O. Box 2000  
Oakville, ON, Canada  
L6J 5E4  
338  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Customer Assistance  
REPORTING SAFETY DEFECTS (U.S. ONLY)  
If you believe that your vehicle has  
a defect which could cause a crash  
or could cause injury or death, you  
should immediately inform the  
National Highway Traffic Safety  
Administration (NHTSA) in addition to notifying Ford Motor Company.  
If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open an investigation, and  
if it finds that a safety defect exists in a group of vehicles, it may order a  
recall and remedy campaign. However, NHTSA cannot become involved  
in individual problems between you, your dealer, or Ford Motor  
Company.  
To contact NHTSA, you may call the Vehicle Safety Hotline toll-free at  
1–888–327–4236 (TTY: 1–800–424–9153); go to http://www.safercar.gov;  
or write to:  
Administrator  
1200 New Jersey Avenue, Southeast  
Washington, D.C. 20590  
You can also obtain other information about motor vehicle safety from  
http://www.safercar.gov.  
REPORTING SAFETY DEFECTS (CANADA ONLY)  
If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which could cause a crash or  
could cause injury or death, you should immediately inform Transport  
Canada, using their toll-free number: 1–800–333–0510.  
339  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cleaning  
WASHING THE EXTERIOR  
Wash your vehicle regularly with cool or lukewarm water and a neutral  
pH shampoo, such as Motorcraft Detail Wash (ZC-3-A), which is available  
from your authorized dealer.  
Never use strong household detergents or soap, such as dish washing  
or laundry liquid. These products can discolor and spot painted  
surfaces.  
Never wash a vehicle that is “hot to the touch” or during exposure to  
strong, direct sunlight.  
Always use a clean sponge or car wash mitt with plenty of water for  
best results.  
Dry the vehicle with a chamois or soft terry cloth towel in order to  
eliminate water spotting.  
It is especially important to wash the vehicle regularly during the  
winter months, as dirt and road salt are difficult to remove and cause  
damage to the vehicle.  
Immediately remove items such as gasoline, diesel fuel, bird droppings  
and insect deposits because they can cause damage to the vehicle’s  
paintwork and trim over time. Use Motorcraft Bug and Tar Remover  
(ZC-42), which is available from your authorized dealer.  
Remove any exterior accessories, such as antennas, before entering a  
car wash.  
Suntan lotions and insect repellents can damage any painted  
surface; if these substances come in contact with your vehicle,  
wash off as soon as possible.  
If your vehicle is equipped with running boards, do not use  
rubber, plastic and vinyl protectant products on the running  
board surface, as the area may become slippery.  
Exterior chrome  
Wash the vehicle first, using cool or lukewarm water and a neutral pH  
shampoo, such as Motorcraft Detail Wash (ZC-3-A).  
Use Motorcraft Custom Bright Metal Cleaner (ZC-15), available from  
your authorized dealer. Apply the product as you would a wax to  
clean bumpers and other chrome parts; allow the cleaner to dry for a  
few minutes, then wipe off the haze with a clean, dry rag.  
Never use abrasive materials such as steel wool or plastic pads  
as they can scratch the chrome surface.  
340  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cleaning  
After polishing chrome bumpers, apply a coating of Motorcraft  
Premium Liquid Wax (ZC-53-A), available from your authorized dealer,  
or an equivalent quality product to help protect from environmental  
effects.  
WAXING  
Wash the vehicle first.  
Do not use waxes that contain abrasives; use Motorcraft Premium  
Liquid Wax (ZC-53-A), which is available from your authorized dealer,  
or an equivalent quality product.  
Do not allow paint sealant to come in contact with any non-body  
(low-gloss black) colored trim, such as grained door handles, roof  
racks, bumpers, side moldings, mirror housings or the windshield cowl  
area. The paint sealant will “gray” or stain the parts over time.  
PAINT CHIPS  
Your authorized dealer has touch-up paint to match your vehicle’s color.  
Take your color code (printed on a sticker in the driver’s door jamb) to  
your authorized dealer to ensure you get the correct color.  
Remove particles such as bird droppings, tree sap, insect deposits, tar  
spots, road salt and industrial fallout before repairing paint chips.  
Always read the instructions before using the products.  
ALUMINUM WHEELS AND WHEEL COVERS  
Aluminum wheels and wheel covers are coated with a clearcoat paint  
finish. In order to maintain their shine:  
Clean weekly with Motorcraft Wheel and Tire Cleaner (ZC-37-A),  
which is available from your authorized dealer. Heavy dirt and brake  
dust accumulation may require agitation with a sponge. Rinse  
thoroughly with a strong stream of water.  
Never apply any cleaning chemical to hot or warm wheel rims or  
covers.  
Some automatic car washes may cause damage to the finish on your  
wheel rims or covers. Chemical-strength cleaners, or cleaning  
chemicals, in combination with brush agitation to remove brake dust  
and dirt, could wear away the clearcoat finish over time.  
Do not use hydrofluoric acid-based or high caustic-based wheel  
cleaners, steel wool, fuels or strong household detergent.  
To remove tar and grease, use Motorcraft Bug and Tar Remover  
(ZC-42), available from your authorized dealer.  
341  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cleaning  
ENGINE  
Engines are more efficient when they are clean because grease and dirt  
buildup keep the engine warmer than normal. When washing:  
Take care when using a power washer to clean the engine. The high  
pressure fluid could penetrate the sealed parts and cause damage.  
Do not spray a hot engine with cold water to avoid cracking the  
engine block or other engine components.  
Spray Motorcraft Engine Shampoo and Degreaser (ZC-20) on all parts  
that require cleaning and pressure rinse clean. In Canada use  
Motorcraft Engine Shampoo (CXC-66-A).  
Cover the highlighted areas to prevent water damage when cleaning  
the engine.  
Never wash or rinse the engine while it is running; water in the  
running engine may cause internal damage.  
Never wash or rinse any ignition coil, spark plug wire or spark plug  
well, or the area in and around these locations.  
4.0L V6 ENGINE  
342  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cleaning  
4.6L V8 ENGINE  
PLASTIC (NON-PAINTED) EXTERIOR PARTS  
Use only approved products to clean plastic parts. These products are  
available from your authorized dealer.  
For routine cleaning, use Motorcraft Detail Wash (ZC-3-A).  
If tar or grease spots are present, use Motorcraft Bug and Tar  
Remover (ZC-42).  
WINDOWS AND WIPER BLADES  
The windshield, rear and side windows and the wiper blades should be  
cleaned regularly. If the wipers do not wipe properly, substances on the  
vehicle’s glass or the wiper blades may be the cause. These may include  
hot wax treatments used by commercial car washes, water repellent  
coatings, tree sap, or other organic contamination; these contaminants  
may cause squeaking or chatter noise from the blades, and streaking and  
smearing of the windshield. To clean these items, follow these tips:  
The windshield, rear windows and side windows may be cleaned with  
a non-abrasive cleaner such as Motorcraft Ultra-Clear Spray Glass  
Cleaner (ZC-23), available from your authorized dealer.  
343  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cleaning  
The wiper blades can be cleaned with isopropyl (rubbing) alcohol or  
Motorcraft Premium Windshield Washer Concentrate (ZC-32-A),  
available from your authorized dealer. This washer fluid contains  
special solution in addition to alcohol which helps to remove the hot  
wax deposited on the wiper blade and windshield from automated car  
wash facilities. Be sure to replace wiper blades when they appear  
worn or do not function properly.  
Do not use abrasives, as they may cause scratches.  
Do not use fuel, kerosene, or paint thinner to clean any parts.  
If you cannot remove those streaks after cleaning with the glass cleaner  
or if the wipers chatter and move in a jerky motion, clean the outer  
surface of the windshield and the wiper blades using a sponge or soft  
cloth with a neutral detergent or mild-abrasive cleaning solution. After  
cleaning, rinse the windshield and wiper blades with clean water. The  
windshield is clean if beads do not form when you rinse the windshield  
with water.  
Do not use sharp objects, such as a razor blade, to clean the  
inside of the rear window or to remove decals, as it may cause  
damage to the rear window defroster’s heated grid lines.  
INSTRUMENT PANEL/INTERIOR TRIM AND CLUSTER LENS  
Clean the instrument panel, interior trim areas and cluster lens with a  
clean, damp, white cotton cloth, then use a clean and dry white cotton  
cloth to dry these areas.  
Avoid cleaners or polishes that increase the gloss of the upper portion  
of the instrument panel. The dull finish in this area helps protect the  
driver from undesirable windshield reflection.  
Be certain to wash or wipe your hands clean if you have been in  
contact with certain products such as insect repellent and suntan  
lotion in order to avoid possible damage to the interior painted  
surfaces.  
Do not use household or glass cleaners as these may damage the  
finish of the instrument panel, interior trim and cluster lens.  
WARNING: Do not use chemical solvents or strong detergents  
when cleaning the steering wheel or instrument panel to avoid  
contamination of the airbag system.  
344  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cleaning  
If a staining liquid like coffee/juice has been spilled on the instrument  
panel or on interior trim surfaces, clean as follows:  
1. Wipe up spilled liquid using a clean, white, cotton cloth.  
2. Wipe the surface with a damp, clean, white cotton cloth. For more  
thorough cleaning, use a mild soap and water solution. If the spot cannot  
be completely cleaned by this method, the area may be cleaned using a  
commercially available cleaning product designed for automotive  
interiors.  
3. If necessary, apply more soap and water solution or cleaning product  
to a clean, white, cotton cloth and press the cloth onto the soiled  
area–allow this to set at room temperature for 30 minutes.  
4. Remove the soaked cloth, and if it is not soiled badly, use this cloth to  
clean the area by using a rubbing motion for 60 seconds.  
5. Following this, wipe area dry with a clean, white, cotton cloth.  
INTERIOR  
For fabric, carpets, cloth seats, safety belts and seats equipped with side  
airbags:  
Remove dust and loose dirt with a vacuum cleaner.  
Remove light stains and soil with Motorcraft Professional Strength  
Carpet & Upholstery Cleaner (ZC-54).  
If grease or tar is present on the material, spot-clean the area first  
with Motorcraft Spot and Stain Remover (ZC-14). In Canada, use  
Motorcraft Multi-Purpose Cleaner (CXC-101).  
If a ring forms on the fabric after spot cleaning, clean the entire area  
immediately (but do not oversaturate) or the ring will set.  
Do not use household cleaning products or glass cleaners, which can  
stain and discolor the fabric and affect the flame retardant abilities of  
the seat materials.  
WARNING: Do not use cleaning solvents, bleach or dye on the  
vehicle’s safety belts, as these actions may weaken the belt  
webbing.  
WARNING: On vehicles equipped with seat-mounted airbags, do  
not use chemical solvents or strong detergents. Such products  
could contaminate the side-airbag system and affect performance of  
the side airbag in a collision.  
345  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cleaning  
LEATHER SEATS (IF EQUIPPED)  
Your leather seating surfaces have a clear, protective coating over the  
leather.  
For routine cleaning, wipe the surface with a soft, damp cloth. For  
more thorough cleaning, wipe the surface with a mild soap and water  
solution. In Canada, use Motorcraft Vinyl Cleaner (CXC-93). Dry the  
area with a soft cloth.  
If the leather cannot be completely cleaned using a mild soap and  
water solution, the leather may be cleaned using a commercially  
available cleaning product designed for automotive leather.  
Do not use household cleaning products, alcohol solutions, solvents or  
cleaners intended for rubber, vinyl and plastics, or oil/petroleum-based  
leather conditioners. These products may cause premature wearing of  
the clear, protective coating.  
Note: In some instances, color or dye transfer can occur when wet  
clothing comes in contact with leather upholstery. If this occurs, the  
leather should be cleaned immediately to avoid permanent staining.  
UNDERBODY  
Flush the complete underside of your vehicle frequently. Keep body and  
door drain holes free from packed dirt.  
FORD AND LINCOLN MERCURY CAR CARE PRODUCTS  
Your Ford or Lincoln Mercury authorized dealer has many quality  
products available to clean your vehicle and protect its finishes. These  
quality products have been specifically engineered to fulfill your  
automotive needs; they are custom designed to complement the style  
and appearance of your vehicle. Each product is made from high quality  
materials that meet or exceed rigid specifications. For best results, use  
the following products or products of equivalent quality:  
Motorcraft Bug and Tar Remover (ZC-42)  
Motorcraft Custom Bright Metal Cleaner (ZC-15)  
Motorcraft Custom Clear Coat Polish (ZC-8-A)  
Motorcraft Detail Wash (ZC-3-A)  
Motorcraft Dusting Cloth (ZC-24)  
Motorcraft Engine Shampoo and Degreaser (U.S. only) (ZC-20)  
Motorcraft Engine Shampoo (Canada only) (CXC-66-A)  
Motorcraft Multi-Purpose Cleaner (Canada only) (CXC-101)  
346  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Cleaning  
Motorcraft Premium Glass Cleaner (Canada only) (CXC-100)  
Motorcraft Premium Liquid Wax (ZC-53-A)  
Motorcraft Premium Windshield Washer Concentrate (U.S. only)  
(ZC-32-A)  
Motorcraft Professional Strength Carpet & Upholstery Cleaner (ZC-54)  
Motorcraft Spot and Stain Remover (U.S. only) (ZC-14)  
Motorcraft Tire Clean and Shine (ZC-28)  
Motorcraft Ultra-Clear Spray Glass Cleaner (ZC-23)  
Motorcraft Vinyl Cleaner (Canada only) (CXC-93)  
Motorcraft Wheel and Tire Cleaner (ZC-37-A)  
347  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
SERVICE RECOMMENDATIONS  
Use the scheduled maintenance information to track routine  
service.  
Use only recommended fuels, lubricants, fluids and service parts  
conforming to specifications.  
Your authorized dealer can provide parts and service.  
PRECAUTIONS WHEN SERVICING YOUR VEHICLE  
Do not work on a hot engine.  
Make sure that nothing gets caught in moving parts.  
Do not work on a vehicle with the engine running in an enclosed  
space, unless you are sure you have enough ventilation.  
Keep all open flames and other lit material away from the battery and  
all fuel related parts.  
WARNING: Turn off the power running boards, if equipped,  
before working under the vehicle, jacking or placing any object  
under the vehicle. Never place your hand between the extended  
running board and the vehicle. A moving running board may cause  
injury.  
Working with the engine off  
1. Set the parking brake and ensure the gearshift is securely latched in P  
(Park).  
2. Turn off the engine and remove the key.  
3. Block the wheels to prevent the vehicle from moving unexpectedly.  
348  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
Working with the engine on  
1. Set the parking brake and shift to P (Park).  
2. Block the wheels.  
WARNING: To reduce the risk of vehicle damage and/or  
personal burn injuries, do not start your engine with the air  
cleaner removed and do not remove it while the engine is running.  
OPENING THE HOOD  
1. Inside the vehicle, pull the hood  
release handle located under the  
bottom left corner of the instrument  
panel.  
2. Go to the front of the vehicle and  
release the auxiliary latch that is  
located under the front center of  
the hood.  
3. Lift the hood.  
349  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
IDENTIFYING COMPONENTS IN THE ENGINE COMPARTMENT  
4.0L V6 engine  
1. Engine oil filler cap  
2. Engine oil dipstick (out of view)  
3. Brake fluid reservoir  
4. Power distribution box  
5. Battery  
6. Power steering fluid reservoir  
7. Radiator cap  
8. Engine coolant reservoir  
9. Air filter assembly  
10. Washer fluid reservoir  
350  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
4.6L V8 engine  
1. Air filter assembly  
2. Engine oil filler cap  
3. Engine oil dipstick  
4. Brake fluid reservoir  
5. Power distribution box  
6. Battery  
7. Power steering fluid reservoir  
8. Radiator cap  
9. Engine coolant reservoir  
10. Windshield washer fluid reservoir  
351  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
WINDSHIELD WASHER FLUID  
Add fluid to fill the reservoir if the  
level is low. In very cold weather, do  
not fill the reservoir completely.  
Only use a washer fluid that meets Ford specification WSB-M8B16–A2.  
Do not use any special washer fluid such as windshield water repellent  
type fluid or bug wash. They may cause squeaking, chatter noise,  
streaking and smearing. Refer to the Maintenance product  
specifications and capacities section in this chapter.  
State or local regulations on volatile organic compounds may restrict the  
use of methanol, a common windshield washer antifreeze additive.  
Washer fluids containing non-methanol antifreeze agents should be used  
only if they provide cold weather protection without damaging the  
vehicle’s paint finish, wiper blades or washer system.  
WARNING: If you operate your vehicle in temperatures below  
40°F (5°C), use washer fluid with antifreeze protection. Failure  
to use washer fluid with antifreeze protection in cold weather could  
result in impaired windshield vision and increase the risk of injury or  
accident.  
Do not put washer fluid in the engine coolant reservoir. Washer  
fluid placed in the cooling system may harm engine and cooling  
system components.  
Checking and adding washer fluid for the liftgate  
Washer fluid for the liftgate is supplied by the same reservoir as the  
windshield.  
352  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
CHANGING THE WIPER BLADES  
1. Pull the wiper arm away from the  
vehicle. Turn the blade at an angle  
from the wiper arm. Push the lock  
pin manually to release the blade  
and pull the wiper blade down  
toward the windshield to remove it  
from the arm.  
2. Attach the new wiper to the  
wiper arm and press it into place  
until a click is heard.  
Replace wiper blades at least once  
per year for optimum performance.  
Poor wiper quality can be improved  
by cleaning the wiper blades and  
the windshield. Refer to Windows  
and wiper blades in the Cleaning chapter.  
To prolong the life of the wiper blades, it is highly recommended to  
scrape off the ice on the windshield before turning on the wipers. The  
layer of ice has many sharp edges and can damage the micro edge of the  
wiper rubber element.  
Changing the rear window wiper blade  
To replace the rear wiper blade:  
1. Pull the wiper arm as far away from the glass as possible. Do not use  
excessive force because it can break the wiper arm. Hold it there until  
the next step.  
2. Grasp the wiper blade and rotate  
it away from the wiper arm using  
moderate force until it disengages  
from the wiper arm.  
3. Once the wiper blade is loose,  
slide it away from the wiper arm.  
353  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
4. To attach the new wiper to the  
wiper arm, align the cross pin and  
keyway (denoted with the arrows)  
and firmly press the wiper blade  
into the wiper arm until an audible  
snap is heard.  
ENGINE OIL  
Checking the engine oil  
Refer to the scheduled maintenance information for the appropriate  
intervals for checking the engine oil.  
1. Make sure the vehicle is on level ground.  
2. Turn the engine off and wait 15 minutes for the oil to drain into the  
oil pan.  
3. Set the parking brake and ensure the gearshift is securely latched in P  
(Park).  
4. Open the hood. Protect yourself from engine heat.  
5. Locate and carefully remove the engine oil level dipstick.  
4.0L V6 engine  
354  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
4.6L V8 engine  
6. Wipe the dipstick clean. Insert the dipstick fully, then remove it again.  
If the oil level is between the lower and upper holes, the oil level  
is acceptable, DO NOT ADD OIL.  
If the oil level is below the lower hole, add enough oil to raise the  
level within the lower and upper holes.  
4.0L V6 engine  
355  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
4.6L V8 engine  
Oil levels above the upper hole may cause engine damage. Some oil  
must be removed from the engine by an authorized dealer.  
7. Put the dipstick back in and ensure it is fully seated.  
Adding engine oil  
1. Check the engine oil. For instructions, refer to Checking the engine  
oil in this chapter.  
2. If the engine oil level is not within the normal range, add only certified  
engine oil of the recommended viscosity. Remove the engine oil filler cap  
and use a funnel to pour the engine oil into the opening.  
3. Recheck the engine oil level. Make sure the oil level is not above the  
upper hole on the engine oil level dipstick.  
4. Install the dipstick and ensure it is fully seated.  
5. Fully install the engine oil filler cap by turning the filler cap clockwise  
until three clicks can be heard.  
To avoid possible oil loss, DO NOT operate the vehicle with the  
engine oil level dipstick and/or the engine oil filler cap removed.  
356  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
Engine Oil Recommendations  
4.0L V6 Engine  
Look for this certification  
trademark.  
Use SAE 5W-30 engine oil  
Only use oils “Certified For Gasoline Engines” by the American  
Petroleum Institute (API). An oil with this trademark symbol conforms  
to the current engine and emission system protection standards and fuel  
economy requirements of the International Lubricant Standardization and  
Approval Committee (ILSAC), comprised of U.S. and Japanese  
automobile manufacturers.  
To protect your engine and engine’s warranty, use Motorcraft SAE 5W-30  
or an equivalent SAE 5W-30 oil meeting Ford specification  
WSS-M2C929-A. Refer to Maintenance product specifications and  
capacities later in this section for more information.  
Do not use supplemental engine oil additives, cleaners or other engine  
treatments. They are unnecessary and could lead to engine damage that  
is not covered by Ford warranty.  
Change your engine oil according to the appropriate schedule listed in  
the scheduled maintenance information.  
Ford production and Motorcraft replacement oil filters are designed for  
added engine protection and long life. If a replacement oil filter is used  
that does not meet Ford material and design specifications, start-up  
engine noises or knock may be experienced.  
It is recommended you use the appropriate Motorcraft oil filter or  
another with equivalent performance for your engine application.  
357  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
4.6L 3V V8 Engine  
Look for this certification  
trademark.  
Use SAE 5W-20 engine oil  
Only use oils “Certified For Gasoline Engines” by the American  
Petroleum Institute (API). An oil with this trademark symbol conforms  
to the current engine and emission system protection standards and fuel  
economy requirements of the International Lubricant Standardization and  
Approval Committee (ILSAC), comprised of U.S. and Japanese  
automobile manufacturers.  
To protect your engine and engine’s warranty, use Motorcraft SAE 5W-20  
or an equivalent SAE 5W-20 oil meeting Ford specification  
WSS-M2C930-A. SAE 5W-20 oil provides optimum fuel economy and  
durability performance meeting all requirements for your  
vehicle’s engine. Refer to Maintenance product specifications and  
capacities later in this section for more information.  
Do not use supplemental engine oil additives, cleaners or other engine  
treatments. They are unnecessary and could lead to engine damage that  
is not covered by Ford warranty.  
Change your engine oil according to the appropriate schedule listed in  
the scheduled maintenance information.  
Ford production and Motorcraft replacement oil filters are designed for  
added engine protection and long life. If a replacement oil filter is used  
that does not meet Ford material and design specifications, start-up  
engine noises or knock may be experienced.  
It is recommended you use the appropriate Motorcraft oil filter or  
another with equivalent performance for your engine application.  
358  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
BATTERY  
Your vehicle is equipped with a  
Motorcraft maintenance-free battery  
which normally does not require  
additional water during its life of  
service.  
If your battery has a cover/shield, make sure it is reinstalled  
after the battery has been cleaned or replaced.  
For longer, trouble-free operation, keep the top of the battery clean and  
dry. Also, make certain the battery cables are always tightly fastened to  
the battery terminals.  
If you see any corrosion on the battery or terminals, remove the cables  
from the terminals and clean with a wire brush. You can neutralize the  
acid with a solution of baking soda and water.  
It is recommended that the negative battery cable terminal be  
disconnected from the battery if you plan to store your vehicle for an  
extended period of time. This will minimize the discharge of your battery  
during storage.  
Note: Electrical or electronic accessories or components added to  
the vehicle by the dealer or the owner may adversely affect  
battery performance and durability.  
WARNING: Batteries normally produce explosive gases which  
can cause personal injury. Therefore, do not allow flames, sparks  
or lighted substances to come near the battery. When working near the  
battery, always shield your face and protect your eyes. Always provide  
proper ventilation.  
WARNING: When lifting a plastic-cased battery, excessive  
pressure on the end walls could cause acid to flow through the  
vent caps, resulting in personal injury and/or damage to the vehicle or  
battery. Lift the battery with a battery carrier or with your hands on  
opposite corners.  
359  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
WARNING: Keep batteries out of reach of children. Batteries  
contain sulfuric acid. Avoid contact with skin, eyes or clothing.  
Shield your eyes when working near the battery to protect against  
possible splashing of acid solution. In case of acid contact with skin or  
eyes, flush immediately with water for a minimum of 15 minutes and  
get prompt medical attention. If acid is swallowed, call a physician  
immediately.  
WARNING: Battery posts, terminals and related accessories  
contain lead and lead compounds. Wash hands after handling.  
Because your vehicle’s engine is electronically controlled by a computer,  
some control conditions are maintained by power from the battery. When  
the battery is disconnected or a new battery is installed, the engine must  
relearn its idle and fuel trim strategy for optimum driveability and  
performance. To begin this process:  
1. With the vehicle at a complete stop, set the parking brake.  
2. Put the gearshift lever in P (Park), turn off all accessories and start  
the engine.  
3. Run the engine until it reaches normal operating temperature.  
4. Allow the engine to idle for at least one minute.  
5. Turn the A/C on and allow the engine to idle for at least one minute.  
6. Drive the vehicle to complete the relearning process.  
The vehicle may need to be driven to relearn the idle and fuel trim  
strategy.  
If you do not allow the engine to relearn its idle trim, the idle  
quality of your vehicle may be adversely affected until the idle  
trim is eventually relearned.  
When the battery is disconnected or a new battery installed, the  
transmission must relearn its adaptive strategy. As a result of this, the  
transmission may shift firmly. This operation is considered normal and  
will not affect function or durability of the transmission. Over time the  
adaptive learning process will fully update transmission operation to its  
optimum shift feel.  
If the battery has been disconnected or a new battery has been installed,  
the clock and the preset radio stations must be reset once the battery is  
reconnected.  
360  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
Always dispose of automotive  
batteries in a responsible manner.  
Follow your local authorized  
standards for disposal. Call your  
local authorized recycling center  
to find out more about recycling  
automotive batteries.  
RECYCLE  
ENGINE COOLANT  
Checking engine coolant  
The concentration and level of engine coolant should be checked at the  
intervals listed in scheduled maintenance information. The coolant  
concentration should be maintained at 50/50 coolant and distilled water,  
which equates to a freeze point of -34°F (-36°C). Coolant concentration  
testing is possible with a hydrometer or antifreeze tester. The level of  
coolant should be maintained at the FULL COLD level in the coolant  
reservoir. If the level falls below, add coolant per the instructions in the  
Adding engine coolant section.  
Your vehicle was factory-filled with a 50/50 engine coolant and water  
concentration. If the concentration of coolant falls below 40% or above  
60%, the engine parts could become damaged or not work properly. A  
50/50 mixture of coolant and water provides the following:  
Freeze protection down to -34°F (-36°C).  
Boiling protection up to 265°F (129°C).  
Protection against rust and other forms of corrosion.  
Enables calibrated gauges to work properly.  
When the engine is cold, check the level of the engine coolant in the  
reservoir.  
361  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
4.0L V6 engine  
4.6L V8 engine  
The engine coolant should be at the FULL COLD level or within the  
COLD FILL RANGE as listed on the engine coolant reservoir  
(depending upon application).  
Refer to scheduled maintenance information for service interval  
schedules.  
Be sure to read and understand Precautions when servicing your  
vehicle in this chapter.  
If the engine coolant has not been checked at the recommended interval,  
the engine coolant reservoir may become low or empty. If the reservoir is  
low or empty, add engine coolant to the reservoir. Refer to Adding  
engine coolant in this chapter.  
Note: Automotive fluids are not interchangeable; do not use engine  
coolant, antifreeze or windshield washer fluid outside of its specified  
function and vehicle location.  
362  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
Adding engine coolant  
When adding coolant, make sure it is a 50/50 mixture of engine coolant  
and distilled water. Add the mixture to the coolant reservoir, when the  
engine is cool, until the appropriate fill level is obtained.  
WARNING: Do not add engine coolant when the engine is hot.  
Steam and scalding liquids released from a hot cooling system  
can burn you badly. Also, you can be burned if you spill coolant on hot  
engine parts.  
WARNING: Do not put engine coolant in the windshield washer  
fluid container. If sprayed on the windshield, engine coolant  
could make it difficult to see through the windshield.  
Do not mix coolants. Add the coolant type originally equipped  
in your vehicle. Refer to Maintenance product specifications and  
capacities in this chapter.  
Note: Do not use stop leak pellets or cooling system sealants/additives  
as they can cause damage to the engine cooling and/or heating systems.  
This damage would not be covered under your vehicle’s warranty.  
A large amount of water without engine coolant may be added, in case  
of emergency, to reach a vehicle service location. In this instance, the  
cooling system must be drained and refilled with a 50/50 mixture of  
engine coolant and distilled water as soon as possible. Water alone  
(without engine coolant) can cause engine damage from corrosion,  
overheating or freezing.  
Do not use alcohol, methanol, brine or any engine coolants  
mixed with alcohol or methanol antifreeze (coolant). Alcohol  
and other liquids can cause engine damage from overheating or  
freezing.  
Do not add extra inhibitors or additives to the coolant. These  
can be harmful and compromise the corrosion protection of the engine  
coolant.  
For vehicles with overflow coolant systems with a non-pressurized cap  
on the coolant recovery system, add coolant to the coolant recovery  
reservoir when the engine is cool. Add the proper mixture of coolant and  
water to the FULL COLD level. For all other vehicles which have a  
coolant degas system with a pressurized cap, or if it is necessary to  
remove the coolant pressure relief cap on the radiator of a vehicle with  
an overflow system, follow these steps to add engine coolant.  
363  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
WARNING: To reduce the risk of personal injury, make sure the  
engine is cool before unscrewing the coolant pressure relief cap.  
The cooling system is under pressure; steam and hot liquid can come  
out forcefully when the cap is loosened slightly.  
Add the proper mixture of coolant and water to the cooling system by  
following these steps:  
1. Before you begin, turn the engine off and let it cool.  
2. When the engine is cool, wrap a thick cloth around the coolant  
pressure relief cap on the coolant reservoir (a translucent plastic bottle).  
Slowly turn cap counterclockwise (left) until pressure begins to release.  
3. Step back while the pressure releases.  
4. When you are sure that all the pressure has been released, use the  
cloth to turn it counterclockwise and remove the cap.  
5. Fill the coolant reservoir slowly with the proper coolant mixture, to  
within the COLD FILL RANGE or the FULL COLD level on the reservoir.  
If you removed the radiator cap in an overflow system, fill the radiator  
until the coolant is visible and radiator is almost full.  
6. Replace the cap. Turn until tightly installed. Cap must be tightly  
installed to prevent coolant loss.  
After any coolant has been added, check the coolant concentration (refer  
to Checking engine coolant). If the concentration is not 50/50  
(protection to –34°F/–36°C), drain some coolant and adjust the  
concentration. It may take several drains and additions to obtain a 50/50  
coolant concentration.  
Whenever coolant has been added, the coolant level in the coolant  
reservoir should be checked the next few times you drive the vehicle. If  
necessary, add enough 50/50 concentration of engine coolant and  
distilled water to bring the liquid level to the proper level.  
If you have to add more than 1.0 quart (1.0 liter) of engine coolant per  
month, have your authorized dealer check the engine cooling system.  
Your cooling system may have a leak. Operating an engine with a low  
level of coolant can result in engine overheating and possible engine  
damage.  
Recycled engine coolant  
Ford Motor Company does NOT recommend the use of recycled engine  
coolant since a Ford-approved recycling process is not yet available.  
364  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
Used engine coolant should be disposed of in an appropriate  
manner. Follow your community’s regulations and standards for recycling  
and disposing of automotive fluids.  
Coolant refill capacity  
To find out how much fluid your vehicle’s cooling system can hold, refer  
to Maintenance product specifications and capacities in this chapter.  
Fill your engine coolant reservoir as outlined in Adding engine coolant  
in this section.  
Severe climates  
If you drive in extremely cold climates (less than –34°F [–36°C]):  
It may be necessary to increase the coolant concentration  
above 50%.  
NEVER increase the coolant concentration above 60%.  
Increased engine coolant concentrations above 60% will  
decrease the overheat protection characteristics of the engine  
coolant and may cause engine damage.  
Refer to the chart on the coolant container to ensure the  
coolant concentration in your vehicle will provide adequate  
freeze protection at the temperatures in which you drive in the  
winter months.  
If you drive in extremely hot climates:  
It is still necessary to maintain the coolant concentration  
above 40%.  
NEVER decrease the coolant concentration below 40%.  
Decreased engine coolant concentrations below 40% will  
decrease the corrosion protection characteristics of the engine  
coolant and may cause engine damage.  
Decreased engine coolant concentrations below 40% will  
decrease the freeze protection characteristics of the engine  
coolant and may cause engine damage.  
Refer to the chart on the coolant container to ensure the  
coolant concentration in your vehicle will provide adequate  
protection at the temperatures in which you drive.  
Vehicles driven year-round in non-extreme climates should use a 50/50  
mixture of engine coolant and distilled water for optimum cooling system  
and engine protection.  
365  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
What you should know about fail-safe cooling  
(4.6L V8 engine only)  
If the engine coolant supply is depleted, this feature allows the vehicle to  
be driven temporarily before incremental component damage is incurred.  
The “fail-safe” distance depends on ambient temperatures, vehicle load  
and terrain.  
Fail-safe cooling and engine oil overheat mode (4.6L V8 only)  
If the engine coolant and/or engine oil overheat, the vehicle’s fail-safe  
modes will reduce engine power to limit engine damage, even with a  
total loss of coolant. The vehicle’s range and/or speed will be reduced,  
depending on vehicle load, terrain, and outside temperatures.  
The instrument cluster provides warnings for each mode.  
Fail-Safe Cooling Mode: The  
(Service engine  
(Engine oil pressure), and (Engine coolant  
soon),  
temperature) indicators will be on.  
Along with these warning indicators, the engine coolant temperature  
gauge will read in the Hot (H) area.  
If the engine coolant reaches even hotter temperatures, fail-safe  
cooling mode limits engine power more and disables air conditioning.  
The engine will switch to alternating cylinder operation to help cool  
the engine. The engine will run rough in this mode.  
If continued operation increases the engine coolant temperature to a  
critical range, the engine will shut down. Steering and braking effort  
will increase. Once engine coolant temperature cools, the engine can  
be restarted.  
Engine Oil Overheat Mode: The  
(Engine coolant temperature)  
indicator will be on. The instrument cluster has no separate oil  
temperature indicator.  
Along with the  
(Engine coolant temperature) indicator, the engine  
coolant temperature gauge will read in the Hot (H) area.  
Oil overheat can be triggered in severe driving conditions, such as  
towing heavy loads over mountainous terrain in extreme hot  
temperatures. As oil temperature increases, engine and vehicle speed  
will be limited. The transmission will also shift differently.  
When the engine oil has cooled, the vehicle will perform normally.  
366  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
When fail-safe cooling mode is activated  
You have limited engine power when in the fail-safe mode, so drive the  
vehicle with caution. Remember that the engine is capable of completely  
shutting down automatically to prevent engine damage, therefore:  
1. Pull off the road as soon as safely possible and turn off the engine.  
2. Arrange for the vehicle to be taken to an authorized dealer.  
3. If this is not possible, wait approximately 15 minutes for the engine to  
cool.  
4. Check the coolant level and replenish if low. Look for coolant leakage  
in the engine compartment and under the vehicle.  
WARNING: Never remove the coolant reservoir cap while the  
engine is running or hot.  
5. Restart the engine and take your vehicle to an authorized dealer.  
Driving the vehicle without repairing the engine problem  
increases the chance of engine damage. Take your vehicle to an  
authorized dealer as soon as possible.  
FUEL FILTER  
For fuel filter replacement, see your authorized dealer. Refer to  
scheduled maintenance information for the appropriate intervals for  
changing the fuel filter.  
Replace the fuel filter with an authorized Motorcraft part. The  
customer warranty may be void for any damage to the fuel system  
if an authorized Motorcraft fuel filter is not used.  
WHAT YOU SHOULD KNOW ABOUT AUTOMOTIVE FUELS  
Important safety precautions  
WARNING: Do not overfill the fuel tank. The pressure in an  
overfilled tank may cause leakage and lead to fuel spray and fire.  
WARNING: The fuel system may be under pressure. If you hear  
a hissing sound near the fuel filler door (Easy Fuel™ “no cap”  
fuel system), do not refuel until the sound stops. Otherwise, fuel may  
spray out, which could cause serious personal injury.  
367  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
WARNING: Automotive fuels can cause serious injury or death  
if misused or mishandled.  
WARNING: Gasoline may contain benzene, which is a  
cancer-causing agent.  
Observe the following guidelines when handling automotive fuel:  
Extinguish all smoking materials  
and any open flames before  
refueling your vehicle.  
Always turn off the vehicle before  
refueling.  
Automotive fuels can be harmful  
or fatal if swallowed. Fuel such as gasoline is highly toxic and if  
swallowed can cause death or permanent injury. If fuel is swallowed,  
call a physician immediately, even if no symptoms are immediately  
apparent. The toxic effects of fuel may not be visible for hours.  
Avoid inhaling fuel vapors. Inhaling too much fuel vapor of any kind  
can lead to eye and respiratory tract irritation. In severe cases,  
excessive or prolonged breathing of fuel vapor can cause serious  
illness and permanent injury.  
Avoid getting fuel liquid in your eyes. If fuel is splashed in the eyes,  
remove contact lenses (if worn), flush with water for 15 minutes and  
seek medical attention. Failure to seek proper medical attention could  
lead to permanent injury.  
Fuels can also be harmful if absorbed through the skin. If fuel is  
splashed on the skin and/or clothing, promptly remove contaminated  
clothing and wash skin thoroughly with soap and water. Repeated or  
prolonged skin contact with fuel liquid or vapor causes skin irritation.  
Be particularly careful if you are taking “Antabuse” or other forms of  
disulfiram for the treatment of alcoholism. Breathing gasoline vapors,  
or skin contact could cause an adverse reaction. In sensitive  
individuals, serious personal injury or sickness may result. If fuel is  
splashed on the skin, promptly wash skin thoroughly with soap and  
water. Consult a physician immediately if you experience an adverse  
reaction.  
368  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
WARNING: When refueling always shut the engine off and  
never allow sparks or open flames near the filler neck. Never  
smoke while refueling. Fuel vapor is extremely hazardous under certain  
conditions. Care should be taken to avoid inhaling excess fumes.  
WARNING: The flow of fuel through a fuel pump nozzle can  
produce static electricity, which can cause a fire if fuel is  
pumped into an ungrounded fuel container.  
Refueling  
WARNING: Fuel vapor burns violently and a fuel fire can cause  
severe injuries. To help avoid injuries to you and others:  
Read and follow all the instructions on the pump island;  
Turn off your engine when you are refueling;  
Do not smoke if you are near fuel or refueling your vehicle;  
Keep sparks, flames and smoking materials away from fuel;  
Stay outside your vehicle and do not leave the fuel pump unattended  
when refueling your vehicle — this is against the law in some places;  
Keep children away from the fuel pump; never let children pump  
fuel.  
Use the following guidelines to avoid electrostatic charge build-up when  
filling an ungrounded fuel container:  
Place approved fuel container on the ground.  
DO NOT fill a fuel container while it is in the vehicle (including the  
cargo area).  
Keep the fuel pump nozzle in contact with the fuel container while  
filling.  
DO NOT use a device that would hold the fuel pump handle in the fill  
position.  
369  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
Easy Fuel™ “no cap” fuel system  
Your fuel tank is equipped with an Easy Fuel™ “no cap” fuel filler  
system. This allows you to simply open the fuel filler door and insert the  
fuel filler nozzle into the fuel system. The Easy Fuel™ system is  
self-sealing and protected against dust, dirt, water and snow/ice.  
When fueling your vehicle:  
1. Turn the engine off.  
2. Open the fuel filler door.  
3. Slowly insert the fuel filler nozzle fully into the fuel system. Pump fuel  
as normal.  
4. After you are done pumping fuel, slowly remove the fuel filler  
nozzle—allow about five seconds after pumping fuel before removing the  
fuel filler nozzle. This allows residual fuel to drain back into the fuel tank  
and not spill onto the vehicle.  
Note: A fuel spillage concern may occur if overfilling the fuel tank. Do  
not overfill the tank to the point that the fuel is able to bypass the fuel  
filler nozzle. The overfilled fuel may run down the drain located within  
the fuel filler housing and to the ground.  
If the Check Fuel Fill Inlet lamp or Check Fuel Fill Inlet message comes  
on, the fuel fill inlet may not have properly closed. The inlet may have  
stuck open or debris may be preventing the inlet from fully closing. At  
the next opportunity, safely pull off the road, turn off the engine, open  
the fuel filler door and remove any visible debris from the fuel fill  
opening. Insert either the fuel fill nozzle or the fuel fill funnel (see  
Refilling with a portable fuel container for funnel location) provided  
with the vehicle several times to dislodge any debris and/or allow the  
inlet to close properly. If this action corrects the problem, the Check  
Fuel Fill Inlet lamp or Check Fuel Fill Inlet message may not reset  
immediately. It may take several driving cycles for the Check Fuel Fill  
Inlet lamp or Check Fuel Fill Inlet message to turn off. A driving cycle  
consists of an engine start-up (after four or more hours with the engine  
off) followed by city/highway driving. Continuing to drive with the Check  
Fuel Fill Inlet lamp or Check Fuel Fill Inlet message on may cause the  
Service Engine Soon lamp to turn on as well.  
370  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
WARNING: The fuel system may be under pressure. If you hear  
a hissing sound near the fuel filler door (Easy Fuel™ “no cap”  
fuel system), do not refuel until the sound stops. Otherwise, fuel may  
spray out, which could cause serious personal injury.  
Choosing the right fuel  
Use only UNLEADED fuel or UNLEADED fuel blended with a maximum  
of 10% ethanol. Do not use fuel ethanol (E85), diesel, methanol, leaded  
fuel or any other fuel. The use of leaded fuel is prohibited by law and  
could damage your vehicle.  
Your vehicle was not designed to use fuel or fuel additives with metallic  
compounds, including manganese-based additives.  
Note: Use of any fuel other than those recommended may cause  
powertrain damage, a loss of vehicle performance, and repairs may not  
be covered under warranty.  
Octane recommendations  
Your vehicle is designed to use  
“Regular” unleaded gasoline with a  
pump (R+M)/2 octane rating of 87.  
87  
Some stations offer fuels posted as  
(R+M)/2 METHOD  
“Regular” with an octane rating  
below 87, particularly in high altitude areas. Fuels with octane levels  
below 87 are not recommended.  
Do not be concerned if your engine sometimes knocks lightly. However, if  
it knocks heavily under most driving conditions while you are using fuel  
with the recommended octane rating, see your authorized dealer to  
prevent any engine damage.  
371  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
Fuel quality  
If you are experiencing starting, rough idle or hesitation driveability  
problems, try a different brand of unleaded gasoline. If the problems  
persist, see your authorized dealer.  
Do not add aftermarket fuel additive products to your fuel tank. It  
should not be necessary to add any aftermarket products to your fuel  
tank if you continue to use high quality fuel of the recommended octane  
rating. These products have not been approved for your engine and  
could cause damage to the fuel system. Repairs to correct the effects of  
using an aftermarket product in your fuel may not be covered by your  
warranty.  
Many of the world’s automakers approved the World-Wide Fuel Charter  
that recommends gasoline specifications to provide improved  
performance and emission control system protection for your vehicle.  
Gasolines that meet the World-Wide Fuel Charter should be used when  
available. Ask your fuel supplier about gasolines that meet the  
World-Wide Fuel Charter.  
Cleaner air  
Ford endorses the use of reformulated “cleaner-burning” gasolines to  
improve air quality, per the recommendations in the Choosing the right  
fuel section.  
Running out of fuel  
Avoid running out of fuel because this situation may have an adverse  
effect on powertrain components.  
If you have run out of fuel:  
You may need to cycle the ignition from off to on several times after  
refueling to allow the fuel system to pump the fuel from the tank to  
the engine. On restarting, cranking time will take a few seconds longer  
than normal.  
Normally, adding 1 gallon (3.8L) of fuel is enough to restart the  
engine. If the vehicle is out of fuel and on a steep grade, more than  
1 gallon (3.8L) may be required.  
The service engine soon  
indicator may come on. For more  
information on the service engine soon indicator, refer to Warning  
lights and chimes in the Instrument Cluster chapter.  
372  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
Refilling with a portable fuel container  
With the Easy Fuel™ “no cap” fuel system, use the following directions  
when filling from a portable fuel container:  
WARNING: Do not insert the nozzle of portable fuel containers  
or aftermarket funnels into the Easy Fuel™ system. This could  
damage the fuel system and its seal, and may cause fuel to run onto  
the ground instead of filling the tank, which could result in serious  
personal injury.  
WARNING: Do not try to pry open or push open the Easy  
Fuel™ system with foreign objects. This could damage the fuel  
system and its seal and cause injury to you or others.  
When filling the vehicle’s fuel tank from a portable fuel container, use the  
included funnel.  
1. Locate the white plastic funnel. It  
is attached to the underside of the  
spare tire cover or is included with  
the tire changing tools.  
2. Slowly insert the funnel into the Easy Fuel™ system.  
3. Fill the vehicle with fuel from the portable fuel container.  
4. When done, clean the funnel or properly dispose of it. Extra funnels  
can be purchased from your authorized dealer if you choose to dispose  
of the funnel. Do not use aftermarket funnels; they will not work with  
the Easy Fuel™ system and can damage it. The included funnel has  
been specially designed to work safely with your vehicle.  
373  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
ESSENTIALS OF GOOD FUEL ECONOMY  
Measuring techniques  
Your best source of information about actual fuel economy is you, the  
driver. You must gather information as accurately and consistently as  
possible. Fuel expense, frequency of fill-ups or fuel gauge readings are  
NOT accurate as a measure of fuel economy. We do not recommend  
taking fuel economy measurements during the first 1,000 miles  
(1,600 km) of driving (engine break-in period). You will get a more  
accurate measurement after 2,000 miles–3,000 miles (3,000 km–5,000  
km).  
Filling the tank  
The advertised fuel capacity of the fuel tank on your vehicle is equal to  
the rated refill capacity of the fuel tank as listed in the Maintenance  
product specifications and capacities section of this chapter.  
The advertised capacity is the amount of the indicated capacity and the  
empty reserve combined. Indicated capacity is the difference in the  
amount of fuel in a full tank and a tank when the fuel gauge indicates  
empty. Empty reserve is the small amount of fuel remaining in the fuel  
tank after the fuel gauge indicates empty.  
The amount of usable fuel in the empty reserve varies and should  
not be relied upon to increase driving range. When refueling your  
vehicle after the fuel gauge indicates empty, you might not be  
able to refuel the full amount of the advertised capacity of the  
fuel tank due to the empty reserve still present in the tank.  
For consistent results when filling the fuel tank:  
Turn the engine/ignition switch to the off position prior to refueling,  
an error in the reading will result if the engine is left running.  
Use the same filling rate setting (low — medium — high) each time  
the tank is filled.  
Allow no more than two automatic click-offs when filling.  
Always use fuel with the recommended octane rating.  
Use a known quality gasoline, preferably a national brand.  
Use the same side of the same pump and have the vehicle facing the  
same direction each time you fill up.  
Have the vehicle loading and distribution the same every time.  
Your results will be most accurate if your filling method is consistent.  
374  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
Calculating fuel economy  
1. Fill the fuel tank completely and record the initial odometer reading  
(in miles or kilometers).  
2. Each time you fill the tank, record the amount of fuel added (in  
gallons or liters).  
3. After at least three to five tank fill-ups, fill the fuel tank and record  
the current odometer reading.  
4. Subtract your initial odometer reading from the current odometer  
reading.  
5. Follow one of the simple calculations in order to determine fuel  
economy:  
Calculation 1: Divide total miles traveled by total gallons used.  
Calculation 2: Multiply liters used by 100, then divide by total  
kilometers traveled.  
Keep a record for at least one month and record the type of driving (city  
or highway). This will provide an accurate estimate of the vehicle’s fuel  
economy under current driving conditions. Additionally, keeping records  
during summer and winter will show how temperature impacts fuel  
economy. In general, lower temperatures give lower fuel economy.  
Driving style — good driving and fuel economy habits  
Give consideration to the lists that follow and you may be able to change  
a number of variables and improve your fuel economy.  
Habits  
Smooth, moderate operation can yield up to 10% savings in fuel.  
Steady speeds without stopping will usually give the best fuel  
economy.  
Idling for long periods of time (greater than one minute) may waste  
fuel.  
Anticipate stopping; slowing down may eliminate the need to stop.  
Sudden or hard accelerations may reduce fuel economy.  
Slow down gradually.  
Driving at reasonable speeds (traveling at 55 mph [88 km/h] uses 15%  
less fuel than traveling at 65 mph [105 km/h]).  
Revving the engine before turning it off may reduce fuel economy.  
Using the air conditioner or defroster may reduce fuel economy.  
375  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
You may want to turn off the speed control in hilly terrain if  
unnecessary shifting between the top gears occurs. Unnecessary  
shifting of this type could result in reduced fuel economy.  
Warming up a vehicle on cold mornings is not required and may  
reduce fuel economy.  
Resting your foot on the brake pedal while driving may reduce fuel  
economy.  
Combine errands and minimize stop-and-go driving.  
Maintenance  
Keep tires properly inflated and use only recommended size.  
Operating a vehicle with the wheels out of alignment will reduce fuel  
economy.  
Use recommended engine oil. Refer to Maintenance product  
specifications and capacities in this chapter.  
Perform all regularly scheduled maintenance items. Follow the  
recommended maintenance schedule and owner maintenance checks  
found in scheduled maintenance information.  
Conditions  
Heavily loading a vehicle or towing a trailer may reduce fuel economy  
at any speed.  
Carrying unnecessary weight may reduce fuel economy (approximately  
1 mpg [0.4 km/L] is lost for every 400 lb [180 kg] of weight carried).  
Adding certain accessories to your vehicle (for example; bug  
deflectors, rollbars/light bars, running boards, ski/luggage racks) may  
reduce fuel economy.  
Fuel economy may decrease with lower temperatures during the first  
8–10 miles (12–16 km) of driving.  
Driving on flat terrain offers improved fuel economy as compared to  
driving on hilly terrain.  
Transmissions give their best fuel economy when operated in the top  
cruise gear and with steady pressure on the gas pedal.  
Four-wheel-drive operation (if equipped) is less fuel efficient than  
two-wheel-drive operation.  
Close windows for high speed driving.  
376  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
EPA fuel economy estimates  
Every new vehicle should have a sticker on the window called the  
Monroney Label which contains EPA fuel economy estimates. Contact  
your authorized dealer if the Monroney Label is not supplied with your  
vehicle. The EPA fuel economy estimates should be your guide for the  
fuel economy comparisons with other vehicles. Your fuel economy may  
vary depending upon the method of operation and conditions.  
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM  
Your vehicle is equipped with various emission control components and a  
catalytic converter which will enable your vehicle to comply with  
applicable exhaust emission standards. To make sure that the catalytic  
converter and other emission control components continue to work  
properly:  
Use only the specified fuel listed.  
Avoid running out of fuel.  
Do not turn off the ignition while your vehicle is moving, especially at  
high speeds.  
Have the items listed in scheduled maintenance information  
performed according to the specified schedule.  
The scheduled maintenance items listed in scheduled maintenance  
information are essential to the life and performance of your vehicle  
and to its emissions system.  
If other than Ford, Motorcraft or Ford-authorized parts are used for  
maintenance replacements or for service of components affecting  
emission control, such non-Ford parts should be equivalent to genuine  
Ford Motor Company parts in performance and durability.  
WARNING: Do not park, idle, or drive your vehicle in dry grass  
or other dry ground cover. The emission system heats up the  
engine compartment and exhaust system, which can start a fire.  
Illumination of the service engine soon  
indicator, charging system  
warning light or the temperature warning light, fluid leaks, strange odors,  
smoke or loss of engine power could indicate that the emission control  
system is not working properly.  
An improperly operating or damaged exhaust system may allow exhaust  
to enter the vehicle. Have a damaged or improperly operating exhaust  
system inspected and repaired immediately.  
377  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
WARNING: Exhaust leaks may result in entry of harmful and  
potentially lethal fumes into the passenger compartment.  
Do not make any unauthorized changes to your vehicle or engine. By  
law, vehicle owners and anyone who manufactures, repairs, services,  
sells, leases, trades vehicles, or supervises a fleet of vehicles are not  
permitted to intentionally remove an emission control device or prevent  
it from working. Information about your vehicle’s emission system is on  
the Vehicle Emission Control Information Decal located on or near the  
engine. This decal also lists engine displacement.  
Please consult your Warranty Guide/Customer Information Guide for  
complete emission warranty information.  
On board diagnostics (OBD-II)  
Your vehicle is equipped with a computer that monitors the engine’s  
emission control system. This system is commonly known as the On  
Board Diagnostics System (OBD-II). The OBD-II system protects the  
environment by ensuring that your vehicle continues to meet  
government emission standards. The OBD-II system also assists your  
authorized dealer in properly servicing your vehicle. When the service  
engine soon  
a malfunction. Temporary malfunctions may cause the service engine  
soon indicator to illuminate. Examples are:  
indicator illuminates, the OBD-II system has detected  
1. The vehicle has run out of fuel—the engine may misfire or run poorly.  
2. Poor fuel quality or water in the fuel—the engine may misfire or run  
poorly.  
3. The fuel fill inlet may not have been properly closed. See Easy Fuel™  
“no cap” fuel system in this chapter.  
4. Driving through deep water—the electrical system may be wet.  
These temporary malfunctions can be corrected by filling the fuel tank  
with good quality fuel, properly closing the fuel fill inlet or letting the  
electrical system dry out. After three driving cycles without these or any  
other temporary malfunctions present, the service engine soon  
indicator should stay off the next time the engine is started. A driving  
cycle consists of a cold engine startup followed by mixed city/highway  
driving. No additional vehicle service is required.  
378  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
If the service engine soon  
indicator remains on, have your vehicle  
serviced at the first available opportunity. Although some malfunctions  
detected by the OBD-II may not have symptoms that are apparent,  
continued driving with the service engine soon  
indicator on can  
result in increased emissions, lower fuel economy, reduced engine and  
transmission smoothness, and lead to more costly repairs.  
Readiness for Inspection/Maintenance (I/M) testing  
Some state/provincial and local governments may have  
Inspection/Maintenance (I/M) programs to inspect the emission control  
equipment on your vehicle. Failure to pass this inspection could prevent  
you from getting a vehicle registration. Your vehicle may not pass the I/M  
test if the service engine soon  
indicator is on or not working  
properly (bulb is burned out), or if the OBD-II system has determined  
that some of the emission control systems have not been properly  
checked. In this case, the vehicle is considered not ready for I/M testing.  
If the service engine soon  
indicator is on or the bulb does not  
work, the vehicle may need to be serviced. Refer to the On board  
diagnostics (OBD-II) description in this chapter.  
If the vehicle’s engine or transmission has just been serviced, or the  
battery has recently run down or been replaced, the OBD-II system may  
indicate that the vehicle is not ready for I/M testing. To determine if the  
vehicle is ready for I/M testing, turn the ignition key to the on position  
for 15 seconds without cranking the engine. If the service engine  
soon  
indicator blinks eight times, it means that the vehicle is not  
ready for I/M testing; if the service engine soon  
indicator stays on  
solid, it means that the vehicle is ready for I/M testing.  
The OBD-II system is designed to check the emission control system  
during normal driving. A complete check may take several days. If the  
vehicle is not ready for I/M testing, the following driving cycle consisting  
of mixed city and highway driving may be performed:  
15 minutes of steady driving on an expressway/highway followed by  
20 minutes of stop-and-go driving with at least four 30-second idle  
periods.  
Allow the vehicle to sit for at least eight hours without starting the  
engine. Then, start the engine and complete the above driving cycle. The  
engine must warm up to its normal operating temperature. Once started,  
do not turn off the engine until the above driving cycle is complete. If  
the vehicle is still not ready for I/M testing, the above driving cycle will  
have to be repeated.  
379  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
POWER STEERING FLUID  
Check the power steering fluid. Refer to scheduled maintenance  
information.  
1. Start the engine and let it run  
until it reaches normal operating  
temperature (the engine coolant  
temperature gauge indicator will be  
near the center of the normal area  
between H and C).  
2. While the engine idles, turn the  
steering wheel left and right several  
times.  
3. Turn the engine off.  
4. Check the fluid level in the reservoir.  
5. The fluid level should be between the MIN and MAX lines. Do not add  
fluid if the level is in this range.  
6. If the fluid is low, add fluid in small amounts, continuously checking  
the level until it reaches the correct operating range. Be sure to put the  
cap back on the reservoir. Refer to Maintenance product specifications  
and capacities in this chapter for the proper fluid type.  
BRAKE FLUID  
The fluid level will drop slowly as  
the brakes wear, and will rise when  
the brake components are replaced.  
Fluid levels between the MIN and  
MAX lines are within the normal  
operating range; there is no need to  
add fluid. If the fluid levels are  
outside of the normal operating  
range, the performance of the  
system could be compromised; seek  
service from your authorized dealer  
immediately.  
TRANSMISSION FLUID  
Checking automatic transmission fluid  
The automatic transmission does not have an underhood transmission  
fluid dipstick.  
380  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
Refer to your scheduled maintenance information for scheduled  
intervals for fluid checks and changes. Your transmission does not  
consume fluid. However, the fluid level should be checked if the  
transmission is not working properly, (i.e., if the transmission slips or  
shifts slowly) or if you notice some sign of fluid leakage.  
Transmission fluid should be checked and, if required, fluid  
should be added by an authorized dealer.  
Do not use supplemental transmission fluid additives, treatments or  
cleaning agents. The use of these materials may affect transmission  
operation and result in damage to internal transmission components.  
TRANSFER CASE FLUID (IF EQUIPPED)  
WARNING: Turn off the  
power running boards, if  
equipped, before working under  
the vehicle, jacking or placing any  
object under the vehicle. Never  
place your hand between the  
extended running board and the  
vehicle. A moving running board  
may cause injury.  
1. Clean the filler plug.  
2. Remove the filler plug and inspect the fluid level.  
3. Add only enough fluid through  
the filler opening so that the fluid  
level is at the bottom of the  
opening.  
Use only fluid that meets Ford specifications. Refer to the Maintenance  
product specifications and capacities section in this chapter.  
381  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
DRIVELINE UNIVERSAL JOINT, DRIVESHAFT AND SLIP YOKE  
WARNING: Turn off the power running boards, if equipped,  
before working under the vehicle, jacking or placing any object  
under the vehicle. Never place your hand between the extended  
running board and the vehicle. A moving running board may cause  
injury.  
If the original universal joints are replaced with universal joints equipped  
with grease fittings, periodic lubrication will be necessary.  
Note: Your vehicle’s driveshaft is balanced. If undercoating the vehicle,  
protect the driveshaft, universal joints, and axle and transmission flanges  
to prevent overspray of any undercoating material. If your vehicle has  
four-wheel drive, your vehicle has two driveshafts, one connected to the  
rear axle and one connected to the front axle.  
AIR FILTER  
Refer to scheduled maintenance information for the appropriate  
intervals for changing the air filter element.  
When changing the air filter element, use only the air filter element  
listed. Refer to Motorcraft part numbers in this chapter.  
WARNING: To reduce the risk of vehicle damage and/or  
personal burn injuries do not start your engine with the air  
cleaner removed and do not remove it while the engine is running.  
382  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
Changing the air filter element  
4.0L Engine  
4.6L Engine  
1. Release the clamps that secure the air filter housing cover.  
2. Carefully separate the two halves of the air filter housing.  
3. Remove the air filter element from the air filter housing.  
4. Wipe the air filter housing and cover clean to remove any dirt or  
debris and to ensure good sealing.  
5. Install a new air filter element. Be careful not to crimp the filter  
element edges between the air filter housing and cover. This could cause  
filter damage and allow unfiltered air to enter the engine if not properly  
seated.  
6. Replace the air filter housing cover and secure the clamps.  
Note: Failure to use the correct air filter element may result in severe  
engine damage. The customer warranty may be void for any damage to  
the engine if the correct air filter element is not used.  
383  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
MOTORCRAFT PART NUMBERS  
Component  
Air filter element  
Fuel filter  
4.0L V6 engine  
FA-1695  
FG-1083  
4.6L 3V V8 engine  
FA-1780  
FG-1083  
Battery  
Oil filter  
Spark plugs  
BXT-65-650  
BXT-65-650  
FL-820S  
FL-820S  
1
1For spark plug replacement, see your authorized dealer. Refer to  
scheduled maintenance information for the appropriate intervals for  
changing the spark plugs.  
Replace the spark plugs with ones that meet Ford material and  
design specifications for your vehicle, such as Motorcraft or  
equivalent replacement parts. The customer warranty may be  
void for any damage to the engine if such spark plugs are not  
used.  
384  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
385  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
386  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
387  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
388  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
389  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Maintenance and Specifications  
ENGINE DATA  
Engine  
4.0L V6 engine 4.6L 3V V8  
engine  
Cubic inches  
Required fuel  
Firing order  
Ignition system  
Spark plug gap  
245  
281  
87 octane  
1-4-2-5-3-6  
EDIS  
0.052–0.056 inch 0.039–0.043 inch  
(1.32–1.42 mm) (1.0–1.1mm)  
87 octane  
1-3-7-2-6-5-4-8  
Coil on Plug  
Compression ratio  
9.7:1  
9.8:1  
Engine drivebelt routing  
4.0L V6 Engine  
4.6L V8 Engine  
390  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
IDENTIFYING YOUR VEHICLE  
Safety Compliance Certification Label  
The National Highway Traffic Safety  
Administration Regulations require  
that a Safety Compliance  
Certification Label be affixed to a  
vehicle and prescribe where the  
Safety Compliance Certification  
Label may be located. The Safety  
Compliance Certification Label is  
located on the structure (B-Pillar)  
by the trailing edge of the driver’s  
door or the edge of the driver’s  
door.  
Vehicle identification number (VIN)  
The vehicle identification number is  
located on the driver side  
instrument panel.  
XXXXXXXXXXXXXXXXX  
Please note that in the graphic,  
XXXX is representative of your  
vehicle identification number.  
391  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Maintenance and Specifications  
The Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) contains the following  
information:  
1. World manufacturer identifier  
2. Brake system / Gross Vehicle  
Weight Rating (GVWR) / Restraint  
Devices and their location  
3. Make, vehicle line, series, body  
type  
4. Engine type  
5. Check digit  
6. Model year  
7. Assembly plant  
8. Production sequence number  
TRANSMISSION CODE DESIGNATIONS  
You can find a transmission code on  
the Safety Compliance Certification  
Label. The following table tells you  
which transmission each code  
represents.  
Description  
Code  
Five-speed automatic (5R55S)  
Six-speed automatic (6R80)  
V
6
392  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Accessories  
GENUINE FORD ACCESSORIES FOR YOUR VEHICLE  
A wide selection of Genuine Ford Accessories are available for your  
vehicle through your local Ford or Ford of Canada dealer. These quality  
accessories have been specifically engineered to fulfill your automotive  
needs; they are custom designed to complement the style and  
aerodynamic appearance of your vehicle. In addition, each accessory is  
made from high quality materials and meets or exceeds Ford’s rigorous  
engineering and safety specifications. Ford Motor Company will repair or  
replace any properly dealer-installed Genuine Ford Accessories found to  
be defective in factory-supplied materials or workmanship during the  
warranty period, as well as any component damaged by the defective  
accessories. The accessories will be warranted for whichever provides  
you the greatest benefit:  
12 months or 12,000 miles (20,000 km) (whichever occurs first), or  
the remainder of your new vehicle limited warranty.  
Contact your dealer for details and a copy of the warranty.  
The following is a list of several Genuine Ford Accessories. Not all  
accessories are available for all models. For a complete listing of the  
accessories that are available for your vehicle, please contact your dealer  
or visit our online store at: www.fordaccessories.com.  
Exterior style  
Aluminum fuel filler door  
Bug shields  
Deflectors  
Running boards  
Interior style  
Ambient lighting for footwells and cupholders  
Electrochromic compass/temperature interior mirrors  
Floor mats  
Lifestyle  
Ash cup / smoker’s package  
Cargo organization and management  
Neutral tow kit  
Trailer hitch drawbars, and towing accessories  
393  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Accessories  
Peace of mind  
Keyless entry keypad  
Remote start  
Vehicle security systems  
Locking gas plug for capless fuel system  
Wheel locks  
For maximum vehicle performance, keep the following information in  
mind when adding accessories or equipment to your vehicle:  
When adding accessories, equipment, passengers and luggage to your  
vehicle, do not exceed the total weight capacity of the vehicle or of  
the front or rear axle (GVWR or GAWR as indicated on the Safety  
Compliance Certification label). Consult your authorized dealer for  
specific weight information.  
The Federal Communications Commission (FCC) and Canadian Radio  
Telecommunications Commission (CRTC) regulate the use of mobile  
communications systems — such as two-way radios, telephones and  
theft alarms - that are equipped with radio transmitters. Any such  
equipment installed in your vehicle should comply with FCC or CRTC  
regulations and should be installed only by a qualified service  
technician.  
Mobile communications systems may harm the operation of your  
vehicle, particularly if they are not properly designed for automotive  
use.  
To avoid interference with other vehicle functions, such as anti-lock  
braking systems, amateur radio users who install radios and antennas  
onto their vehicle should not locate the Amateur Radio Antennas in  
the area of the driver’s side hood.  
Electrical or electronic accessories or components that are added to  
the vehicle by the authorized dealer or the owner may adversely affect  
battery performance and durability.  
394  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Ford Extended Service Plan  
FORD ESP EXTENDED SERVICE PLANS  
More than 30 million Ford, Lincoln, and Mercury owners have discovered  
the powerful protection of Ford ESP. It is the only extended service plan  
backed by Ford Motor Company, and provides “peace of mind”  
protection beyond the New Vehicle Limited Warranty coverage.  
Up to 500+ Covered Vehicle Components  
There are four, new-vehicle Extended Service Plans with different levels  
of coverage. Ask you dealer for details.  
PremiumCare – Our most comprehensive coverage. With over 500  
covered components, this plan is so complete that we generally only  
discuss what’s not covered!  
ExtraCare – Covers 113 components, and includes many high-tech  
items.  
BaseCare – Covers 84 components.  
PowertrainCare – Covers 29 critical components.  
Ford ESP is honored by all Ford, Lincoln and Mercury Dealers in  
the U.S. and Canada It’s the only extended service plan authorized and  
backed by Ford Motor Company. That means you get:  
Reliable, quality service anywhere you go.  
Factory-trained technicians.  
Genuine Ford and MotorcraftParts.  
Rental car reimbursement  
If your vehicle is kept overnight for covered repairs, you are  
eligible for rental car coverage, including Bumper-to-Bumper warranty  
repairs, or manufacturer’s recalls.  
Transferable coverage  
If you sell your vehicle before your Ford ESP coverage expires, you can  
transfer any remaining coverage to the new owner. Whenever you’re  
ready to sell your car, prospective buyers may feel better about taking a  
risk on your used vehicle. Ford ESP may add resale value!  
Plus, exclusive 24/7 roadside assistance, including:  
Towing, flat-tire change and battery jump starts.  
Out-of-fuel and lock-out assistance.  
Travel expense reimbursement for lodging, meals and rental car.  
Destination assistance for taxi, shuttle, rental car coverage and  
emergency transportation.  
395  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Ford Extended Service Plan  
Ford ESP Can Quickly Pay for Itself  
One service bill – the cost of parts and labor – can easily exceed the  
price of your Ford ESP Service Contract. With Ford ESP, you minimize  
your risk for unexpected repair bills and rising repair costs.  
Avoid the rising cost of properly maintaining your vehicle!  
Ford ESP also offers a Premium Maintenance Plan that covers items that  
routinely wear out, like brakes and shocks.  
The coverage is prepaid, so you never have to worry about affording  
your vehicle maintenance. It covers regular checkups, routine  
inspections, preventive care and replacement of items that require  
periodic attention for normal “wear”:  
Wiper blades  
Spark plugs (except  
California)  
Clutch disc  
Brake pads and linings  
Shock absorbers  
Belts and hoses  
Contact your selling Ford, Lincoln, or Mercury dealership today so they  
can customize a Ford Extended Service Plan that fits your driving  
lifestyle and budget.  
396  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Ford Extended Service Plan  
397  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
A
B
C
Automatic transmission  
Axle  
398  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
 
Index  
Cleaning your vehicle  
D
Defrost  
Dipstick  
Clock adjust  
Compass, electronic  
Controls  
Coolant  
E
Emergencies, roadside  
399  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
G
F
GAWR (Gross Axle Weight  
Rating)  
GVWR (Gross Vehicle Weight  
Rating)  
H
Heating  
400  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
I
Locks  
Instrument panel  
J
M
K
Keyless entry system  
L
N
Lamps  
O
401  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
P
S
R
402  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  
Index  
Setting the clock  
Special notice  
Transfer case  
Steering wheel  
T
U
Tire Pressure Monitoring  
System (TPMS)  
V
403  
2010 Explorer (exp)  
Owners Guide (own2002), 1st Printing  
USA (fus)  
Download from Www.Somanuals.com. All Manuals Search And Download.  

Ericsson Modem WCDMA HSDPA User Manual
Evo Fitness Home Gym 5102 User Manual
FieldServer Computer Drive FS 8700 80 User Manual
Fisher Paykel Ventilation Hood HS60CIW1 User Manual
Flymo Trimmer CT250 plus User Manual
Focal Speaker Sib User Manual
Frigidaire Washer FWT449GF User Manual
GE Microwave Oven JES1339 User Manual
GE Monogram Microwave Oven ZEM200WV User Manual
GE Washer LISR310 User Manual